]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - man/gnus.texi
(Link format): New section, emphasis on bracket links.
[gnu-emacs] / man / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
4 @settitle Gnus Manual
5 @syncodeindex fn cp
6 @syncodeindex vr cp
7 @syncodeindex pg cp
8
9 @copying
10 Copyright @copyright{} 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
11 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12
13 @quotation
14 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
15 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
16 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
17 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
18 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
19 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
20 License'' in the Emacs manual.
21
22 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
23 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
24 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
25
26 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
27 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
28 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
29 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
30 @end quotation
31 @end copying
32
33 @iftex
34 @iflatex
35 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
36 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
37 \usepackage{pagestyle}
38 \usepackage{epsfig}
39 \usepackage{pixidx}
40 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
41
42 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
43 \else
44 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
45 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
46 \pdfcompresslevel=9
47 \fi
48
49 \makeindex
50 \begin{document}
51
52 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
53 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.11}
54 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
55 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
56
57 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
58
59 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
60 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
61 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
62 \else
63 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
64 \fi
65 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
66 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
67
68 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
70
71 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
77 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
78 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
80 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
81 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
82 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
94 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
95
96 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
97 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
98 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
99 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
100 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
101 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
104 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
106 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
108 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
109
110 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
111 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
112 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
113 }
114
115 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
116
117 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
118 {\mbox{}}
119 }
120
121 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
122 \gnusdimen 0pt
123
124 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
125 \gnuscleardoublepage
126 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
127 \chapter{#2}
128 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
129 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
130 \thispagestyle{empty}
131 \hspace*{-2cm}
132 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
133 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
134 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
135 \end{picture}
136 \clearpage
137 }
138
139 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
140 \begin{figure}
141 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
142 #3
143 \end{picture}
144 \caption{#1}
145 \end{figure}
146 }
147
148 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
149 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
150 }
151
152 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
153 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
154 }
155
156 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
157 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
158 }
159
160 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
161 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
162 }
163
164 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
165
166 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
167 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
168 \section{#1}
169 }
170
171 \newenvironment{codelist}%
172 {\begin{list}{}{
173 }
174 }{\end{list}}
175
176 \newenvironment{asislist}%
177 {\begin{list}{}{
178 }
179 }{\end{list}}
180
181 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
182 {\begin{list}{}{
183 \labelwidth=0cm
184 }
185 }{\end{list}}
186
187 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
188 {\begin{list}{}{
189 }
190 }{\end{list}}
191
192 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
193 {\begin{list}{}{
194 }
195 }{\end{list}}
196
197 \newenvironment{samplist}%
198 {\begin{list}{}{
199 }
200 }{\end{list}}
201
202 \newenvironment{varlist}%
203 {\begin{list}{}{
204 }
205 }{\end{list}}
206
207 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
208 {\begin{list}{}{
209 }
210 }{\end{list}}
211
212 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
213 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
214 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
215
216 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
217 {
218 {
219 \ifodd\count0
220 {
221 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
222 }
223 \else
224 {
225 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
226 }
227 }
228 \fi
229 }
230 }
231 {
232 \ifodd\count0
233 \mbox{} \hfill
234 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
235 \else
236 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
237 \hfill \mbox{}
238 \fi
239 }
240
241 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
242 {
243 {
244 \ifodd\count0
245 {
246 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
247 }
248 \else
249 {
250 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
251 }
252 \fi
253 }
254 }
255 {
256 \ifodd\count0
257 \mbox{} \hfill
258 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
259 \else
260 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
261 \hfill \mbox{}
262 \fi
263 }
264
265 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
266 {
267 {
268 \ifodd\count0
269 {
270 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
271 }
272 \else
273 {
274 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
275 }
276 \fi
277 }
278 }
279 {
280 \ifodd\count0
281 \mbox{} \hfill
282 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
283 \else
284 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
285 \hfill \mbox{}
286 \fi
287 }
288
289 \pagenumbering{roman}
290 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
291
292 @end iflatex
293 @end iftex
294
295 @iftex
296 @iflatex
297
298 \begin{titlepage}
299 {
300
301 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
302 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
303 \parindent=0cm
304 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
305
306 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
307 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308 \vfill
309 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
310 \vfill
311 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
312 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
313 \newpage
314 }
315
316 \mbox{}
317 \vfill
318
319 \thispagestyle{empty}
320
321 @c @insertcopying
322 \newpage
323 \end{titlepage}
324 @end iflatex
325 @end iftex
326
327 @ifnottex
328 @insertcopying
329 @end ifnottex
330
331 @dircategory Emacs
332 @direntry
333 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
334 @end direntry
335 @iftex
336 @finalout
337 @end iftex
338 @setchapternewpage odd
339
340
341
342 @titlepage
343 @title Gnus Manual
344
345 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
346 @page
347 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
348 @insertcopying
349 @end titlepage
350
351
352 @node Top
353 @top The Gnus Newsreader
354
355 @ifinfo
356
357 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
358 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
359 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
360 luck.
361
362 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
363 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.11.
364
365 @end ifinfo
366
367 @iftex
368
369 @iflatex
370 \tableofcontents
371 \gnuscleardoublepage
372 @end iflatex
373
374 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
375 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
376
377 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
378 being accused of plagiarism:
379
380 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
381 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
382 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
383 can even read news with it!
384
385 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
386 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
387 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
388 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
389 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
390 the program.
391
392 @end iftex
393
394 @menu
395 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
396 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
397 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
398 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
399 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
400 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
401 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
402 * Various:: General purpose settings.
403 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
404 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
405 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
406 * Key Index:: Key Index.
407
408 Other related manuals
409
410 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
411 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
412 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
413 * PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
414
415 @detailmenu
416 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
417
418 Starting Gnus
419
420 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
421 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
422 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
423 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
424 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
425 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
426 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
427 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
428 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
429 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
430 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
431
432 New Groups
433
434 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
435 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
436 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
437
438 Group Buffer
439
440 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
441 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
442 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
443 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
444 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
445 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
446 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
447 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
448 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
449 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
450 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
451 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
452 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
453 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
454 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
455 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
456 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
457
458 Group Buffer Format
459
460 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
461 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
462 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
463
464 Group Topics
465
466 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
467 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
468 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
469 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
470 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
471
472 Misc Group Stuff
473
474 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
475 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
476 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
477 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
478 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
479
480 Summary Buffer
481
482 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
483 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
484 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
485 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
486 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
487 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
488 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
489 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
490 * Threading:: How threads are made.
491 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
492 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
493 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
494 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
495 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
496 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
497 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
498 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
499 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
500 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
501 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
502 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
503 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
504 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
505 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
506 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
507 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
508 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
509 or reselecting the current group.
510 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
511 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
512 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
513 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
514
515 Summary Buffer Format
516
517 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
518 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
519 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
520 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
521
522 Choosing Articles
523
524 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
525 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
526
527 Reply, Followup and Post
528
529 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
530 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
531 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
532 * Canceling and Superseding::
533
534 Marking Articles
535
536 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
537 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
538 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
539 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
540 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
541 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
542
543 Threading
544
545 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
546 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
547
548 Customizing Threading
549
550 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
551 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
552 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
553 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
554
555 Decoding Articles
556
557 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
558 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
559 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
560 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
561 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
562 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
563
564 Decoding Variables
565
566 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
567 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
568 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
569
570 Article Treatment
571
572 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
573 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
574 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
575 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
576 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
577 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
578 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
579 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
580 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
581 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
582 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
583
584 Alternative Approaches
585
586 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
587 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
588
589 Various Summary Stuff
590
591 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
592 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
593 * Summary Generation Commands::
594 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
595
596 Article Buffer
597
598 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
599 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
600 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
601 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
602 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
603
604 Composing Messages
605
606 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
607 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
608 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
609 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
610 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
611 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
612 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
613 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
614 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
615
616 Select Methods
617
618 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
619 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
620 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
621 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
622 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
623 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
624 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
625 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
626
627 Server Buffer
628
629 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
630 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
631 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
632 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
633 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
634 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
635 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
636
637 Getting News
638
639 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
640 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
641
642 @acronym{NNTP}
643
644 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
645 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
646 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
647
648 Getting Mail
649
650 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
651 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
652 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
653 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
654 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
655 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
656 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
657 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
658 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
659 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
660 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
661 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
662 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
663
664 Mail Sources
665
666 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
667 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
668 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
669
670 Choosing a Mail Back End
671
672 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
673 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
674 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
675 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
676 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
677 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
678 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
679
680 Browsing the Web
681
682 * Archiving Mail::
683 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
684 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
685 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
686 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
687 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
688 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
689
690 @acronym{IMAP}
691
692 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
693 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
694 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
695 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
696 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
697 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
698
699 Other Sources
700
701 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
702 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
703 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
704 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
705 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
706
707 Document Groups
708
709 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
710
711 SOUP
712
713 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
714 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
715 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
716
717 Combined Groups
718
719 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
720 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
721
722 Gnus Unplugged
723
724 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
725 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
726 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
727 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
728 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
729 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
730 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
731 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
732 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
733 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
734 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
735 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
736 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
737
738 Agent Categories
739
740 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
741 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
742 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
743
744 Agent Commands
745
746 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
747 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
748 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
749
750 Scoring
751
752 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
753 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
754 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
755 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
756 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
757 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
758 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
759 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
760 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
761 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
762 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
763 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
764 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
765 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
766 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
767 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
768 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
769
770 GroupLens
771
772 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
773 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
774 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
775 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
776
777 Advanced Scoring
778
779 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
780 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
781 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
782
783 Various
784
785 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
786 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
787 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
788 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
789 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
790 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
791 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
792 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
793 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
794 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
795 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
796 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
797 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
798 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
799 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
800 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
801 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
802 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
803 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
804 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
805
806 Formatting Variables
807
808 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
809 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
810 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
811 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
812 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
813 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
814 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
815 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
816
817 Image Enhancements
818
819 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
820 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
821 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
822 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
823 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
824
825 Thwarting Email Spam
826
827 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
828 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
829 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
830 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
831 * Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package::
832 * Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat::
833
834 Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
835
836 * Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events::
837 * Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail::
838 * Spam ELisp Package Global Variables::
839 * Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples::
840 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
841 * BBDB Whitelists::
842 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
843 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
844 * Blackholes::
845 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
846 * Bogofilter::
847 * ifile spam filtering::
848 * spam-stat spam filtering::
849 * SpamOracle::
850 * Extending the Spam ELisp package::
851
852 Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
853
854 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
855 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
856 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
857
858 Appendices
859
860 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
861 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
862 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
863 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
864 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
865 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
866 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
867 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
868 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
869
870 History
871
872 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
873 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
874 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
875 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
876 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
877 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
878 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
879 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
880 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
881
882 New Features
883
884 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
885 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
886 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
887 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
888 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
889 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
890
891 Customization
892
893 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
894 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
895 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
896 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
897
898 Gnus Reference Guide
899
900 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
901 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
902 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
903 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
904 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
905 * Group Info:: The group info format.
906 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
907 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
908 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
909
910 Back End Interface
911
912 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
913 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
914 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
915 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
916 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
917 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
918
919 Various File Formats
920
921 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
922 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
923
924 Emacs for Heathens
925
926 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
927 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
928
929 @end detailmenu
930 @end menu
931
932 @node Starting Up
933 @chapter Starting Gnus
934 @cindex starting up
935
936 @kindex M-x gnus
937 @findex gnus
938 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
939 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
940 your Emacs.
941
942 @findex gnus-other-frame
943 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
944 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
945 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
946
947 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
948 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
949 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
950
951 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
952 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
953
954 @menu
955 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
956 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
957 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
958 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
959 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
960 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
961 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
962 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
963 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
964 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
965 @end menu
966
967
968 @node Finding the News
969 @section Finding the News
970 @cindex finding news
971
972 @vindex gnus-select-method
973 @c @head
974 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
975 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
976 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
977 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
978 foreign groups.
979
980 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
981 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
982
983 @lisp
984 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
985 @end lisp
986
987 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
988
989 @lisp
990 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
991 @end lisp
992
993 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
994 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
995 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
996 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
997
998 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
999 @cindex NNTPSERVER
1000 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1001 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1002 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1003 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1004 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1005 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1006 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1007
1008 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1009 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1010 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1011 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1012
1013 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1014 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1015 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1016 @acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1017 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1018 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1019 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1020 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1021 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1022 server.)
1023
1024 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1025 @kindex B (Group)
1026 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1027 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1028 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1029 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1030 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1031 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1032
1033 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1034 @c @head
1035 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1036 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1037 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1038 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1039 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1040 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1041 groups are.
1042
1043 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1044 you would typically set this variable to
1045
1046 @lisp
1047 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1048 @end lisp
1049
1050
1051 @node The First Time
1052 @section The First Time
1053 @cindex first time usage
1054
1055 If no startup files exist (@pxref{Startup Files}), Gnus will try to
1056 determine what groups should be subscribed by default.
1057
1058 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1059 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1060 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1061 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1062 something useful.
1063
1064 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1065 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1066 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1067
1068 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1069 help you with most common problems.
1070
1071 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1072 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1073 special.
1074
1075
1076 @node The Server is Down
1077 @section The Server is Down
1078 @cindex server errors
1079
1080 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1081 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1082 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1083
1084 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1085 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1086 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1087 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1088 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1089 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1090 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1091
1092 @findex gnus-no-server
1093 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1094 @c @head
1095 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1096 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1097 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1098 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1099 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1100 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1101 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1102
1103
1104 @node Slave Gnusae
1105 @section Slave Gnusae
1106 @cindex slave
1107
1108 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1109 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1110 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1111 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1112
1113 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1114 @file{.newsrc} file.
1115
1116 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1117 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1118 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1119 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1120 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1121 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1122 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1123
1124 @findex gnus-slave
1125 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1126 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1127 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1128 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1129 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1130 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1131 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1132 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1133
1134 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1135 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1136
1137 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1138 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1139 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1140 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1141 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1142
1143
1144
1145 @node New Groups
1146 @section New Groups
1147 @cindex new groups
1148 @cindex subscription
1149
1150 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1151 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1152 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1153 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1154 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1155 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1156 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1157 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1158 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1159
1160 @menu
1161 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1162 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1163 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1164 @end menu
1165
1166
1167 @node Checking New Groups
1168 @subsection Checking New Groups
1169
1170 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1171 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1172 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1173 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1174 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1175 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1176 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1177 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1178 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1179 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1180
1181 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1182 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1183 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1184 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1185 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1186 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1187 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1188 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1189 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1190 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1191 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1192
1193 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1194 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1195 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1196 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1197 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1198 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1199
1200
1201 @node Subscription Methods
1202 @subsection Subscription Methods
1203
1204 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1205 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1206 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1207
1208 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1209 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1210
1211 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1212
1213 @table @code
1214
1215 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1216 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1217 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1218 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1219 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1220
1221 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1222 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1223 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1224 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1225
1226 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1227 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1228 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1229
1230 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1231 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1232 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1233 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1234 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1235 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1236 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1237 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1238 up. Or something like that.
1239
1240 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1241 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1242 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1243 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1244 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1245
1246 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1247 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1248 Kill all new groups.
1249
1250 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1251 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1252 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1253 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1254 topic parameter that looks like
1255
1256 @example
1257 "nnslashdot"
1258 @end example
1259
1260 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1261 that topic.
1262
1263 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1264 top-level topic.
1265
1266 @end table
1267
1268 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1269 A closely related variable is
1270 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1271 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1272 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1273 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1274 hierarchy or not.
1275
1276 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1277 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1278 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1279 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1280
1281
1282 @node Filtering New Groups
1283 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1284
1285 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1286 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1287 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1288
1289 @example
1290 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1291 @end example
1292
1293 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1294 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1295 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1296 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1297 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1298 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1299 subscribing these groups.
1300 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1301 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1302
1303 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1304 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1305 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1306 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1307 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1308 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1309 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1310 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1311
1312 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1313 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1314 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1315 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1316 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1317 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1318 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1319 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1320 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1321 subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1322 @code{nil}.
1323
1324 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1325 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1326
1327
1328 @node Changing Servers
1329 @section Changing Servers
1330 @cindex changing servers
1331
1332 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1333 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1334 very flaky and you want to use another.
1335
1336 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1337 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1338
1339 @emph{Wrong!}
1340
1341 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1342 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1343 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1344 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1345 worthless.
1346
1347 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1348 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1349 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1350 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1351
1352 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1353 @findex gnus-change-server
1354 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1355 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1356 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1357 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1358 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1359
1360 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1361 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1362 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1363 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1364 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1365
1366 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1367 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1368 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1369 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1370 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1371 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1372
1373 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1374 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1375 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1376 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1377
1378 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1379 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1380 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1381 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1382 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1383 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1384 cache for all groups).
1385
1386
1387 @node Startup Files
1388 @section Startup Files
1389 @cindex startup files
1390 @cindex .newsrc
1391 @cindex .newsrc.el
1392 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1393
1394 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1395 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1396 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1397 read.
1398
1399 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1400 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1401 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1402 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1403 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1404 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1405 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1406
1407 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1408 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1409 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1410 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1411 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1412 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1413
1414 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1415 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1416 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1417 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1418 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1419 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1420 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1421 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1422 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1423 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1424 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1425 news reader.
1426
1427 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1428 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1429 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1430 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1431 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1432 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1433 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1434 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1435 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1436 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1437 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1438 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1439
1440 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1441 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1442 @vindex version-control
1443 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1444 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1445 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1446 If you want version control for this file, set
1447 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1448 @code{version-control} variable.
1449
1450 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1451 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1452 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1453 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1454 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1455 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1456 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1457 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1458 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1459 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1460
1461 @lisp
1462 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1463 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1464
1465 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1466 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1467 @end lisp
1468
1469 @vindex gnus-init-file
1470 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1471 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1472 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1473 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1474 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1475 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1476 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1477 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1478 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1479 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1480 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1481 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1482 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1483
1484
1485 @node Auto Save
1486 @section Auto Save
1487 @cindex dribble file
1488 @cindex auto-save
1489
1490 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1491 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1492 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1493 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1494 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1495 this file.
1496
1497 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1498 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1499 saved.
1500
1501 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1502 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1503 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1504
1505 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1506 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1507 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1508 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1509 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1510 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1511
1512 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1513 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1514 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1515
1516
1517 @node The Active File
1518 @section The Active File
1519 @cindex active file
1520 @cindex ignored groups
1521
1522 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1523 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1524 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1525
1526 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1527 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1528 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1529 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1530 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1531 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1532 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1533
1534 @c This variable is
1535 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1536 @c if you set it to anything else.
1537
1538 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1539 @c @head
1540 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1541 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1542 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1543
1544 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1545 you actually subscribe to.
1546
1547 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1548 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1549 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1550 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1551
1552 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1553 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1554 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1555 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1556 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1557 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1558
1559 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1560 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1561 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1562 variable.
1563
1564 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1565 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1566 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1567 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1568 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1569 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1570
1571 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1572 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1573
1574 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1575 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1576
1577 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1578 secondary select methods.
1579
1580
1581 @node Startup Variables
1582 @section Startup Variables
1583
1584 @table @code
1585
1586 @item gnus-load-hook
1587 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1588 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1589 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1590 times you start Gnus.
1591
1592 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1593 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1594 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1595
1596 @item gnus-startup-hook
1597 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1598 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1599
1600 @item gnus-started-hook
1601 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1602 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1603 successfully.
1604
1605 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1606 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1607 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1608 generating the group buffer.
1609
1610 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1611 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1612 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1613 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1614 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1615 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1616 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1617 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1618
1619 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1620 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1621 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1622 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1623 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1624 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1625
1626 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1627 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1628 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1629
1630 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1631 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1632 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1633
1634 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1635 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1636 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1637 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1638
1639 @end table
1640
1641
1642 @node Group Buffer
1643 @chapter Group Buffer
1644 @cindex group buffer
1645
1646 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1647 @c
1648 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1649 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1650 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1651 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1652 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1653 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1654 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1655 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1656 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1657 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1658 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1659 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1660 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1661 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1662 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1663 @c human rights at 9...
1664
1665
1666 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1667 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1668 long as Gnus is active.
1669
1670 @iftex
1671 @iflatex
1672 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1673 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1674 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1675 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1676 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1677 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1678 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1679 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1680 }
1681 @end iflatex
1682 @end iftex
1683
1684 @menu
1685 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1686 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1687 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1688 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1689 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1690 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1691 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1692 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1693 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1694 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1695 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1696 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1697 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1698 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1699 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1700 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1701 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1702 @end menu
1703
1704
1705 @node Group Buffer Format
1706 @section Group Buffer Format
1707
1708 @menu
1709 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1710 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1711 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1712 @end menu
1713
1714
1715 @node Group Line Specification
1716 @subsection Group Line Specification
1717 @cindex group buffer format
1718
1719 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1720 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1721
1722 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1723
1724 @example
1725 25: news.announce.newusers
1726 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1727 @end example
1728
1729 Quite simple, huh?
1730
1731 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1732 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1733 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1734 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1735
1736 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1737 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1738 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1739 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1740 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1741 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1742
1743 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1744
1745 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1746 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1747 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1748 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1749 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1750
1751 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1752 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1753 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1754
1755 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1756
1757 @table @samp
1758
1759 @item M
1760 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1761
1762 @item S
1763 Whether the group is subscribed.
1764
1765 @item L
1766 Level of subscribedness.
1767
1768 @item N
1769 Number of unread articles.
1770
1771 @item I
1772 Number of dormant articles.
1773
1774 @item T
1775 Number of ticked articles.
1776
1777 @item R
1778 Number of read articles.
1779
1780 @item U
1781 Number of unseen articles.
1782
1783 @item t
1784 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1785 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1786
1787 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1788 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1789 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1790 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1791 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1792 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1793 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job. If you
1794 want to work on this, please contact the Gnus mailing list.
1795
1796 @item y
1797 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1798
1799 @item i
1800 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1801
1802 @item g
1803 Full group name.
1804
1805 @item G
1806 Group name.
1807
1808 @item C
1809 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1810 comment element in the group parameters.
1811
1812 @item D
1813 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1814 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1815 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1816 command.
1817
1818 @item o
1819 @samp{m} if moderated.
1820
1821 @item O
1822 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1823
1824 @item s
1825 Select method.
1826
1827 @item B
1828 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1829
1830 @item n
1831 Select from where.
1832
1833 @item z
1834 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1835 used.
1836
1837 @item P
1838 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1839
1840 @item c
1841 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1842 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1843 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1844 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1845 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1846
1847 @item m
1848 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1849 @cindex %
1850 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1851 the group lately.
1852
1853 @item p
1854 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1855
1856 @item d
1857 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1858 Timestamp}).
1859
1860 @item u
1861 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1862 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1863 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1864 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1865 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1866 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1867 specifier.
1868 @end table
1869
1870 @cindex *
1871 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1872 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1873 group, or a bogus native group.
1874
1875
1876 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1877 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1878 @cindex group mode line
1879
1880 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1881 The mode line can be changed by setting
1882 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1883 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1884
1885 @table @samp
1886 @item S
1887 The native news server.
1888 @item M
1889 The native select method.
1890 @end table
1891
1892
1893 @node Group Highlighting
1894 @subsection Group Highlighting
1895 @cindex highlighting
1896 @cindex group highlighting
1897
1898 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1899 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1900 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1901 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1902 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1903
1904 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1905 background is dark:
1906
1907 @lisp
1908 (cond (window-system
1909 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1910 (defface my-group-face-1
1911 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1912 (defface my-group-face-2
1913 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1914 "Second group face")
1915 (defface my-group-face-3
1916 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1917 (defface my-group-face-4
1918 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1919 (defface my-group-face-5
1920 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1921
1922 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1923 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1924 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1925 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1926 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1927 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1928 @end lisp
1929
1930 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1931
1932 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1933 include:
1934
1935 @table @code
1936 @item group
1937 The group name.
1938 @item unread
1939 The number of unread articles in the group.
1940 @item method
1941 The select method.
1942 @item mailp
1943 Whether the group is a mail group.
1944 @item level
1945 The level of the group.
1946 @item score
1947 The score of the group.
1948 @item ticked
1949 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1950 @item total
1951 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1952 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1953 @item topic
1954 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1955 topic being inserted.
1956 @end table
1957
1958 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1959 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1960 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1961
1962 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1963 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1964 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1965 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1966 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1967
1968
1969 @node Group Maneuvering
1970 @section Group Maneuvering
1971 @cindex group movement
1972
1973 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1974 expected, hopefully.
1975
1976 @table @kbd
1977
1978 @item n
1979 @kindex n (Group)
1980 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1981 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1982 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1983
1984 @item p
1985 @itemx DEL
1986 @kindex DEL (Group)
1987 @kindex p (Group)
1988 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1989 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1990 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1991
1992 @item N
1993 @kindex N (Group)
1994 @findex gnus-group-next-group
1995 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
1996
1997 @item P
1998 @kindex P (Group)
1999 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2000 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2001
2002 @item M-n
2003 @kindex M-n (Group)
2004 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2005 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2006 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2007
2008 @item M-p
2009 @kindex M-p (Group)
2010 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2011 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2012 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2013 @end table
2014
2015 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2016
2017 @table @kbd
2018
2019 @item j
2020 @kindex j (Group)
2021 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2022 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2023 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2024 like living groups.
2025
2026 @item ,
2027 @kindex , (Group)
2028 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2029 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2030 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2031
2032 @item .
2033 @kindex . (Group)
2034 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2035 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2036 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2037 @end table
2038
2039 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2040 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2041 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2042 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2043 is @code{t}.
2044
2045
2046 @node Selecting a Group
2047 @section Selecting a Group
2048 @cindex group selection
2049
2050 @table @kbd
2051
2052 @item SPACE
2053 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2054 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2055 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2056 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2057 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2058 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2059 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2060 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2061 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2062 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2063
2064 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2065 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2066 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2067
2068 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2069 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2070 ones.
2071
2072 @item RET
2073 @kindex RET (Group)
2074 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2075 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2076 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2077 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2078 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2079 entry.
2080
2081 @item M-RET
2082 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2083 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2084 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2085 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2086 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2087 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2088 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2089 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2090 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2091 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2092
2093 @item M-SPACE
2094 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2095 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2096 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2097 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2098 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2099
2100 @item C-M-RET
2101 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2102 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2103 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2104 doing any processing of its contents
2105 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2106 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2107 manner will have no permanent effects.
2108
2109 @end table
2110
2111 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2112 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2113 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2114 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2115 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2116 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2117 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2118 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2119 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2120 most recently will be fetched.
2121
2122 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2123 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2124 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2125 newsgroups.
2126
2127 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2128 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2129 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2130 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2131 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2132 Which article this is is controlled by the
2133 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2134 variable is:
2135
2136 @table @code
2137
2138 @item unread
2139 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2140
2141 @item first
2142 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2143
2144 @item unseen
2145 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2146
2147 @item unseen-or-unread
2148 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2149 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2150 unread article.
2151
2152 @item best
2153 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2154
2155 @end table
2156
2157 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2158 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2159
2160 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2161 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2162 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2163 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2164 selected.
2165
2166
2167 @node Subscription Commands
2168 @section Subscription Commands
2169 @cindex subscription
2170
2171 @table @kbd
2172
2173 @item S t
2174 @itemx u
2175 @kindex S t (Group)
2176 @kindex u (Group)
2177 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2178 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2179 Toggle subscription to the current group
2180 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2181
2182 @item S s
2183 @itemx U
2184 @kindex S s (Group)
2185 @kindex U (Group)
2186 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2187 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2188 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2189 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2190
2191 @item S k
2192 @itemx C-k
2193 @kindex S k (Group)
2194 @kindex C-k (Group)
2195 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2196 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2197 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2198
2199 @item S y
2200 @itemx C-y
2201 @kindex S y (Group)
2202 @kindex C-y (Group)
2203 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2204 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2205
2206 @item C-x C-t
2207 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2208 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2209 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2210 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2211 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2212
2213 @item S w
2214 @itemx C-w
2215 @kindex S w (Group)
2216 @kindex C-w (Group)
2217 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2218 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2219
2220 @item S z
2221 @kindex S z (Group)
2222 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2223 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2224
2225 @item S C-k
2226 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2227 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2228 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2229 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2230 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2231 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2232 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2233 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2234 @file{.newsrc} file.
2235
2236 @end table
2237
2238 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2239
2240
2241 @node Group Data
2242 @section Group Data
2243
2244 @table @kbd
2245
2246 @item c
2247 @kindex c (Group)
2248 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2249 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2250 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2251 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2252 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2253 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2254 the group buffer.
2255
2256 @item C
2257 @kindex C (Group)
2258 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2259 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2260 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2261
2262 @item M-c
2263 @kindex M-c (Group)
2264 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2265 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2266 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2267
2268 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2269 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2270 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2271 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2272 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2273 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2274 caution.
2275
2276 @end table
2277
2278
2279 @node Group Levels
2280 @section Group Levels
2281 @cindex group level
2282 @cindex level
2283
2284 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2285 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2286 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2287 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2288 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2289
2290 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2291
2292 @table @kbd
2293
2294 @item S l
2295 @kindex S l (Group)
2296 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2297 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2298 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2299 prompted for a level.
2300 @end table
2301
2302 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2303 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2304 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2305 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2306 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2307 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2308 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2309 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2310 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2311 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2312 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2313 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2314 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2315 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2316 reasons of efficiency.
2317
2318 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2319 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2320
2321 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2322 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2323 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2324 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2325 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2326 groups are hidden, in a way.
2327
2328 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2329 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2330 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2331 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2332 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2333 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2334
2335 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2336 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2337 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2338 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2339 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2340 list of killed groups.)
2341
2342 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2343 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2344 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2345
2346 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2347 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2348 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2349 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2350 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2351 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2352 relevant valid ranges.
2353
2354 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2355 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2356 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2357 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2358 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2359 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2360 rest.
2361
2362 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2363 one with the best level.
2364
2365 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2366 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2367 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2368 by default.
2369
2370 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2371 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2372 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2373 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2374 listed.
2375
2376 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2377 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2378 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2379 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2380
2381 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2382 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2383 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2384 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2385 to 5. The default is 6.
2386
2387
2388 @node Group Score
2389 @section Group Score
2390 @cindex group score
2391 @cindex group rank
2392 @cindex rank
2393
2394 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2395 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2396 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2397 reason?
2398
2399 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2400 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2401 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2402 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2403 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2404 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2405 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2406 least significant part.))
2407
2408 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2409 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2410 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2411 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2412 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2413 action after each summary exit, you can add
2414 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2415 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2416 slow things down somewhat.
2417
2418
2419 @node Marking Groups
2420 @section Marking Groups
2421 @cindex marking groups
2422
2423 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2424 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2425 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2426 bidding on those groups.
2427
2428 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2429 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2430 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2431
2432 @table @kbd
2433
2434 @item #
2435 @kindex # (Group)
2436 @itemx M m
2437 @kindex M m (Group)
2438 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2439 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2440
2441 @item M-#
2442 @kindex M-# (Group)
2443 @itemx M u
2444 @kindex M u (Group)
2445 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2446 Remove the mark from the current group
2447 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2448
2449 @item M U
2450 @kindex M U (Group)
2451 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2452 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2453
2454 @item M w
2455 @kindex M w (Group)
2456 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2457 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2458
2459 @item M b
2460 @kindex M b (Group)
2461 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2462 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2463
2464 @item M r
2465 @kindex M r (Group)
2466 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2467 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2468 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2469 @end table
2470
2471 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2472
2473 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2474 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2475 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2476 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2477 the command to be executed.
2478
2479
2480 @node Foreign Groups
2481 @section Foreign Groups
2482 @cindex foreign groups
2483
2484 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2485 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2486 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2487 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2488 consulted.
2489
2490 @table @kbd
2491
2492 @item G m
2493 @kindex G m (Group)
2494 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2495 @cindex making groups
2496 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2497 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2498 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2499
2500 @item G M
2501 @kindex G M (Group)
2502 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2503 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2504 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2505
2506 @item G r
2507 @kindex G r (Group)
2508 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2509 @cindex renaming groups
2510 Rename the current group to something else
2511 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2512 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2513 on some back ends.
2514
2515 @item G c
2516 @kindex G c (Group)
2517 @cindex customizing
2518 @findex gnus-group-customize
2519 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2520
2521 @item G e
2522 @kindex G e (Group)
2523 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2524 @cindex renaming groups
2525 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2526 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2527
2528 @item G p
2529 @kindex G p (Group)
2530 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2531 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2532 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2533
2534 @item G E
2535 @kindex G E (Group)
2536 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2537 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2538 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2539
2540 @item G d
2541 @kindex G d (Group)
2542 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2543 @cindex nndir
2544 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2545 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2546
2547 @item G h
2548 @kindex G h (Group)
2549 @cindex help group
2550 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2551 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2552
2553 @item G a
2554 @kindex G a (Group)
2555 @cindex (ding) archive
2556 @cindex archive group
2557 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2558 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2559 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2560 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2561 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2562 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2563 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2564
2565 @item G k
2566 @kindex G k (Group)
2567 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2568 @cindex nnkiboze
2569 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2570 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2571 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2572 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2573
2574 @item G D
2575 @kindex G D (Group)
2576 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2577 @cindex nneething
2578 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2579 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2580 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2581
2582 @item G f
2583 @kindex G f (Group)
2584 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2585 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2586 @cindex nndoc
2587 Make a group based on some file or other
2588 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2589 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2590 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2591 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2592 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2593 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2594 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2595 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2596 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2597
2598 @item G u
2599 @kindex G u (Group)
2600 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2601 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2602 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2603 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2604
2605 @item G w
2606 @kindex G w (Group)
2607 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2608 @cindex Google
2609 @cindex nnweb
2610 @cindex gmane
2611 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2612 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2613 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2614 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2615 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2616 @xref{Web Searches}.
2617
2618 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2619 to a particular group by using a match string like
2620 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2621
2622 @item G R
2623 @kindex G R (Group)
2624 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2625 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2626 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2627 @xref{RSS}.
2628
2629 @item G DEL
2630 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2631 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2632 This function will delete the current group
2633 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2634 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2635 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2636 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2637 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2638
2639 @item G V
2640 @kindex G V (Group)
2641 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2642 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2643 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2644
2645 @item G v
2646 @kindex G v (Group)
2647 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2648 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2649 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2650 @end table
2651
2652 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2653 methods.
2654
2655 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2656 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2657 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2658 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2659 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2660 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2661 newsgroups.
2662
2663
2664 @node Group Parameters
2665 @section Group Parameters
2666 @cindex group parameters
2667
2668 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2669 Here's an example group parameter list:
2670
2671 @example
2672 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2673 (auto-expire . t))
2674 @end example
2675
2676 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2677 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2678 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2679 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2680
2681 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2682 is an alist of regexps and values.
2683
2684 The following group parameters can be used:
2685
2686 @table @code
2687 @item to-address
2688 @cindex to-address
2689 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2690
2691 @example
2692 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2693 @end example
2694
2695 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2696 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2697 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2698 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2699 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2700
2701 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2702 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2703 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2704 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2705 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2706 list address instead.
2707
2708 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2709
2710 @item to-list
2711 @cindex to-list
2712 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2713
2714 @example
2715 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2716 @end example
2717
2718 It is totally ignored
2719 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2720 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2721
2722 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2723 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2724 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2725 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2726 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2727
2728 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2729 @cindex mail list groups
2730 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2731 entering summary buffer.
2732
2733 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2734
2735 @anchor{subscribed}
2736 @item subscribed
2737 @cindex subscribed
2738 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2739 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2740 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2741 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2742 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2743 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2744 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2745 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2746
2747 @lisp
2748 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2749 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2750 @end lisp
2751
2752 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2753 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2754
2755 @item visible
2756 @cindex visible
2757 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2758 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2759 of whether it has any unread articles.
2760
2761 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2762 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2763
2764 @item broken-reply-to
2765 @cindex broken-reply-to
2766 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2767 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2768 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2769 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2770 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2771 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2772
2773 @item to-group
2774 @cindex to-group
2775 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2776 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2777
2778 @item newsgroup
2779 @cindex newsgroup
2780 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2781 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2782 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2783 news group.
2784
2785 @item gcc-self
2786 @cindex gcc-self
2787 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2788 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2789 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2790 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2791 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2792 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2793 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2794
2795 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2796 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2797 doesn't accept articles.
2798
2799 @item auto-expire
2800 @cindex auto-expire
2801 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2802 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2803 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2804
2805 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2806
2807 @item total-expire
2808 @cindex total-expire
2809 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2810 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2811 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2812 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2813 expiry.
2814
2815 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2816
2817 @item expiry-wait
2818 @cindex expiry-wait
2819 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2820 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2821 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2822 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2823 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2824 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2825 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2826
2827 @item expiry-target
2828 @cindex expiry-target
2829 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2830 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2831
2832 @item score-file
2833 @cindex score file group parameter
2834 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2835 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2836 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2837
2838 @item adapt-file
2839 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2840 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2841 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2842 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2843
2844 @item admin-address
2845 @cindex admin-address
2846 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2847 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2848 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2849 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2850
2851 @item display
2852 @cindex display
2853 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2854 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2855
2856 @table @code
2857 @item all
2858 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2859
2860 @item an integer
2861 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2862 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2863
2864 @item default
2865 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2866 ticked articles.
2867
2868 @item an array
2869 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2870
2871 Here are some examples:
2872
2873 @table @code
2874 @item [unread]
2875 Display only unread articles.
2876
2877 @item [not expire]
2878 Display everything except expirable articles.
2879
2880 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2881 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2882 responded to.
2883 @end table
2884
2885 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2886 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2887 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2888 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2889 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
2890
2891 @end table
2892
2893 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2894 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2895 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2896
2897 @item comment
2898 @cindex comment
2899 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2900 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2901 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2902
2903 @item charset
2904 @cindex charset
2905 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2906 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2907 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2908
2909 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2910
2911 @item ignored-charsets
2912 @cindex ignored-charset
2913 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
2914 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2915 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2916
2917 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2918
2919 @item posting-style
2920 @cindex posting-style
2921 You can store additional posting style information for this group
2922 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2923 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2924 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2925 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2926
2927 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2928 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2929 like this in the group parameters:
2930
2931 @example
2932 (posting-style
2933 (name "Funky Name")
2934 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
2935 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2936 @end example
2937
2938 @item post-method
2939 @cindex post-method
2940 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
2941 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
2942
2943 @item banner
2944 @cindex banner
2945 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
2946 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
2947 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
2948 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
2949 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
2950
2951 @item sieve
2952 @cindex sieve
2953 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
2954 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
2955 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
2956 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
2957
2958 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
2959 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
2960 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
2961 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
2962
2963 @example
2964 if address \"sender\" \"sieve-admin@@extundo.com\" @{
2965 fileinto \"INBOX.list.sieve\";
2966 @}
2967 @end example
2968
2969 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
2970 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
2971
2972 @item (agent parameters)
2973 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
2974 to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
2975 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
2976 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
2977 minimize the configuration effort.
2978
2979 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
2980 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
2981 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
2982 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
2983 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
2984 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
2985 @code{eval}ed there.
2986
2987 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer.
2988 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
2989 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
2990 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
2991 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
2992 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
2993 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
2994 @file{~/.gnus} file:
2995
2996 @lisp
2997 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
2998 @end lisp
2999
3000 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3001 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3002 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3003
3004 @example
3005 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3006 @end example
3007
3008 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3009 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3010 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3011 into the group parameters for the group.
3012
3013 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3014 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3015 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group.
3016 @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the (meaningless) result of the
3017 @code{(ding)} form.
3018
3019 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3020 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3021 following is added to a group parameter
3022
3023 @lisp
3024 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3025 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3026 @end lisp
3027
3028 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3029 expired.
3030
3031 @end table
3032
3033 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
3034 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
3035 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
3036 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
3037 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
3038
3039 @vindex gnus-parameters
3040 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3041 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3042 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3043 For example:
3044
3045 @lisp
3046 (setq gnus-parameters
3047 '(("mail\\..*"
3048 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3049 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3050 (gnus-summary-line-format
3051 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3052 (gcc-self . t)
3053 (display . all))
3054
3055 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3056 (to-group . "\\1"))
3057
3058 ("mail\\.me"
3059 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3060
3061 ("list\\..*"
3062 (total-expire . t)
3063 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3064 @end lisp
3065
3066 String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3067 the @code{to-group} example shows.
3068
3069 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3070 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3071 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3072 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3073 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3074 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3075 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3076 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3077 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3078 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3079 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3080 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3081
3082
3083 @node Listing Groups
3084 @section Listing Groups
3085 @cindex group listing
3086
3087 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3088
3089 @table @kbd
3090
3091 @item l
3092 @itemx A s
3093 @kindex A s (Group)
3094 @kindex l (Group)
3095 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3096 List all groups that have unread articles
3097 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3098 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3099 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3100 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3101 groups).
3102
3103 @item L
3104 @itemx A u
3105 @kindex A u (Group)
3106 @kindex L (Group)
3107 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3108 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3109 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3110 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3111 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3112 unsubscribed groups).
3113
3114 @item A l
3115 @kindex A l (Group)
3116 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3117 List all unread groups on a specific level
3118 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3119 with no unread articles.
3120
3121 @item A k
3122 @kindex A k (Group)
3123 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3124 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3125 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3126 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3127 from the server.
3128
3129 @item A z
3130 @kindex A z (Group)
3131 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3132 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3133
3134 @item A m
3135 @kindex A m (Group)
3136 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3137 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3138 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3139
3140 @item A M
3141 @kindex A M (Group)
3142 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3143 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3144
3145 @item A A
3146 @kindex A A (Group)
3147 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3148 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3149 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3150 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3151 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3152 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3153 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3154 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3155
3156 @item A a
3157 @kindex A a (Group)
3158 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3159 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3160 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3161
3162 @item A d
3163 @kindex A d (Group)
3164 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3165 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3166 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3167
3168 @item A c
3169 @kindex A c (Group)
3170 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3171 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3172
3173 @item A ?
3174 @kindex A ? (Group)
3175 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3176 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3177
3178 @item A /
3179 @kindex A / (Group)
3180 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3181 List groups limited within the current selection
3182 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3183
3184 @item A f
3185 @kindex A f (Group)
3186 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3187 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3188
3189 @item A p
3190 @kindex A p (Group)
3191 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3192 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3193
3194 @end table
3195
3196 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3197 @cindex visible group parameter
3198 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3199 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3200 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3201 get the same effect.
3202
3203 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3204 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3205 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3206 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3207 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3208
3209
3210 @node Sorting Groups
3211 @section Sorting Groups
3212 @cindex sorting groups
3213
3214 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3215 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3216 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3217 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3218 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3219 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3220 include:
3221
3222 @table @code
3223
3224 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3225 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3226 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3227
3228 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3229 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3230 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3231
3232 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3233 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3234 Sort by group level.
3235
3236 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3237 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3238 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3239
3240 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3241 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3242 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3243 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3244
3245 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3246 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3247 Sort by number of unread articles.
3248
3249 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3250 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3251 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3252
3253 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3254 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3255 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3256
3257
3258 @end table
3259
3260 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3261 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3262 the last one.
3263
3264
3265 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3266 some sorting criteria:
3267
3268 @table @kbd
3269 @item G S a
3270 @kindex G S a (Group)
3271 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3272 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3273 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3274
3275 @item G S u
3276 @kindex G S u (Group)
3277 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3278 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3279 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3280
3281 @item G S l
3282 @kindex G S l (Group)
3283 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3284 Sort the group buffer by group level
3285 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3286
3287 @item G S v
3288 @kindex G S v (Group)
3289 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3290 Sort the group buffer by group score
3291 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3292
3293 @item G S r
3294 @kindex G S r (Group)
3295 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3296 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3297 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3298
3299 @item G S m
3300 @kindex G S m (Group)
3301 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3302 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3303 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3304
3305 @item G S n
3306 @kindex G S n (Group)
3307 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3308 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3309 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3310
3311 @end table
3312
3313 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3314 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3315
3316 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3317 commands will sort in reverse order.
3318
3319 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3320
3321 @table @kbd
3322 @item G P a
3323 @kindex G P a (Group)
3324 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3325 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3326 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3327
3328 @item G P u
3329 @kindex G P u (Group)
3330 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3331 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3332 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3333
3334 @item G P l
3335 @kindex G P l (Group)
3336 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3337 Sort the groups by group level
3338 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3339
3340 @item G P v
3341 @kindex G P v (Group)
3342 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3343 Sort the groups by group score
3344 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3345
3346 @item G P r
3347 @kindex G P r (Group)
3348 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3349 Sort the groups by group rank
3350 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3351
3352 @item G P m
3353 @kindex G P m (Group)
3354 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3355 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3356 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3357
3358 @item G P n
3359 @kindex G P n (Group)
3360 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3361 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3362 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3363
3364 @item G P s
3365 @kindex G P s (Group)
3366 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3367 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3368
3369 @end table
3370
3371 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3372 move groups around.
3373
3374
3375 @node Group Maintenance
3376 @section Group Maintenance
3377 @cindex bogus groups
3378
3379 @table @kbd
3380 @item b
3381 @kindex b (Group)
3382 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3383 Find bogus groups and delete them
3384 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3385
3386 @item F
3387 @kindex F (Group)
3388 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3389 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3390 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3391 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3392 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3393 zombies.
3394
3395 @item C-c C-x
3396 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3397 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3398 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3399 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3400 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3401 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3402
3403 @item C-c C-M-x
3404 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3405 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3406 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3407 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3408
3409 @end table
3410
3411
3412 @node Browse Foreign Server
3413 @section Browse Foreign Server
3414 @cindex foreign servers
3415 @cindex browsing servers
3416
3417 @table @kbd
3418 @item B
3419 @kindex B (Group)
3420 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3421 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3422 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3423 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3424 @end table
3425
3426 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3427 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3428 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3429 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3430
3431 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3432
3433 @table @kbd
3434 @item n
3435 @kindex n (Browse)
3436 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3437 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3438
3439 @item p
3440 @kindex p (Browse)
3441 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3442 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3443
3444 @item SPACE
3445 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3446 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3447 Enter the current group and display the first article
3448 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3449
3450 @item RET
3451 @kindex RET (Browse)
3452 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3453 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3454
3455 @item u
3456 @kindex u (Browse)
3457 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3458 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3459 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3460
3461 @item l
3462 @itemx q
3463 @kindex q (Browse)
3464 @kindex l (Browse)
3465 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3466 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3467
3468 @item d
3469 @kindex d (Browse)
3470 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3471 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3472
3473 @item ?
3474 @kindex ? (Browse)
3475 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3476 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3477 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3478 @end table
3479
3480
3481 @node Exiting Gnus
3482 @section Exiting Gnus
3483 @cindex exiting Gnus
3484
3485 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3486
3487 @table @kbd
3488 @item z
3489 @kindex z (Group)
3490 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3491 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3492 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3493 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3494
3495 @item q
3496 @kindex q (Group)
3497 @findex gnus-group-exit
3498 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3499 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3500
3501 @item Q
3502 @kindex Q (Group)
3503 @findex gnus-group-quit
3504 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3505 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3506 @end table
3507
3508 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3509 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3510 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3511 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3512 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3513 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3514 exiting Gnus.
3515
3516 Note:
3517
3518 @quotation
3519 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3520 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3521 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3522 plastic chair.
3523 @end quotation
3524
3525
3526 @node Group Topics
3527 @section Group Topics
3528 @cindex topics
3529
3530 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3531 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3532 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3533 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3534 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3535 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3536
3537 @iftex
3538 @iflatex
3539 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3540 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3541 }
3542 @end iflatex
3543 @end iftex
3544
3545 Here's an example:
3546
3547 @example
3548 Gnus
3549 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3550 3: comp.emacs
3551 2: alt.religion.emacs
3552 Naughty Emacs
3553 452: alt.sex.emacs
3554 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3555 Misc
3556 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3557 13: comp.sources.unix
3558 @end example
3559
3560 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3561 @kindex t (Group)
3562 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3563 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3564 is a toggling command.)
3565
3566 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3567 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3568 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3569 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3570 Hot and bothered?
3571
3572 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3573 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3574 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3575
3576 @lisp
3577 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3578 @end lisp
3579
3580 @menu
3581 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3582 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3583 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3584 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3585 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3586 @end menu
3587
3588
3589 @node Topic Commands
3590 @subsection Topic Commands
3591 @cindex topic commands
3592
3593 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3594 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3595 definitions slightly.
3596
3597 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3598 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3599 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3600 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3601 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3602 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3603
3604 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3605 the way you like.
3606
3607 @table @kbd
3608
3609 @item T n
3610 @kindex T n (Topic)
3611 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3612 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3613 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3614
3615 @item T TAB
3616 @itemx TAB
3617 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3618 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3619 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3620 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3621 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3622 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3623
3624 @item M-TAB
3625 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3626 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3627 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3628 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3629
3630 @end table
3631
3632 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3633 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3634 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3635 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3636
3637 @table @kbd
3638
3639 @item C-k
3640 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3641 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3642 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3643 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3644
3645 @item C-y
3646 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3647 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3648 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3649 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3650 before all groups.
3651
3652 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3653 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3654 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3655 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3656 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3657
3658 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3659 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3660
3661 @end table
3662
3663 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3664 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3665 key.
3666
3667 @table @kbd
3668
3669 @item RET
3670 @kindex RET (Topic)
3671 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3672 @itemx SPACE
3673 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3674 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3675 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3676 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3677 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3678 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3679
3680 @end table
3681
3682 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3683
3684 @table @kbd
3685
3686 @item T m
3687 @kindex T m (Topic)
3688 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3689 Move the current group to some other topic
3690 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3691 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3692
3693 @item T j
3694 @kindex T j (Topic)
3695 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3696 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3697
3698 @item T c
3699 @kindex T c (Topic)
3700 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3701 Copy the current group to some other topic
3702 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3703 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3704
3705 @item T h
3706 @kindex T h (Topic)
3707 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3708 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3709 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3710
3711 @item T s
3712 @kindex T s (Topic)
3713 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3714 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3715 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3716
3717 @item T D
3718 @kindex T D (Topic)
3719 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3720 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3721 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3722 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3723 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3724 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3725 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3726 topic.
3727
3728 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3729 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3730
3731 @item T M
3732 @kindex T M (Topic)
3733 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3734 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3735 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3736
3737 @item T C
3738 @kindex T C (Topic)
3739 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3740 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3741 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3742
3743 @item T H
3744 @kindex T H (Topic)
3745 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3746 Toggle hiding empty topics
3747 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3748
3749 @item T #
3750 @kindex T # (Topic)
3751 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3752 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3753 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3754 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3755
3756 @item T M-#
3757 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3758 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3759 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3760 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3761 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3762
3763 @item C-c C-x
3764 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3765 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3766 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3767 expiry process (if any)
3768 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3769
3770 @item T r
3771 @kindex T r (Topic)
3772 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3773 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3774
3775 @item T DEL
3776 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3777 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3778 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3779
3780 @item A T
3781 @kindex A T (Topic)
3782 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3783 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3784 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3785
3786 @item T M-n
3787 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3788 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3789 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3790
3791 @item T M-p
3792 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3793 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3794 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3795
3796 @item G p
3797 @kindex G p (Topic)
3798 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3799 @cindex group parameters
3800 @cindex topic parameters
3801 @cindex parameters
3802 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3803 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3804
3805 @end table
3806
3807
3808 @node Topic Variables
3809 @subsection Topic Variables
3810 @cindex topic variables
3811
3812 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3813 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3814
3815 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3816 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3817 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3818 Valid elements are:
3819
3820 @table @samp
3821 @item i
3822 Indentation.
3823 @item n
3824 Topic name.
3825 @item v
3826 Visibility.
3827 @item l
3828 Level.
3829 @item g
3830 Number of groups in the topic.
3831 @item a
3832 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3833 @item A
3834 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3835 @end table
3836
3837 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3838 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3839 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3840 The default is 2.
3841
3842 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3843 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3844
3845 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3846 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3847 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3848
3849
3850 @node Topic Sorting
3851 @subsection Topic Sorting
3852 @cindex topic sorting
3853
3854 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3855 commands:
3856
3857
3858 @table @kbd
3859 @item T S a
3860 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3861 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3862 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3863 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3864
3865 @item T S u
3866 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3867 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3868 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3869 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3870
3871 @item T S l
3872 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3873 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3874 Sort the current topic by group level
3875 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3876
3877 @item T S v
3878 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3879 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3880 Sort the current topic by group score
3881 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3882
3883 @item T S r
3884 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3885 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3886 Sort the current topic by group rank
3887 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3888
3889 @item T S m
3890 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3891 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3892 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
3893 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3894
3895 @item T S e
3896 @kindex T S e (Topic)
3897 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
3898 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
3899 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
3900
3901 @item T S s
3902 @kindex T S s (Topic)
3903 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
3904 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
3905 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
3906 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
3907
3908 @end table
3909
3910 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
3911 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
3912 sorting.
3913
3914
3915 @node Topic Topology
3916 @subsection Topic Topology
3917 @cindex topic topology
3918 @cindex topology
3919
3920 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3921
3922 @example
3923 @group
3924 Gnus
3925 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3926 3: comp.emacs
3927 2: alt.religion.emacs
3928 Naughty Emacs
3929 452: alt.sex.emacs
3930 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3931 Misc
3932 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3933 13: comp.sources.unix
3934 @end group
3935 @end example
3936
3937 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3938 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3939 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3940 follows:
3941
3942 @lisp
3943 (("Gnus" visible)
3944 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
3945 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
3946 (("Misc" visible)))
3947 @end lisp
3948
3949 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
3950 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
3951 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
3952 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
3953 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
3954 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
3955
3956 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
3957 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
3958 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
3959
3960
3961 @node Topic Parameters
3962 @subsection Topic Parameters
3963 @cindex topic parameters
3964
3965 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
3966 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
3967 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
3968 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
3969 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
3970
3971 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
3972 parameters:
3973
3974 @table @code
3975 @item subscribe
3976 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
3977 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
3978 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
3979 topic.
3980
3981 @item subscribe-level
3982 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
3983 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
3984 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
3985
3986 @end table
3987
3988 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
3989 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
3990 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
3991 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
3992
3993 @example
3994 @group
3995 Gnus
3996 Emacs
3997 3: comp.emacs
3998 2: alt.religion.emacs
3999 452: alt.sex.emacs
4000 Relief
4001 452: alt.sex.emacs
4002 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4003 Misc
4004 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4005 13: comp.sources.unix
4006 452: alt.sex.emacs
4007 @end group
4008 @end example
4009
4010 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4011 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4012 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4013 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4014 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4015 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4016
4017 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4018 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4019 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4020 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4021 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4022
4023 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4024 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4025 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4026 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4027 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4028 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4029 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4030 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4031
4032
4033 @node Misc Group Stuff
4034 @section Misc Group Stuff
4035
4036 @menu
4037 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4038 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4039 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4040 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4041 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4042 @end menu
4043
4044 @table @kbd
4045
4046 @item ^
4047 @kindex ^ (Group)
4048 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4049 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4050 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4051
4052 @item a
4053 @kindex a (Group)
4054 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4055 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4056 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4057 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4058 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4059 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4060 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4061
4062 @item m
4063 @kindex m (Group)
4064 @findex gnus-group-mail
4065 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4066 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4067 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4068 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4069
4070 @item i
4071 @kindex i (Group)
4072 @findex gnus-group-news
4073 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4074 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4075 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4076
4077 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4078 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4079 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4080 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4081 for this to work though.
4082
4083 @end table
4084
4085 Variables for the group buffer:
4086
4087 @table @code
4088
4089 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4090 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4091 is called after the group buffer has been
4092 created.
4093
4094 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4095 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4096 is called after the group buffer is
4097 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4098 unnatural way.
4099
4100 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4101 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4102 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4103 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4104
4105 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4106 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4107 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4108 whether they are empty or not.
4109
4110 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4111 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4112 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
4113 non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4114
4115 For example:
4116 @lisp
4117 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4118 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4119 @end lisp
4120
4121 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4122 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4123 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4124 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names. It
4125 is used to show non-@acronym{ASCII} group names. @code{((".*"
4126 utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported, otherwise the
4127 default is @code{nil}.
4128
4129 For example:
4130 @lisp
4131 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4132 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
4133 @end lisp
4134
4135 @end table
4136
4137 @node Scanning New Messages
4138 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4139 @cindex new messages
4140 @cindex scanning new news
4141
4142 @table @kbd
4143
4144 @item g
4145 @kindex g (Group)
4146 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4147 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4148 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4149 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4150 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4151 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4152 back end(s).
4153
4154 @item M-g
4155 @kindex M-g (Group)
4156 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4157 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4158 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4159 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4160 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4161 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4162 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4163
4164 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4165 @cindex activating groups
4166 @item C-c M-g
4167 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4168 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4169
4170 @item R
4171 @kindex R (Group)
4172 @cindex restarting
4173 @findex gnus-group-restart
4174 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4175 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4176 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4177
4178 @end table
4179
4180 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4181 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4182
4183 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4184 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4185 news.
4186
4187
4188 @node Group Information
4189 @subsection Group Information
4190 @cindex group information
4191 @cindex information on groups
4192
4193 @table @kbd
4194
4195
4196 @item H f
4197 @kindex H f (Group)
4198 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
4199 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
4200 @cindex FAQ
4201 @cindex ange-ftp
4202 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
4203 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
4204 from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
4205 a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
4206 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
4207 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
4208 used for fetching the file.
4209
4210 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
4211 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
4212
4213 @item H c
4214 @kindex H c (Group)
4215 @findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
4216 @vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
4217 @cindex charter
4218 Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
4219 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
4220 prefix argument.
4221
4222 Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
4223 the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
4224 messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
4225
4226 @item H C
4227 @kindex H C (Group)
4228 @findex gnus-group-fetch-control
4229 @vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
4230 @cindex control message
4231 Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
4232 @code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
4233 group if given a prefix argument.
4234
4235 If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
4236 Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
4237 @code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
4238 and displayed in an ephemeral group.
4239
4240 Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
4241 you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
4242 Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
4243
4244 @item H d
4245 @itemx C-c C-d
4246 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4247 @kindex H d (Group)
4248 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4249 @cindex describing groups
4250 @cindex group description
4251 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4252 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4253 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4254
4255 @item M-d
4256 @kindex M-d (Group)
4257 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4258 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4259 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4260
4261 @item H v
4262 @itemx V
4263 @kindex V (Group)
4264 @kindex H v (Group)
4265 @cindex version
4266 @findex gnus-version
4267 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4268
4269 @item ?
4270 @kindex ? (Group)
4271 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4272 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4273
4274 @item C-c C-i
4275 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4276 @cindex info
4277 @cindex manual
4278 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4279 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4280 @end table
4281
4282
4283 @node Group Timestamp
4284 @subsection Group Timestamp
4285 @cindex timestamps
4286 @cindex group timestamps
4287
4288 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4289 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4290 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4291
4292 @lisp
4293 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4294 @end lisp
4295
4296 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4297
4298 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4299 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4300
4301 @lisp
4302 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4303 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4304 @end lisp
4305
4306 This will result in lines looking like:
4307
4308 @example
4309 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4310 0: custom 19961002T012713
4311 @end example
4312
4313 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4314 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4315 something like:
4316
4317 @lisp
4318 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4319 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4320 @end lisp
4321
4322 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4323 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4324 trick:
4325
4326 @lisp
4327 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4328 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4329 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4330 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4331 (if time
4332 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4333 "")))
4334 @end lisp
4335
4336
4337 @node File Commands
4338 @subsection File Commands
4339 @cindex file commands
4340
4341 @table @kbd
4342
4343 @item r
4344 @kindex r (Group)
4345 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4346 @vindex gnus-init-file
4347 @cindex reading init file
4348 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4349 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4350
4351 @item s
4352 @kindex s (Group)
4353 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4354 @cindex saving .newsrc
4355 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4356 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4357 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4358
4359 @c @item Z
4360 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4361 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4362 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4363
4364 @end table
4365
4366
4367 @node Sieve Commands
4368 @subsection Sieve Commands
4369 @cindex group sieve commands
4370
4371 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4372 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4373 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4374 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4375 script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
4376
4377 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4378 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4379 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4380 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4381 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4382 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4383 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4384 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4385 regenerate the Sieve script.
4386
4387 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4388 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4389 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4390 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4391 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4392 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4393 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4394 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4395 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4396 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4397
4398 @example
4399 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4400 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4401 stop;
4402 @}
4403 @end example
4404
4405 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4406
4407 @table @kbd
4408
4409 @item D g
4410 @kindex D g (Group)
4411 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4412 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4413 @cindex generating sieve script
4414 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4415 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4416
4417 @item D u
4418 @kindex D u (Group)
4419 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4420 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4421 @cindex updating sieve script
4422 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4423 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4424 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4425
4426 @end table
4427
4428
4429 @node Summary Buffer
4430 @chapter Summary Buffer
4431 @cindex summary buffer
4432
4433 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4434 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4435
4436 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4437 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4438
4439 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4440
4441 @menu
4442 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4443 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4444 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4445 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4446 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4447 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4448 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4449 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4450 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4451 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4452 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4453 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4454 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4455 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4456 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4457 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4458 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4459 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4460 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4461 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4462 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4463 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4464 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4465 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4466 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4467 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4468 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4469 or reselecting the current group.
4470 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4471 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4472 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4473 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4474 @end menu
4475
4476
4477 @node Summary Buffer Format
4478 @section Summary Buffer Format
4479 @cindex summary buffer format
4480
4481 @iftex
4482 @iflatex
4483 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4484 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4485 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4486 }
4487 @end iflatex
4488 @end iftex
4489
4490 @menu
4491 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4492 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4493 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4494 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4495 @end menu
4496
4497 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4498 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4499 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4500 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4501 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4502 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4503 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4504 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4505 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4506 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4507 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4508
4509 @lisp
4510 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4511 'mail-extract-address-components)
4512 @end lisp
4513
4514 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4515 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4516 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4517 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4518
4519
4520 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4521 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4522
4523 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4524 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4525 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4526 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4527 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4528
4529 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4530 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4531 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4532 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4533 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4534 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4535
4536 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4537
4538 The following format specification characters and extended format
4539 specification(s) are understood:
4540
4541 @table @samp
4542 @item N
4543 Article number.
4544 @item S
4545 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4546 @code{gnus-list-identifies}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4547 @item s
4548 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4549 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4550 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4551 @item F
4552 Full @code{From} header.
4553 @item n
4554 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4555 @item f
4556 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4557 From Newsgroups}).
4558 @item a
4559 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4560 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4561 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4562 may be more thorough.
4563 @item A
4564 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4565 the @code{a} spec.
4566 @item L
4567 Number of lines in the article.
4568 @item c
4569 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4570 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4571 @item k
4572 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4573 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4574 @item I
4575 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4576 @item B
4577 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4578 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4579
4580 @example
4581 >
4582 +->
4583 | +->
4584 | | \->
4585 | | \->
4586 | \->
4587 +->
4588 \->
4589 @end example
4590
4591 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4592 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4593 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4594 line-drawing glyphs.
4595 @table @code
4596 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4597 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4598 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4599 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4600
4601 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4602 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4603 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4604 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4605
4606 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4607 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4608 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4609 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4610
4611 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4612 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4613 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4614
4615 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4616 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4617 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4618
4619 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4620 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4621 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4622
4623 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4624 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4625 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4626
4627 @end table
4628
4629 @item T
4630 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4631 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4632 @item [
4633 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4634 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4635 @item ]
4636 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4637 for adopted articles.
4638 @item >
4639 One space for each thread level.
4640 @item <
4641 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4642 @item U
4643 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4644
4645 @item R
4646 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4647 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4648 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4649
4650 @item i
4651 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4652 @item z
4653 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4654 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4655 default level. If the difference between
4656 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4657 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4658 @item V
4659 Total thread score.
4660 @item x
4661 @code{Xref}.
4662 @item D
4663 @code{Date}.
4664 @item d
4665 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4666 @item o
4667 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4668 @item M
4669 @code{Message-ID}.
4670 @item r
4671 @code{References}.
4672 @item t
4673 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4674 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4675 @item e
4676 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4677 article has any children.
4678 @item P
4679 The line number.
4680 @item O
4681 Download mark.
4682 @item *
4683 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4684 @item &user-date;
4685 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4686 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4687 @item u
4688 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4689 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4690 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4691 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4692 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4693 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4694 @end table
4695
4696 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4697 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4698 There can only be one such area.
4699
4700 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4701 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4702 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4703 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4704 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4705 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4706
4707 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4708 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4709
4710 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4711
4712
4713 @node To From Newsgroups
4714 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4715 @cindex To
4716 @cindex Newsgroups
4717
4718 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4719 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4720 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4721 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4722 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4723
4724 @enumerate
4725 @item
4726 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4727 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4728 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4729 instance:
4730
4731 @lisp
4732 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4733 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4734 @end lisp
4735
4736 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4737 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4738
4739 @item
4740 @findex gnus-extra-header
4741 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4742 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4743 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4744
4745 @example
4746 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4747 @end example
4748
4749 @item
4750 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4751 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4752 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4753 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4754 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4755 headers are used instead.
4756
4757 @end enumerate
4758
4759 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4760 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4761 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
4762 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
4763 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
4764 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
4765 regeneration.
4766
4767 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4768 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4769 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4770 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4771
4772 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
4773 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
4774
4775 @lisp
4776 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4777 '(To Newsgroups))
4778 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4779 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4780 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
4781 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4782 "Your Name Here")
4783 @end lisp
4784
4785 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
4786 to fit your needs.)
4787
4788 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
4789 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
4790 support:
4791
4792 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4793 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4794 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
4795
4796 @example
4797 Newsgroups:full
4798 @end example
4799
4800 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4801 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4802
4803
4804 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4805 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4806
4807 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4808 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4809 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4810 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4811
4812 Here are the elements you can play with:
4813
4814 @table @samp
4815 @item G
4816 Group name.
4817 @item p
4818 Unprefixed group name.
4819 @item A
4820 Current article number.
4821 @item z
4822 Current article score.
4823 @item V
4824 Gnus version.
4825 @item U
4826 Number of unread articles in this group.
4827 @item e
4828 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4829 summary buffer.
4830 @item Z
4831 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4832 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4833 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4834 and no unselected ones.
4835 @item g
4836 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4837 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4838 @item S
4839 Subject of the current article.
4840 @item u
4841 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4842 @item s
4843 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4844 @item d
4845 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4846 @item t
4847 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4848 @item r
4849 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4850 @item E
4851 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4852 @end table
4853
4854
4855 @node Summary Highlighting
4856 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4857
4858 @table @code
4859
4860 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4861 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4862 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4863 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4864 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4865
4866 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4867 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4868 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4869 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4870
4871 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4872 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4873 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4874 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4875
4876 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4877 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4878 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4879 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4880 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4881 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4882 to something like
4883 @lisp
4884 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4885 ((> score default) . bold))
4886 @end lisp
4887 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4888 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4889 @end table
4890
4891
4892 @node Summary Maneuvering
4893 @section Summary Maneuvering
4894 @cindex summary movement
4895
4896 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4897 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4898
4899 None of these commands select articles.
4900
4901 @table @kbd
4902 @item G M-n
4903 @itemx M-n
4904 @kindex M-n (Summary)
4905 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
4906 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4907 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4908 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4909
4910 @item G M-p
4911 @itemx M-p
4912 @kindex M-p (Summary)
4913 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
4914 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4915 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
4916 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4917
4918 @item G g
4919 @kindex G g (Summary)
4920 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
4921 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
4922 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
4923 @end table
4924
4925 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
4926 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
4927 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
4928 to the group buffer.
4929
4930 Variables related to summary movement:
4931
4932 @table @code
4933
4934 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
4935 @item gnus-auto-select-next
4936 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
4937 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
4938 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
4939 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
4940 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
4941 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
4942 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
4943 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
4944 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
4945 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
4946 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
4947 @pxref{Group Levels}.
4948
4949 @item gnus-auto-select-same
4950 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
4951 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
4952 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
4953 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
4954 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
4955 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
4956
4957 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
4958
4959 @item gnus-summary-check-current
4960 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
4961 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
4962 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
4963 Instead, they will choose the current article.
4964
4965 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
4966 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
4967 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
4968 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
4969 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
4970 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
4971 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
4972 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
4973 threads.
4974
4975 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
4976 the given number of lines from the top.
4977
4978 @end table
4979
4980
4981 @node Choosing Articles
4982 @section Choosing Articles
4983 @cindex selecting articles
4984
4985 @menu
4986 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
4987 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
4988 @end menu
4989
4990
4991 @node Choosing Commands
4992 @subsection Choosing Commands
4993
4994 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
4995 and they all select and display an article.
4996
4997 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
4998 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
4999
5000 @table @kbd
5001 @item SPACE
5002 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5003 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5004 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5005 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5006
5007 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5008 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5009 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5010
5011 @item G n
5012 @itemx n
5013 @kindex n (Summary)
5014 @kindex G n (Summary)
5015 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5016 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5017 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5018
5019 @item G p
5020 @itemx p
5021 @kindex p (Summary)
5022 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5023 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5024 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5025
5026 @item G N
5027 @itemx N
5028 @kindex N (Summary)
5029 @kindex G N (Summary)
5030 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5031 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5032
5033 @item G P
5034 @itemx P
5035 @kindex P (Summary)
5036 @kindex G P (Summary)
5037 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5038 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5039
5040 @item G C-n
5041 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5042 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5043 Go to the next article with the same subject
5044 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5045
5046 @item G C-p
5047 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5048 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5049 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5050 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5051
5052 @item G f
5053 @itemx .
5054 @kindex G f (Summary)
5055 @kindex . (Summary)
5056 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5057 Go to the first unread article
5058 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5059
5060 @item G b
5061 @itemx ,
5062 @kindex G b (Summary)
5063 @kindex , (Summary)
5064 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5065 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5066 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5067 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5068
5069 @item G l
5070 @itemx l
5071 @kindex l (Summary)
5072 @kindex G l (Summary)
5073 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5074 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5075
5076 @item G o
5077 @kindex G o (Summary)
5078 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5079 @cindex history
5080 @cindex article history
5081 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5082 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5083 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5084 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5085 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5086 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5087
5088 @item G j
5089 @itemx j
5090 @kindex j (Summary)
5091 @kindex G j (Summary)
5092 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5093 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5094 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5095
5096 @end table
5097
5098
5099 @node Choosing Variables
5100 @subsection Choosing Variables
5101
5102 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5103
5104 @table @code
5105 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5106 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5107 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5108 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5109 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5110 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5111
5112 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5113 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5114 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5115 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5116 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5117 hook will do so.
5118
5119 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5120 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5121 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5122 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5123 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5124 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5125 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5126 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5127 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5128 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5129 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5130 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5131 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5132 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5133
5134 @end table
5135
5136
5137 @node Paging the Article
5138 @section Scrolling the Article
5139 @cindex article scrolling
5140
5141 @table @kbd
5142
5143 @item SPACE
5144 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5145 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5146 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5147 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5148 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5149
5150 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5151 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5152 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5153 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5154 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5155 what is considered uninteresting with
5156 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5157 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5158
5159 @item DEL
5160 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5161 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5162 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5163
5164 @item RET
5165 @kindex RET (Summary)
5166 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5167 Scroll the current article one line forward
5168 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5169
5170 @item M-RET
5171 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5172 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5173 Scroll the current article one line backward
5174 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5175
5176 @item A g
5177 @itemx g
5178 @kindex A g (Summary)
5179 @kindex g (Summary)
5180 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5181 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5182 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5183 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
5184 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
5185 the way it came from the server.
5186
5187 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5188 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5189 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5190
5191 @lisp
5192 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5193 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5194 (2 . big5)))
5195 @end lisp
5196
5197 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5198
5199 @item A <
5200 @itemx <
5201 @kindex < (Summary)
5202 @kindex A < (Summary)
5203 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5204 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5205 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5206
5207 @item A >
5208 @itemx >
5209 @kindex > (Summary)
5210 @kindex A > (Summary)
5211 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5212 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5213
5214 @item A s
5215 @itemx s
5216 @kindex A s (Summary)
5217 @kindex s (Summary)
5218 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5219 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5220 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5221
5222 @item h
5223 @kindex h (Summary)
5224 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5225 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5226
5227 @end table
5228
5229
5230 @node Reply Followup and Post
5231 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5232
5233 @menu
5234 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5235 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5236 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5237 * Canceling and Superseding::
5238 @end menu
5239
5240
5241 @node Summary Mail Commands
5242 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5243 @cindex mail
5244 @cindex composing mail
5245
5246 Commands for composing a mail message:
5247
5248 @table @kbd
5249
5250 @item S r
5251 @itemx r
5252 @kindex S r (Summary)
5253 @kindex r (Summary)
5254 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5255 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5256 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5257 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5258 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5259
5260 @item S R
5261 @itemx R
5262 @kindex R (Summary)
5263 @kindex S R (Summary)
5264 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5265 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5266 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5267 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5268 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5269
5270 @item S w
5271 @kindex S w (Summary)
5272 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5273 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5274 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5275 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5276 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5277 present, that's used instead.
5278
5279 @item S W
5280 @kindex S W (Summary)
5281 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5282 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5283 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5284 the process/prefix convention.
5285
5286 @item S v
5287 @kindex S v (Summary)
5288 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5289 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5290 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5291 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5292 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5293 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5294
5295 @item S V
5296 @kindex S V (Summary)
5297 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5298 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5299 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5300 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5301
5302 @item S B r
5303 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5304 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5305 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5306 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5307 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5308 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5309 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5310 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5311
5312 @item S B R
5313 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5314 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5315 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5316 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5317 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5318
5319 @item S o m
5320 @itemx C-c C-f
5321 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5322 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5323 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5324 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5325 Forward the current article to some other person
5326 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5327 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5328 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5329 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5330 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5331 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5332 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5333 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5334 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5335 section.
5336
5337 @item S m
5338 @itemx m
5339 @kindex m (Summary)
5340 @kindex S m (Summary)
5341 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5342 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5343 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5344 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5345 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5346
5347 @item S i
5348 @itemx i
5349 @kindex i (Summary)
5350 @kindex S i (Summary)
5351 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5352 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5353 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5354 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5355
5356 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5357 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5358 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5359 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5360 for this to work though.
5361
5362 @item S D b
5363 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5364 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5365 @cindex bouncing mail
5366 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5367 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5368 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5369 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5370 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5371 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5372 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5373 very well fail, though.
5374
5375 @item S D r
5376 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5377 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5378 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5379 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5380 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5381 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5382 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5383 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5384 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5385 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5386
5387 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5388 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5389 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5390 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5391 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5392
5393 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5394 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5395
5396 @item S D e
5397 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5398 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5399
5400 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5401 if it were a new message before resending.
5402
5403 @item S O m
5404 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5405 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5406 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5407 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5408 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5409
5410 @item S M-c
5411 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5412 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5413 @cindex crossposting
5414 @cindex excessive crossposting
5415 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5416 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5417
5418 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5419 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5420 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5421 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5422 command understands the process/prefix convention
5423 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5424
5425 @end table
5426
5427 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5428 Manual}, for more information.
5429
5430
5431 @node Summary Post Commands
5432 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5433 @cindex post
5434 @cindex composing news
5435
5436 Commands for posting a news article:
5437
5438 @table @kbd
5439 @item S p
5440 @itemx a
5441 @kindex a (Summary)
5442 @kindex S p (Summary)
5443 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5444 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5445 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5446 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5447 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5448
5449 @item S f
5450 @itemx f
5451 @kindex f (Summary)
5452 @kindex S f (Summary)
5453 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5454 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5455 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5456
5457 @item S F
5458 @itemx F
5459 @kindex S F (Summary)
5460 @kindex F (Summary)
5461 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5462 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5463 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5464 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5465 process/prefix convention.
5466
5467 @item S n
5468 @kindex S n (Summary)
5469 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5470 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5471 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5472
5473 @item S N
5474 @kindex S N (Summary)
5475 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5476 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5477 message through mail and include the original message
5478 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5479 the process/prefix convention.
5480
5481 @item S o p
5482 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5483 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5484 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5485 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5486 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5487 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5488 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5489 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5490 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5491 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5492 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5493 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5494 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5495
5496 @item S O p
5497 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5498 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5499 @cindex digests
5500 @cindex making digests
5501 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5502 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5503 process/prefix convention.
5504
5505 @item S u
5506 @kindex S u (Summary)
5507 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5508 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5509 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5510 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5511 @end table
5512
5513 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5514 Manual}, for more information.
5515
5516
5517 @node Summary Message Commands
5518 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5519
5520 @table @kbd
5521 @item S y
5522 @kindex S y (Summary)
5523 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5524 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5525 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5526 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5527 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5528
5529 @end table
5530
5531
5532 @node Canceling and Superseding
5533 @subsection Canceling Articles
5534 @cindex canceling articles
5535 @cindex superseding articles
5536
5537 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5538 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5539
5540 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5541
5542 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5543 @kindex C (Summary)
5544 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5545 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5546 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5547 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5548 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5549 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5550
5551 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5552 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5553 question.
5554
5555 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5556 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5557 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5558
5559 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5560 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5561 message, Message Manual}).
5562
5563 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5564 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5565 your original article.
5566
5567 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5568 @kindex S (Summary)
5569 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5570 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5571 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5572 usual way.
5573
5574 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5575 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5576 have posted almost the same article twice.
5577
5578 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5579 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5580 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5581 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5582 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5583 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5584 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5585 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5586 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5587 canceled/superseded.
5588
5589 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5590
5591 @node Delayed Articles
5592 @section Delayed Articles
5593 @cindex delayed sending
5594 @cindex send delayed
5595
5596 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5597 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5598 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5599 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5600
5601 @lisp
5602 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5603 @end lisp
5604
5605 @findex gnus-delay-article
5606 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5607 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5608 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5609 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5610
5611 @itemize @bullet
5612 @item
5613 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5614 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5615 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5616 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5617
5618 @item
5619 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5620 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5621 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5622
5623 @item
5624 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5625 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5626 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5627 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5628 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5629 that means a time tomorrow.
5630 @end itemize
5631
5632 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5633 couple of variables:
5634
5635 @table @code
5636 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5637 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5638 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5639 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5640
5641 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5642 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5643 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5644 formats described above.
5645
5646 @item gnus-delay-group
5647 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5648 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5649 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5650 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5651
5652 @item gnus-delay-header
5653 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5654 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5655 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5656 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5657 @end table
5658
5659 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5660 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5661 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5662 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5663 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5664
5665 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5666 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5667 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5668 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5669 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5670 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5671 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5672
5673 @table @code
5674 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5675 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5676 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5677 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5678 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5679 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5680 argument is ignored.
5681
5682 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5683 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5684 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5685 @end table
5686
5687
5688 @node Marking Articles
5689 @section Marking Articles
5690 @cindex article marking
5691 @cindex article ticking
5692 @cindex marks
5693
5694 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5695
5696 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5697 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5698 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5699
5700 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5701
5702 @ifinfo
5703 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5704 @end ifinfo
5705
5706 @menu
5707 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5708 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
5709 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
5710 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
5711 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
5712 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
5713 @end menu
5714
5715
5716 @node Unread Articles
5717 @subsection Unread Articles
5718
5719 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
5720 other.
5721
5722 @table @samp
5723 @item !
5724 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
5725 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
5726
5727 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
5728 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
5729 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
5730 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
5731 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
5732 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
5733 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
5734
5735 @item ?
5736 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
5737 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
5738
5739 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
5740 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
5741 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
5742 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
5743 messages.
5744
5745 @item SPACE
5746 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
5747 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
5748
5749 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
5750 @end table
5751
5752
5753 @node Read Articles
5754 @subsection Read Articles
5755 @cindex expirable mark
5756
5757 All the following marks mark articles as read.
5758
5759 @table @samp
5760
5761 @item r
5762 @vindex gnus-del-mark
5763 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
5764 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
5765
5766 @item R
5767 @vindex gnus-read-mark
5768 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
5769
5770 @item O
5771 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
5772 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
5773 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
5774
5775 @item K
5776 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
5777 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
5778
5779 @item X
5780 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
5781 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
5782
5783 @item Y
5784 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
5785 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
5786
5787 @item C
5788 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
5789 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
5790
5791 @item G
5792 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
5793 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
5794
5795 @item F
5796 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
5797 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
5798
5799 @item Q
5800 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
5801 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
5802 Threading}.
5803
5804 @item M
5805 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
5806 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
5807 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
5808
5809 @end table
5810
5811 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
5812 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
5813
5814 One more special mark, though:
5815
5816 @table @samp
5817 @item E
5818 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
5819 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
5820
5821 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
5822 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
5823 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
5824 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
5825 any time.
5826 @end table
5827
5828
5829 @node Other Marks
5830 @subsection Other Marks
5831 @cindex process mark
5832 @cindex bookmarks
5833
5834 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
5835 read or not.
5836
5837 @itemize @bullet
5838
5839 @item
5840 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
5841 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
5842 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
5843 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
5844 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
5845
5846 @item
5847 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
5848 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
5849 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
5850 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
5851
5852 @item
5853 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
5854 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
5855 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
5856
5857 @item
5858 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
5859 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
5860 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5861
5862 @item
5863 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
5864 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
5865 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
5866 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
5867
5868 @item
5869 @vindex gnus-recent-mark
5870 Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
5871 before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
5872 (@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
5873 mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
5874 @code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
5875
5876 @item
5877 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
5878 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
5879 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
5880 Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
5881
5882 @item
5883 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
5884 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
5885 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
5886 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
5887 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
5888 use.)
5889
5890 @item
5891 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
5892 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
5893 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
5894 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
5895 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
5896 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
5897
5898 @item
5899 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
5900 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
5901 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
5902 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
5903 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
5904 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
5905 use.)
5906
5907 @item
5908 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
5909 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
5910 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
5911 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
5912 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
5913
5914 @item
5915 @vindex gnus-process-mark
5916 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
5917 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
5918 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
5919 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
5920 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
5921
5922 @end itemize
5923
5924 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
5925 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
5926 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
5927
5928 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
5929 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
5930 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
5931
5932
5933 @node Setting Marks
5934 @subsection Setting Marks
5935 @cindex setting marks
5936
5937 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
5938
5939 @table @kbd
5940 @item M c
5941 @itemx M-u
5942 @kindex M c (Summary)
5943 @kindex M-u (Summary)
5944 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
5945 @cindex mark as unread
5946 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
5947 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
5948 article as unread.
5949
5950 @item M t
5951 @itemx !
5952 @kindex ! (Summary)
5953 @kindex M t (Summary)
5954 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
5955 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
5956 @xref{Article Caching}.
5957
5958 @item M ?
5959 @itemx ?
5960 @kindex ? (Summary)
5961 @kindex M ? (Summary)
5962 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
5963 Mark the current article as dormant
5964 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5965
5966 @item M d
5967 @itemx d
5968 @kindex M d (Summary)
5969 @kindex d (Summary)
5970 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
5971 Mark the current article as read
5972 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
5973
5974 @item D
5975 @kindex D (Summary)
5976 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
5977 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
5978 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
5979
5980 @item M k
5981 @itemx k
5982 @kindex k (Summary)
5983 @kindex M k (Summary)
5984 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
5985 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
5986 and then select the next unread article
5987 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
5988
5989 @item M K
5990 @itemx C-k
5991 @kindex M K (Summary)
5992 @kindex C-k (Summary)
5993 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
5994 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
5995 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
5996
5997 @item M C
5998 @kindex M C (Summary)
5999 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6000 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6001 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6002
6003 @item M C-c
6004 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6005 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6006 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6007 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6008
6009 @item M H
6010 @kindex M H (Summary)
6011 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6012 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6013 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6014
6015 @item M h
6016 @kindex M h (Summary)
6017 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6018 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6019 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6020
6021 @item C-w
6022 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6023 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6024 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6025 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6026
6027 @item M V k
6028 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6029 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6030 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6031 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6032
6033 @item M e
6034 @itemx E
6035 @kindex M e (Summary)
6036 @kindex E (Summary)
6037 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6038 Mark the current article as expirable
6039 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6040
6041 @item M b
6042 @kindex M b (Summary)
6043 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6044 Set a bookmark in the current article
6045 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6046
6047 @item M B
6048 @kindex M B (Summary)
6049 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6050 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6051 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6052
6053 @item M V c
6054 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6055 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6056 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6057 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6058
6059 @item M V u
6060 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6061 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6062 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6063 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6064
6065 @item M V m
6066 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6067 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6068 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6069 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6070 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6071 @end table
6072
6073 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6074 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6075 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6076 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6077 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6078 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6079 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6080 The default is @code{t}.
6081
6082
6083 @node Generic Marking Commands
6084 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6085
6086 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6087 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6088 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6089 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6090 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6091 well.
6092
6093 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6094 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6095 command should do.
6096
6097 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6098 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6099 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6100 to list in this manual.
6101
6102 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6103 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6104 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6105 article, you could say something like:
6106
6107 @lisp
6108 @group
6109 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6110 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6111 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6112 @end group
6113 @end lisp
6114
6115 @noindent
6116 or
6117
6118 @lisp
6119 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6120 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6121 @end lisp
6122
6123
6124 @node Setting Process Marks
6125 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6126 @cindex setting process marks
6127
6128 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6129 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6130 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6131 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6132 commands into the cache. For more information,
6133 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6134
6135 @table @kbd
6136
6137 @item M P p
6138 @itemx #
6139 @kindex # (Summary)
6140 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6141 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6142 Mark the current article with the process mark
6143 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6144 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6145
6146 @item M P u
6147 @itemx M-#
6148 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6149 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6150 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6151 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6152
6153 @item M P U
6154 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6155 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6156 Remove the process mark from all articles
6157 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6158
6159 @item M P i
6160 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6161 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6162 Invert the list of process marked articles
6163 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6164
6165 @item M P R
6166 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6167 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6168 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6169 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6170
6171 @item M P G
6172 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6173 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6174 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6175 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6176
6177 @item M P r
6178 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6179 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6180 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6181
6182 @item M P g
6183 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6184 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6185 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6186
6187 @item M P t
6188 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6189 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6190 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6191 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6192
6193 @item M P T
6194 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6195 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6196 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6197 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6198
6199 @item M P v
6200 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6201 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6202 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6203 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6204
6205 @item M P s
6206 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6207 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6208 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6209
6210 @item M P S
6211 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6212 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6213 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6214 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6215
6216 @item M P a
6217 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6218 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6219 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6220
6221 @item M P b
6222 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6223 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6224 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6225 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6226
6227 @item M P k
6228 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6229 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6230 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6231 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6232
6233 @item M P y
6234 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6235 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6236 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6237 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6238
6239 @item M P w
6240 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6241 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6242 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6243 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6244
6245 @end table
6246
6247 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6248 set process marks based on article body contents.
6249
6250
6251 @node Limiting
6252 @section Limiting
6253 @cindex limiting
6254
6255 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6256 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6257 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6258 buffer.
6259
6260 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
6261 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
6262 additional articles.
6263
6264 @table @kbd
6265
6266 @item / /
6267 @itemx / s
6268 @kindex / / (Summary)
6269 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6270 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6271 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6272 matching articles.
6273
6274 @item / a
6275 @kindex / a (Summary)
6276 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6277 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6278 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6279 matching articles.
6280
6281 @item / x
6282 @kindex / x (Summary)
6283 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6284 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6285 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6286 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6287 matching articles.
6288
6289 @item / u
6290 @itemx x
6291 @kindex / u (Summary)
6292 @kindex x (Summary)
6293 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6294 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6295 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6296 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6297 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6298
6299 @item / m
6300 @kindex / m (Summary)
6301 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6302 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6303 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6304
6305 @item / t
6306 @kindex / t (Summary)
6307 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6308 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6309 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6310 articles younger than that number of days.
6311
6312 @item / n
6313 @kindex / n (Summary)
6314 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6315 Limit the summary buffer to the current article
6316 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}). Uses the process/prefix
6317 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6318
6319 @item / w
6320 @kindex / w (Summary)
6321 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6322 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6323 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6324 the stack.
6325
6326 @item / .
6327 @kindex / . (Summary)
6328 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6329 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6330 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6331
6332 @item / v
6333 @kindex / v (Summary)
6334 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6335 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6336 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6337
6338 @item / p
6339 @kindex / p (Summary)
6340 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6341 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6342 group parameter predicate
6343 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6344 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6345
6346 @item / E
6347 @itemx M S
6348 @kindex M S (Summary)
6349 @kindex / E (Summary)
6350 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6351 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6352 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6353
6354 @item / D
6355 @kindex / D (Summary)
6356 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6357 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6358 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6359
6360 @item / *
6361 @kindex / * (Summary)
6362 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6363 Include all cached articles in the limit
6364 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6365
6366 @item / d
6367 @kindex / d (Summary)
6368 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6369 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6370 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6371
6372 @item / M
6373 @kindex / M (Summary)
6374 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6375 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6376
6377 @item / T
6378 @kindex / T (Summary)
6379 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6380 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6381
6382 @item / c
6383 @kindex / c (Summary)
6384 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6385 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6386 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6387
6388 @item / C
6389 @kindex / C (Summary)
6390 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6391 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6392 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6393 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6394
6395 @item / N
6396 @kindex / N (Summary)
6397 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6398 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6399 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6400
6401 @item / o
6402 @kindex / o (Summary)
6403 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6404 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6405 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6406
6407 @end table
6408
6409
6410 @node Threading
6411 @section Threading
6412 @cindex threading
6413 @cindex article threading
6414
6415 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6416 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6417 hierarchical fashion.
6418
6419 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6420 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6421 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6422 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6423 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6424 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6425 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6426
6427 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6428
6429 @table @dfn
6430 @item root
6431 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6432
6433 @item thread
6434 A tree-like article structure.
6435
6436 @item sub-thread
6437 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6438
6439 @item loose threads
6440 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6441 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6442 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6443 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6444 called loose threads.
6445
6446 @item thread gathering
6447 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6448
6449 @item sparse threads
6450 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6451 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6452
6453 @end table
6454
6455
6456 @menu
6457 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6458 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6459 @end menu
6460
6461
6462 @node Customizing Threading
6463 @subsection Customizing Threading
6464 @cindex customizing threading
6465
6466 @menu
6467 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6468 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6469 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6470 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6471 @end menu
6472
6473
6474 @node Loose Threads
6475 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6476 @cindex <
6477 @cindex >
6478 @cindex loose threads
6479
6480 @table @code
6481 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6482 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6483 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6484 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6485 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6486 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6487
6488 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6489 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6490 There are four possible values:
6491
6492 @iftex
6493 @iflatex
6494 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6495 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6496 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6497 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6498 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6499 }
6500 @end iflatex
6501 @end iftex
6502
6503 @cindex adopting articles
6504
6505 @table @code
6506
6507 @item adopt
6508 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6509 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6510 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6511 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6512
6513 @item dummy
6514 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6515 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6516 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6517 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6518 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6519 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6520 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6521 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6522 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6523 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6524
6525 @item empty
6526 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6527 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6528 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6529 Buffer Format}).)
6530
6531 @item none
6532 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6533 display them after one another.
6534
6535 @item nil
6536 Don't gather loose threads.
6537 @end table
6538
6539 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6540 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6541 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6542 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6543 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6544 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6545 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6546 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6547 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6548 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6549 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6550
6551 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6552 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6553 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6554 Matching}).
6555
6556 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6557 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6558 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6559 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6560 simplification is used.
6561
6562 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6563 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6564 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6565 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6566
6567 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6568 @lisp
6569 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6570 (concat
6571 "\\`\\[?\\("
6572 (mapconcat
6573 'identity
6574 '("looking"
6575 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6576 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6577 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6578 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6579 ;; ...
6580 )
6581 "\\|")
6582 "\\)\\s *\\("
6583 (mapconcat 'identity
6584 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6585 "\\|")
6586 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6587 @end lisp
6588
6589 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6590 subjects.
6591
6592 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6593 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6594 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6595 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6596 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6597 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6598
6599 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6600
6601 @table @code
6602 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6603 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6604 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6605
6606 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6607 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6608 Simplify fuzzily.
6609
6610 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6611 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6612 Remove excessive whitespace.
6613
6614 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6615 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6616 Remove all whitespace.
6617 @end table
6618
6619 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6620
6621
6622 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6623 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6624 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6625 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6626 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6627 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6628 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6629 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6630
6631 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6632 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6633 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6634 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6635 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6636 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6637 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6638 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6639 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6640 cholera:
6641
6642 @table @code
6643 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6644 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6645 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6646 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6647
6648 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6649 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6650 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6651 @end table
6652
6653 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6654 something like:
6655
6656 @lisp
6657 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6658 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6659 @end lisp
6660
6661 @end table
6662
6663
6664 @node Filling In Threads
6665 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6666
6667 @table @code
6668 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6669 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6670 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6671 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
6672 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
6673 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
6674 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
6675 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
6676 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
6677 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
6678 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
6679 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
6680 do about that.
6681
6682 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
6683 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
6684 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
6685
6686 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6687 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6688 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
6689 newsgroups.
6690
6691 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
6692 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
6693 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
6694 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
6695 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
6696 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
6697 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
6698 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
6699 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
6700 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
6701 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
6702 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
6703 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
6704 @code{nil} by default.
6705
6706 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
6707 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
6708 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
6709 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
6710 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
6711 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
6712 web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
6713
6714 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
6715 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
6716 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
6717
6718 @end table
6719
6720
6721 @node More Threading
6722 @subsubsection More Threading
6723
6724 @table @code
6725 @item gnus-show-threads
6726 @vindex gnus-show-threads
6727 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
6728 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
6729 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
6730 slower and more awkward.
6731
6732 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6733 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6734 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
6735 generated.
6736
6737 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
6738 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
6739 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
6740
6741 Here's an example:
6742
6743 @lisp
6744 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6745 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
6746 gnus-article-unseen-p))
6747 @end lisp
6748
6749 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
6750 unread, but you get my drift.)
6751
6752
6753 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
6754 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
6755 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
6756 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
6757 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
6758 threads are expunged.
6759
6760 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
6761 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
6762 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
6763 will be hidden.
6764
6765 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6766 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6767 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
6768 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
6769 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
6770 result in a new thread.
6771
6772 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
6773 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
6774 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
6775 The default is 4.
6776
6777 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6778 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6779 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
6780 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
6781 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
6782 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
6783 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
6784 Setting this variable to an alternate value
6785 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
6786 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
6787 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
6788
6789 @end table
6790
6791
6792 @node Low-Level Threading
6793 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
6794
6795 @table @code
6796
6797 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
6798 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
6799 Hook run before parsing any headers.
6800
6801 @item gnus-alter-header-function
6802 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
6803 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
6804 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
6805 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
6806 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
6807 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
6808 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
6809 meaningful. Here's one example:
6810
6811 @lisp
6812 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
6813
6814 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
6815 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
6816 (when (string-match
6817 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
6818 (mail-header-set-id
6819 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
6820 header))))
6821 @end lisp
6822
6823 @end table
6824
6825
6826 @node Thread Commands
6827 @subsection Thread Commands
6828 @cindex thread commands
6829
6830 @table @kbd
6831
6832 @item T k
6833 @itemx C-M-k
6834 @kindex T k (Summary)
6835 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
6836 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
6837 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
6838 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
6839 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
6840 articles instead.
6841
6842 @item T l
6843 @itemx C-M-l
6844 @kindex T l (Summary)
6845 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
6846 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
6847 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
6848 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
6849
6850 @item T i
6851 @kindex T i (Summary)
6852 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
6853 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
6854 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
6855
6856 @item T #
6857 @kindex T # (Summary)
6858 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6859 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
6860 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6861
6862 @item T M-#
6863 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
6864 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6865 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
6866 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6867
6868 @item T T
6869 @kindex T T (Summary)
6870 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
6871 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
6872
6873 @item T s
6874 @kindex T s (Summary)
6875 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
6876 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
6877 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
6878
6879 @item T h
6880 @kindex T h (Summary)
6881 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
6882 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
6883
6884 @item T S
6885 @kindex T S (Summary)
6886 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
6887 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
6888
6889 @item T H
6890 @kindex T H (Summary)
6891 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
6892 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
6893
6894 @item T t
6895 @kindex T t (Summary)
6896 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
6897 Re-thread the current article's thread
6898 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
6899 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
6900
6901 @item T ^
6902 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
6903 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
6904 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
6905 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
6906
6907 @end table
6908
6909 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
6910 understand the numeric prefix.
6911
6912 @table @kbd
6913
6914 @item T n
6915 @kindex T n (Summary)
6916 @itemx C-M-f
6917 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
6918 @itemx M-down
6919 @kindex M-down (Summary)
6920 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
6921 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
6922
6923 @item T p
6924 @kindex T p (Summary)
6925 @itemx C-M-b
6926 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
6927 @itemx M-up
6928 @kindex M-up (Summary)
6929 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
6930 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
6931
6932 @item T d
6933 @kindex T d (Summary)
6934 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
6935 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
6936
6937 @item T u
6938 @kindex T u (Summary)
6939 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
6940 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
6941
6942 @item T o
6943 @kindex T o (Summary)
6944 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
6945 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
6946 @end table
6947
6948 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
6949 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
6950 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
6951 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
6952 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
6953 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
6954 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
6955 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
6956 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
6957 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
6958 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
6959 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
6960 Matching}).
6961
6962
6963 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
6964 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
6965
6966 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
6967 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
6968 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
6969 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
6970 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
6971 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6972 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
6973 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
6974 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
6975 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
6976 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
6977 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
6978 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
6979 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
6980
6981 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
6982 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
6983 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
6984 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
6985 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
6986 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
6987 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
6988 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
6989
6990 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
6991 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
6992 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
6993
6994 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
6995 last function in the list. You should probably always include
6996 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
6997 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
6998 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
6999 ascending article order.
7000
7001 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7002 by number, you could do something like:
7003
7004 @lisp
7005 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7006 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7007 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7008 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7009 @end lisp
7010
7011 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7012 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7013 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7014 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7015 which the articles arrived.
7016
7017 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7018 say something like:
7019
7020 @lisp
7021 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7022 '((lambda (t1 t2)
7023 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
7024 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7025 @end lisp
7026
7027 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7028 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7029 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7030 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7031 tickles your fancy.
7032
7033 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7034 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7035 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7036 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7037 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7038 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7039 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7040 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7041 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7042 variable. It is very similar to the
7043 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7044 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7045 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7046 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7047 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7048 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7049 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7050
7051 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7052 say something like:
7053
7054 @lisp
7055 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7056 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7057 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7058 @end lisp
7059
7060
7061
7062 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7063 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7064 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7065 @cindex article pre-fetch
7066 @cindex pre-fetch
7067
7068 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7069 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7070 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7071 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7072 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7073
7074 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7075 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7076
7077 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7078 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7079 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7080 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7081 connection is blocked.
7082
7083 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7084 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7085 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7086 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7087
7088 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7089 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7090 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7091 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7092 extra connection.
7093
7094 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7095 you really want to.
7096
7097 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7098 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7099 happen automatically.
7100
7101 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7102 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7103 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7104 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7105 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7106 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7107 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7108
7109 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7110 @findex gnus-async-read-p
7111 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7112 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7113 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7114 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7115 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-read-p}, which
7116 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7117 article data structure as the only parameter.
7118
7119 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7120 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7121
7122 @lisp
7123 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7124 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7125 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7126 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7127 100)))
7128
7129 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7130 @end lisp
7131
7132 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7133 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7134 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7135
7136 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7137 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7138 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7139 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7140
7141 @table @code
7142 @item read
7143 Remove articles when they are read.
7144
7145 @item exit
7146 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7147 @end table
7148
7149 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7150
7151 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7152 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7153 @c from the next group.
7154
7155
7156 @node Article Caching
7157 @section Article Caching
7158 @cindex article caching
7159 @cindex caching
7160
7161 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7162 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7163 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7164 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7165 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7166
7167 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7168
7169 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7170 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7171 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7172 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7173 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7174 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7175 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7176 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7177
7178 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7179 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7180 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7181 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7182 as dormant, and don't worry.
7183
7184 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7185
7186 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7187 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7188 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7189 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7190 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7191 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7192 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7193 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7194 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7195 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7196
7197 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7198 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7199 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7200 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7201 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7202 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7203 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7204 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7205 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7206 not then be downloaded by this command.
7207
7208 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7209 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7210 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7211 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7212 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7213 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7214
7215 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7216 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7217 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7218 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7219 variables, the group is not cached.
7220
7221 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7222 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7223 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7224 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7225 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7226 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7227 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7228 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7229 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7230 file.
7231
7232 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7233 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7234 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7235 where, isn't that cool?
7236
7237 @node Persistent Articles
7238 @section Persistent Articles
7239 @cindex persistent articles
7240
7241 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7242 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7243 useful in my opinion.
7244
7245 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7246 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7247 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7248 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7249 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7250 the expiry going on at the news server.
7251
7252 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7253 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7254 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7255
7256 @table @kbd
7257
7258 @item *
7259 @kindex * (Summary)
7260 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7261 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7262
7263 @item M-*
7264 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7265 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7266 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7267 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7268 article.
7269 @end table
7270
7271 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7272
7273 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7274 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7275 interested in persistent articles:
7276
7277 @lisp
7278 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7279 @end lisp
7280
7281
7282 @node Article Backlog
7283 @section Article Backlog
7284 @cindex backlog
7285 @cindex article backlog
7286
7287 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7288 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7289 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7290 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7291 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7292 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7293 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7294 increase memory usage some.
7295
7296 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7297 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7298 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7299 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7300 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7301 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7302 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7303
7304 The default value is 20.
7305
7306
7307 @node Saving Articles
7308 @section Saving Articles
7309 @cindex saving articles
7310
7311 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7312 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7313 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7314 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7315 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7316
7317 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7318 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7319 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7320
7321 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7322 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7323 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7324
7325 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7326 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7327 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7328 deleted before saving.
7329
7330 @table @kbd
7331
7332 @item O o
7333 @itemx o
7334 @kindex O o (Summary)
7335 @kindex o (Summary)
7336 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7337 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7338 Save the current article using the default article saver
7339 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7340
7341 @item O m
7342 @kindex O m (Summary)
7343 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7344 Save the current article in mail format
7345 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7346
7347 @item O r
7348 @kindex O r (Summary)
7349 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7350 Save the current article in Rmail format
7351 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
7352
7353 @item O f
7354 @kindex O f (Summary)
7355 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7356 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7357 Save the current article in plain file format
7358 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7359
7360 @item O F
7361 @kindex O F (Summary)
7362 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7363 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7364 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7365
7366 @item O b
7367 @kindex O b (Summary)
7368 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7369 Save the current article body in plain file format
7370 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7371
7372 @item O h
7373 @kindex O h (Summary)
7374 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7375 Save the current article in mh folder format
7376 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7377
7378 @item O v
7379 @kindex O v (Summary)
7380 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7381 Save the current article in a VM folder
7382 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7383
7384 @item O p
7385 @itemx |
7386 @kindex O p (Summary)
7387 @kindex | (Summary)
7388 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7389 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7390 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7391 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7392 complete headers in the piped output.
7393
7394 @item O P
7395 @kindex O P (Summary)
7396 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7397 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7398 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7399 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7400 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7401 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7402 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7403
7404 @end table
7405
7406 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7407 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7408 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7409 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7410 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7411 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7412 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7413 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7414 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7415 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7416 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7417 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7418 files.
7419
7420
7421 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7422 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7423 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the six ready-made
7424 functions below, or you can create your own.
7425
7426 @table @code
7427
7428 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7429 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7430 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7431 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7432 This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
7433 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7434 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7435
7436 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7437 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7438 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7439 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7440 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7441 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7442
7443 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7444 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7445 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7446 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7447 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7448 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7449 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7450
7451 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7452 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7453 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7454 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7455 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7456 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7457
7458 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7459 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7460 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7461 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7462 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7463
7464 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7465 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7466 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7467 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7468 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7469 @cindex rcvstore
7470 @cindex MH folders
7471 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7472 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7473 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7474 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7475 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7476
7477 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7478 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7479 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7480 reader to use this setting.
7481 @end table
7482
7483 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7484 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7485 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7486 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7487 default.
7488
7489 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7490 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7491 available functions that generate names:
7492
7493 @table @code
7494
7495 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7496 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7497 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7498
7499 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7500 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7501 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7502
7503 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7504 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7505 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7506
7507 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7508 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7509 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7510
7511 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7512 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7513 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7514 @end table
7515
7516 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7517 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7518 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7519 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7520 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7521 like:
7522
7523 @lisp
7524 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7525 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7526 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7527 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7528 @end lisp
7529
7530 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
7531 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
7532 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
7533 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
7534 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
7535 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
7536 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
7537 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
7538 called returns a string or a list of strings.
7539
7540 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
7541 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
7542 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
7543 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
7544
7545 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
7546 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
7547 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
7548 name.
7549
7550 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
7551 lots of mail groups called things like
7552 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
7553 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
7554 following will do just that:
7555
7556 @lisp
7557 (defun my-save-name (group)
7558 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
7559 (substring group (match-end 0))))
7560
7561 (setq gnus-split-methods
7562 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
7563 (my-save-name)))
7564 @end lisp
7565
7566
7567 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7568 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
7569 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
7570 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
7571 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
7572 all the files in the top level directory
7573 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
7574 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
7575 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
7576 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
7577
7578 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
7579 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
7580 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
7581 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
7582 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
7583 for kill files.
7584
7585 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
7586 a spool, you could
7587
7588 @lisp
7589 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
7590 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
7591 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
7592 @end lisp
7593
7594 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
7595 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
7596 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
7597 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
7598
7599
7600 @node Decoding Articles
7601 @section Decoding Articles
7602 @cindex decoding articles
7603
7604 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
7605 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
7606
7607 @menu
7608 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
7609 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
7610 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
7611 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
7612 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
7613 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
7614 @end menu
7615
7616 @cindex series
7617 @cindex article series
7618 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
7619 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
7620 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
7621 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
7622 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
7623
7624 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
7625 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
7626 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
7627
7628 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
7629 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
7630 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
7631
7632 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
7633 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
7634 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
7635
7636
7637 @node Uuencoded Articles
7638 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
7639 @cindex uudecode
7640 @cindex uuencoded articles
7641
7642 @table @kbd
7643
7644 @item X u
7645 @kindex X u (Summary)
7646 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
7647 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
7648 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
7649
7650 @item X U
7651 @kindex X U (Summary)
7652 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
7653 Uudecodes and saves the current series
7654 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7655
7656 @item X v u
7657 @kindex X v u (Summary)
7658 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
7659 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
7660
7661 @item X v U
7662 @kindex X v U (Summary)
7663 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
7664 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
7665 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
7666
7667 @end table
7668
7669 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
7670 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
7671 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
7672 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
7673 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7674
7675 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
7676 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
7677 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
7678 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
7679 @kbd{X u}.
7680
7681 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
7682 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
7683 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
7684 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
7685 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
7686 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
7687 off.
7688
7689
7690 @node Shell Archives
7691 @subsection Shell Archives
7692 @cindex unshar
7693 @cindex shell archives
7694 @cindex shared articles
7695
7696 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
7697 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
7698 some commands to deal with these:
7699
7700 @table @kbd
7701
7702 @item X s
7703 @kindex X s (Summary)
7704 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
7705 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
7706
7707 @item X S
7708 @kindex X S (Summary)
7709 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
7710 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
7711
7712 @item X v s
7713 @kindex X v s (Summary)
7714 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
7715 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
7716
7717 @item X v S
7718 @kindex X v S (Summary)
7719 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
7720 Unshars, views and saves the current series
7721 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
7722 @end table
7723
7724
7725 @node PostScript Files
7726 @subsection PostScript Files
7727 @cindex PostScript
7728
7729 @table @kbd
7730
7731 @item X p
7732 @kindex X p (Summary)
7733 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
7734 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
7735
7736 @item X P
7737 @kindex X P (Summary)
7738 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
7739 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
7740 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
7741
7742 @item X v p
7743 @kindex X v p (Summary)
7744 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
7745 View the current PostScript series
7746 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
7747
7748 @item X v P
7749 @kindex X v P (Summary)
7750 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
7751 View and save the current PostScript series
7752 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
7753 @end table
7754
7755
7756 @node Other Files
7757 @subsection Other Files
7758
7759 @table @kbd
7760 @item X o
7761 @kindex X o (Summary)
7762 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
7763 Save the current series
7764 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
7765
7766 @item X b
7767 @kindex X b (Summary)
7768 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
7769 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
7770 doesn't really work yet.
7771 @end table
7772
7773
7774 @node Decoding Variables
7775 @subsection Decoding Variables
7776
7777 Adjective, not verb.
7778
7779 @menu
7780 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
7781 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
7782 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
7783 @end menu
7784
7785
7786 @node Rule Variables
7787 @subsubsection Rule Variables
7788 @cindex rule variables
7789
7790 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
7791 variables are of the form
7792
7793 @lisp
7794 (list '(regexp1 command2)
7795 '(regexp2 command2)
7796 ...)
7797 @end lisp
7798
7799 @table @code
7800
7801 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7802 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7803 @cindex sox
7804 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
7805 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
7806 say something like:
7807 @lisp
7808 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7809 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
7810 @end lisp
7811
7812 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7813 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7814 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
7815 user and default view rules.
7816
7817 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7818 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7819 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
7820 archives.
7821 @end table
7822
7823
7824 @node Other Decode Variables
7825 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
7826
7827 @table @code
7828 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7829
7830 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7831 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
7832 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
7833 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
7834 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
7835
7836 @table @code
7837
7838 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
7839 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
7840 View the file.
7841
7842 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
7843 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
7844 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
7845 @end table
7846
7847 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7848 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7849 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
7850 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
7851 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
7852 time.
7853
7854 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7855 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7856 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
7857
7858 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7859 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7860 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
7861 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
7862 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
7863 kludgey.
7864
7865 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7866 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7867 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
7868
7869 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7870 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7871 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
7872 looking for files to display.
7873
7874 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
7875 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
7876 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
7877 after viewing it.
7878
7879 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7880 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7881 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
7882 rules.
7883
7884 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7885 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7886 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
7887 unpacking commands.
7888
7889 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7890 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7891 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
7892 from articles.
7893
7894 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7895 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7896 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
7897 decoded articles as unread.
7898
7899 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7900 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7901 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
7902 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
7903
7904 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7905 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7906 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
7907
7908 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7909 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7910 @cindex metamail
7911 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
7912 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
7913 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
7914 @code{metamail} for viewing.
7915
7916 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7917 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7918 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
7919 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
7920 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
7921 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
7922 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
7923 simply dropped them.
7924
7925 @end table
7926
7927
7928 @node Uuencoding and Posting
7929 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
7930
7931 @table @code
7932
7933 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7934 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7935 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
7936 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
7937 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
7938 for you when you post the article.
7939
7940 @item gnus-uu-post-length
7941 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
7942 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
7943 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
7944
7945 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
7946 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
7947 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
7948 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
7949 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
7950 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
7951 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
7952
7953 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7954 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7955 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
7956 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
7957 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
7958 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
7959 Default is @code{t}.
7960
7961 @end table
7962
7963
7964 @node Viewing Files
7965 @subsection Viewing Files
7966 @cindex viewing files
7967 @cindex pseudo-articles
7968
7969 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
7970 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
7971 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
7972 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
7973 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
7974 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
7975 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
7976
7977 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
7978 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
7979 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
7980 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
7981
7982 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
7983 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
7984 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
7985
7986 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
7987 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
7988 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
7989 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
7990 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
7991
7992 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
7993 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
7994 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
7995 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
7996 a list of parameters to that command.
7997
7998 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
7999 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8000 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8001
8002 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8003 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8004 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8005
8006
8007 @node Article Treatment
8008 @section Article Treatment
8009
8010 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8011 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8012 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8013 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8014 these articles easier.
8015
8016 @menu
8017 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8018 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8019 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8020 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8021 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8022 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8023 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8024 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8025 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
8026 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8027 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8028 @end menu
8029
8030
8031 @node Article Highlighting
8032 @subsection Article Highlighting
8033 @cindex highlighting
8034
8035 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8036 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8037
8038 @table @kbd
8039
8040 @item W H a
8041 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8042 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8043 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8044 Do much highlighting of the current article
8045 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8046 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8047
8048 @item W H h
8049 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8050 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8051 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8052 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8053 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8054 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8055 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8056 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8057 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8058 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8059 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8060 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8061
8062 @item W H c
8063 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8064 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8065 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8066
8067 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8068
8069 @table @code
8070 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8071
8072 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8073 If the article size if bigger than this variable (which is 25000 by
8074 default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8075
8076 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8077 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8078 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8079
8080 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8081 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8082 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8083 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8084 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8085 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8086
8087 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8088 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8089 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8090
8091 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8092 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8093 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8094
8095 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8096 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8097 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8098 that it's a citation.
8099
8100 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8101 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8102 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8103
8104 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8105 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8106 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8107
8108 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8109 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8110 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8111 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8112
8113 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8114 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8115 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8116 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8117 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8118 is @code{t}.
8119
8120 @end table
8121
8122
8123 @item W H s
8124 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8125 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8126 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8127 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8128 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8129 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8130 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8131 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8132 default.
8133
8134 @end table
8135
8136 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8137
8138
8139 @node Article Fontisizing
8140 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8141 @cindex emphasis
8142 @cindex article emphasis
8143
8144 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8145 @kindex W e (Summary)
8146 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8147 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8148 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8149 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8150
8151 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8152 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8153 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8154 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8155 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8156 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8157 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8158 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8159 highlighting.
8160
8161 @lisp
8162 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8163 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8164 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8165 @end lisp
8166
8167 @cindex slash
8168 @cindex asterisk
8169 @cindex underline
8170 @cindex /
8171 @cindex *
8172
8173 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8174 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8175 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8176 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8177 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8178 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8179 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8180 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8181 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8182 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8183 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8184 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8185 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8186
8187 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8188 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8189 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8190 say something like:
8191
8192 @lisp
8193 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8194 @end lisp
8195
8196 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8197
8198 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8199 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8200 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8201 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8202
8203 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8204
8205
8206 @node Article Hiding
8207 @subsection Article Hiding
8208 @cindex article hiding
8209
8210 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8211 too much cruft in most articles.
8212
8213 @table @kbd
8214
8215 @item W W a
8216 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8217 @findex gnus-article-hide
8218 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8219 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8220 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8221
8222 @item W W h
8223 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8224 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8225 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8226 Headers}.
8227
8228 @item W W b
8229 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8230 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8231 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8232 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8233
8234 @item W W s
8235 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8236 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8237 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8238 Signature}.
8239
8240 @item W W l
8241 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8242 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8243 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8244 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8245 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8246 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8247 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8248 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8249
8250 @table @code
8251
8252 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8253 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8254 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8255 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8256
8257 @end table
8258
8259 @item W W P
8260 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8261 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8262 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8263 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8264
8265 @item W W B
8266 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8267 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8268 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8269 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8270 @cindex banner
8271 @cindex OneList
8272 @cindex stripping advertisements
8273 @cindex advertisements
8274 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8275 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8276 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8277 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8278 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8279 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8280 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8281 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8282 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8283 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8284 used.
8285
8286 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8287 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8288 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8289
8290 @table @code
8291
8292 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8293 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8294 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8295 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8296 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8297 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8298 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8299 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8300 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8301 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8302 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8303
8304 @lisp
8305 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8306 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8307 @end lisp
8308
8309 @end table
8310
8311 @item W W c
8312 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8313 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8314 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8315 customizing the hiding:
8316
8317 @table @code
8318
8319 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8320 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8321 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8322 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8323 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8324 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8325 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8326 specs are valid:
8327
8328 @table @samp
8329 @item b
8330 Starting point of the hidden text.
8331 @item e
8332 Ending point of the hidden text.
8333 @item l
8334 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8335 @item n
8336 Number of lines of hidden text.
8337 @end table
8338
8339 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8340 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8341 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8342 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8343 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8344
8345 @end table
8346
8347 @item W W C-c
8348 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8349 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8350
8351 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8352 following two variables:
8353
8354 @table @code
8355 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8356 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8357 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8358 50), hide the cited text.
8359
8360 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8361 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8362 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8363 is hidden.
8364 @end table
8365
8366 @item W W C
8367 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8368 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8369 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8370 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8371 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8372 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8373
8374 @end table
8375
8376 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8377 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8378 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8379
8380 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8381 citation customization.
8382
8383 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8384 automatically.
8385
8386
8387 @node Article Washing
8388 @subsection Article Washing
8389 @cindex washing
8390 @cindex article washing
8391
8392 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8393 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8394
8395 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8396 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8397 Cleaner, perhaps.
8398
8399 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8400 articles by default.
8401
8402 @table @kbd
8403
8404 @item C-u g
8405 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8406 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8407 the server.
8408
8409 @item g
8410 Force redisplaying of the current article
8411 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8412 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8413 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8414 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8415
8416 @item W l
8417 @kindex W l (Summary)
8418 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8419 Remove page breaks from the current article
8420 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8421 delimiters.
8422
8423 @item W r
8424 @kindex W r (Summary)
8425 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8426 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8427 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8428 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8429 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8430 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8431
8432 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8433 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8434 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8435 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8436
8437 @item W m
8438 @kindex W m (Summary)
8439 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8440 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8441
8442 @item W t
8443 @item t
8444 @kindex W t (Summary)
8445 @kindex t (Summary)
8446 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8447 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8448 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8449
8450 @item W v
8451 @kindex W v (Summary)
8452 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8453 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8454 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8455
8456 @item W o
8457 @kindex W o (Summary)
8458 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8459 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8460
8461 @item W d
8462 @kindex W d (Summary)
8463 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8464 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8465 @cindex Smartquotes
8466 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8467 @cindex Latin 1
8468 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8469 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8470 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8471 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8472 interactively.
8473
8474 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8475 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8476 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8477 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8478
8479 @item W Y f
8480 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8481 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8482 @cindex Outlook Express
8483 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8484 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8485 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8486
8487 @item W Y u
8488 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8489 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8490 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8491 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8492 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8493 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
8494 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
8495 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
8496 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
8497 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
8498
8499 @item W Y a
8500 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
8501 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
8502 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
8503 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
8504
8505 @item W Y c
8506 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
8507 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
8508 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
8509 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
8510
8511 @item W w
8512 @kindex W w (Summary)
8513 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
8514 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
8515
8516 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
8517 when filling.
8518
8519 @item W Q
8520 @kindex W Q (Summary)
8521 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
8522 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
8523
8524 @item W C
8525 @kindex W C (Summary)
8526 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
8527 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
8528 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
8529
8530 @item W c
8531 @kindex W c (Summary)
8532 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
8533 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8534 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
8535 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
8536 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
8537
8538 @item W q
8539 @kindex W q (Summary)
8540 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
8541 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
8542 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
8543 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
8544 makes strings like @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which
8545 doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually done
8546 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8547 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8548 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8549
8550 @item W 6
8551 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
8552 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
8553 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
8554 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
8555 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
8556 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8557 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8558 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8559
8560 @item W Z
8561 @kindex W Z (Summary)
8562 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
8563 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
8564 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
8565 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
8566
8567 @item W u
8568 @kindex W u (Summary)
8569 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
8570 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
8571 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
8572 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
8573 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
8574
8575 @item W h
8576 @kindex W h (Summary)
8577 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
8578 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
8579 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8580 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
8581
8582 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
8583 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
8584 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
8585
8586 @vindex gnus-article-wash-function
8587 The default is to use the function specified by
8588 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
8589 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
8590 @acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
8591 @code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
8592 can use include:
8593
8594 @table @code
8595 @item w3
8596 Use Emacs/W3.
8597
8598 @item w3m
8599 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
8600
8601 @item w3m-standalone
8602 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
8603
8604 @item links
8605 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
8606
8607 @item lynx
8608 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
8609
8610 @item html2text
8611 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
8612
8613 @end table
8614
8615 @item W b
8616 @kindex W b (Summary)
8617 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
8618 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
8619 @xref{Article Buttons}.
8620
8621 @item W B
8622 @kindex W B (Summary)
8623 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
8624 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
8625 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
8626
8627 @item W p
8628 @kindex W p (Summary)
8629 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
8630 Verify a signed control message
8631 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
8632 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
8633 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
8634 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
8635 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
8636 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
8637
8638 @item W s
8639 @kindex W s (Summary)
8640 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
8641 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
8642 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
8643 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
8644
8645 @item W a
8646 @kindex W a (Summary)
8647 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
8648 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
8649 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
8650
8651 @item W E l
8652 @kindex W E l (Summary)
8653 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
8654 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
8655 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
8656
8657 @item W E m
8658 @kindex W E m (Summary)
8659 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
8660 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
8661 lines with a single empty line.
8662 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
8663
8664 @item W E t
8665 @kindex W E t (Summary)
8666 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
8667 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
8668 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
8669
8670 @item W E a
8671 @kindex W E a (Summary)
8672 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
8673 Do all the three commands above
8674 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
8675
8676 @item W E A
8677 @kindex W E A (Summary)
8678 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
8679 Remove all blank lines
8680 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
8681
8682 @item W E s
8683 @kindex W E s (Summary)
8684 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
8685 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
8686 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
8687
8688 @item W E e
8689 @kindex W E e (Summary)
8690 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
8691 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
8692 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
8693
8694 @end table
8695
8696 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
8697
8698
8699 @node Article Header
8700 @subsection Article Header
8701
8702 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
8703
8704 @table @kbd
8705
8706 @item W G u
8707 @kindex W G u (Summary)
8708 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
8709 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
8710
8711 @item W G n
8712 @kindex W G n (Summary)
8713 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
8714 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
8715 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
8716
8717 @item W G f
8718 @kindex W G f (Summary)
8719 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
8720 Fold all the message headers
8721 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
8722
8723 @item W E w
8724 @kindex W E w (Summary)
8725 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
8726 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
8727 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
8728
8729 @end table
8730
8731
8732 @node Article Buttons
8733 @subsection Article Buttons
8734 @cindex buttons
8735
8736 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
8737 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
8738 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
8739 button on these references.
8740
8741 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8742 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
8743 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
8744 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
8745 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
8746
8747 @table @code
8748
8749 @item gnus-button-alist
8750 @vindex gnus-button-alist
8751 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
8752
8753 @lisp
8754 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8755 @end lisp
8756
8757 @table @var
8758
8759 @item regexp
8760 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
8761 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
8762 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
8763 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
8764 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
8765
8766 @item button-par
8767 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
8768 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
8769 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
8770
8771 @item use-p
8772 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
8773 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
8774 avoid false matches. Often variables named
8775 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
8776 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
8777
8778 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
8779
8780 @item function
8781 This function will be called when you click on this button.
8782
8783 @item data-par
8784 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
8785 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
8786
8787 @end table
8788
8789 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
8790
8791 @lisp
8792 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
8793 @end lisp
8794
8795 @item gnus-header-button-alist
8796 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
8797 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
8798 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
8799 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
8800
8801 @lisp
8802 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8803 @end lisp
8804
8805 @var{header} is a regular expression.
8806 @end table
8807
8808 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
8809
8810 @table @code
8811 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
8812 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
8813
8814 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
8815
8816 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
8817 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
8818 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
8819 default values of the variables above.
8820
8821 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
8822
8823 @item gnus-button-man-handler
8824 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8825 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
8826 argument with a string naming the man page.
8827
8828 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
8829
8830 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8831 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8832 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
8833
8834 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8835 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8836 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
8837 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
8838 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
8839 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
8840 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
8841 @code{ask}, always query the user what do do. If it is a function, this
8842 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
8843 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
8844 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
8845 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8846
8847 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8848 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8849 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
8850 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
8851 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
8852 string is invalid.
8853
8854 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8855 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8856 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
8857 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8858
8859 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
8860
8861 @item gnus-button-ctan-handler
8862 @findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
8863 The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
8864 argument, the string naming the URL.
8865
8866 @item gnus-ctan-url
8867 @vindex gnus-ctan-url
8868 Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
8869 by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
8870
8871 @c Misc stuff
8872
8873 @item gnus-article-button-face
8874 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
8875 Face used on buttons.
8876
8877 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
8878 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
8879 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
8880
8881 @end table
8882
8883 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
8884
8885
8886 @node Article Button Levels
8887 @subsection Article button levels
8888 @cindex button levels
8889 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
8890 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
8891 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
8892 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
8893 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
8894 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
8895 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
8896 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
8897
8898 @lisp
8899 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
8900 (setq gnus-parameters
8901 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
8902 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
8903 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
8904 @end lisp
8905
8906 @table @code
8907
8908 @item gnus-button-browse-level
8909 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
8910 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
8911 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
8912 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
8913 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
8914
8915 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
8916 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
8917 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
8918 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
8919 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
8920 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
8921 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
8922 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
8923 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
8924 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
8925 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
8926 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
8927 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
8928
8929 @item gnus-button-man-level
8930 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
8931 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
8932 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
8933
8934 @item gnus-button-message-level
8935 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
8936 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
8937 Related variables and functions include
8938 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
8939 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
8940 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
8941 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
8942
8943 @item gnus-button-tex-level
8944 @vindex gnus-button-tex-level
8945 Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
8946 URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
8947 @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
8948 @code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
8949 @code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
8950
8951 @end table
8952
8953
8954 @node Article Date
8955 @subsection Article Date
8956
8957 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
8958 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
8959 when the article was sent.
8960
8961 @table @kbd
8962
8963 @item W T u
8964 @kindex W T u (Summary)
8965 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
8966 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
8967 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
8968
8969 @item W T i
8970 @kindex W T i (Summary)
8971 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
8972 @cindex ISO 8601
8973 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
8974 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
8975
8976 @item W T l
8977 @kindex W T l (Summary)
8978 @findex gnus-article-date-local
8979 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
8980
8981 @item W T p
8982 @kindex W T p (Summary)
8983 @findex gnus-article-date-english
8984 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
8985 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
8986
8987 @item W T s
8988 @kindex W T s (Summary)
8989 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
8990 @findex gnus-article-date-user
8991 @findex format-time-string
8992 Display the date using a user-defined format
8993 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
8994 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
8995 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
8996 for a list of possible format specs.
8997
8998 @item W T e
8999 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9000 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9001 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9002 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9003 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9004 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9005
9006 @example
9007 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9008 @end example
9009
9010 @vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
9011 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
9012 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
9013 replace it.
9014
9015 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
9016 into wonderful absurdities.
9017
9018 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
9019
9020 @lisp
9021 (gnus-start-date-timer)
9022 @end lisp
9023
9024 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
9025 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
9026 command.
9027
9028 @item W T o
9029 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9030 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9031 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9032 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9033 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9034 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9035 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9036
9037 @end table
9038
9039 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9040 preferred format automatically.
9041
9042
9043 @node Article Display
9044 @subsection Article Display
9045 @cindex picons
9046 @cindex x-face
9047 @cindex smileys
9048
9049 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9050 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9051
9052 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9053 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9054
9055 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9056 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9057
9058 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9059 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9060
9061 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9062 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9063
9064 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9065 they'll be removed.
9066
9067 @table @kbd
9068 @item W D x
9069 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9070 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9071 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9072 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9073
9074 @item W D d
9075 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9076 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9077 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9078 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9079
9080 @item W D s
9081 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9082 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9083 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9084
9085 @item W D f
9086 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9087 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9088 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9089
9090 @item W D m
9091 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9092 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9093 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9094 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9095
9096 @item W D n
9097 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9098 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9099 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9100 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9101
9102 @item W D D
9103 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9104 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9105 Remove all images from the article buffer
9106 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9107
9108 @end table
9109
9110
9111
9112 @node Article Signature
9113 @subsection Article Signature
9114 @cindex signatures
9115 @cindex article signature
9116
9117 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9118 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9119 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9120 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9121 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9122 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9123 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9124 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9125 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9126
9127 @lisp
9128 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9129 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9130 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9131 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9132 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9133 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9134 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9135 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9136 @end lisp
9137
9138 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9139 positives.
9140
9141 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9142 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9143 signature when displaying articles.
9144
9145 @enumerate
9146 @item
9147 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9148 that integer.
9149 @item
9150 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9151 than that number.
9152 @item
9153 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9154 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9155 @item
9156 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9157 in question is not a signature.
9158 @end enumerate
9159
9160 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9161 listed above. Here's an example:
9162
9163 @lisp
9164 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9165 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9166 @end lisp
9167
9168 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9169 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9170 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9171 signature after all.
9172
9173
9174 @node Article Miscellanea
9175 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9176
9177 @table @kbd
9178 @item A t
9179 @kindex A t (Summary)
9180 @findex gnus-article-babel
9181 Translate the article from one language to another
9182 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9183
9184 @end table
9185
9186
9187 @node MIME Commands
9188 @section MIME Commands
9189 @cindex MIME decoding
9190 @cindex attachments
9191 @cindex viewing attachments
9192
9193 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9194 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9195
9196 @table @kbd
9197 @item b
9198 @itemx K v
9199 @kindex b (Summary)
9200 @kindex K v (Summary)
9201 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9202
9203 @item K o
9204 @kindex K o (Summary)
9205 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9206
9207 @item K c
9208 @kindex K c (Summary)
9209 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9210
9211 @item K e
9212 @kindex K e (Summary)
9213 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9214
9215 @item K i
9216 @kindex K i (Summary)
9217 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9218
9219 @item K |
9220 @kindex K | (Summary)
9221 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9222 @end table
9223
9224 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9225 the same manner:
9226
9227 @table @kbd
9228 @item K b
9229 @kindex K b (Summary)
9230 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9231 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9232 parts.
9233
9234 @item K m
9235 @kindex K m (Summary)
9236 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9237 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9238 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9239 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9240 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9241
9242 @item X m
9243 @kindex X m (Summary)
9244 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9245 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9246 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9247 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9248
9249 @item M-t
9250 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9251 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9252 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9253 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9254
9255 @item W M w
9256 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9257 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9258 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9259 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9260
9261 @item W M c
9262 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9263 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9264 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9265 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9266
9267 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9268 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9269 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9270 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9271 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9272 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9273
9274 @item W M v
9275 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9276 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9277 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9278 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9279
9280 @end table
9281
9282 Relevant variables:
9283
9284 @table @code
9285 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9286 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9287 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9288 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9289 @code{nil}.
9290
9291 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9292
9293 @lisp
9294 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9295 '("text/x-vcard"))
9296 @end lisp
9297
9298 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9299 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9300 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9301 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9302 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9303 default is @code{nil}.
9304
9305 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9306 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9307 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9308 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9309 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9310 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9311 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}.
9312
9313 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9314 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9315 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9316 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9317 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9318 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9319 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9320 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9321
9322 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9323 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9324 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9325 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9326 displayed. This variable overrides
9327 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9328 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9329 is @code{nil}.
9330
9331 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9332 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9333 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9334
9335 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9336 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9337 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9338 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9339 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9340
9341 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9342 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9343 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9344 default value is @code{nil}.
9345
9346 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9347 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9348 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9349 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9350 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9351 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9352 save all jpegs into some directory).
9353
9354 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9355
9356 @lisp
9357 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9358 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9359 (with-temp-buffer
9360 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9361 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9362 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9363 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9364 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9365 @end lisp
9366
9367 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9368 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9369 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9370
9371 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9372 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9373 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9374
9375 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9376 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9377 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9378
9379 If displaying "text/html" is discouraged, see
9380 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9381 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9382 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9383 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9384
9385 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9386 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9387 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9388 overrides @code{nil} values of
9389 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9390 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9391
9392 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9393 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9394 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9395 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9396
9397 Ready-made functions include@*
9398 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9399 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9400 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9401 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9402 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9403 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9404 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9405 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9406 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9407 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9408 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9409 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9410
9411 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9412 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9413
9414 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9415 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9416 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9417
9418 @lisp
9419 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9420 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9421 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9422 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9423 @end lisp
9424
9425 @noindent
9426 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9427
9428 @end table
9429
9430
9431 @node Charsets
9432 @section Charsets
9433 @cindex charsets
9434
9435 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9436 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9437 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9438 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9439 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9440 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9441 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
9442
9443 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
9444 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
9445 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
9446 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
9447
9448 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
9449 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
9450 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
9451 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
9452 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
9453 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
9454 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
9455 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
9456 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
9457
9458 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
9459 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
9460 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
9461 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
9462 quoted-printable header encoding.
9463
9464 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
9465 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
9466 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
9467
9468 @table @var
9469 @item test
9470 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
9471 variable to query,
9472 @item header
9473 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
9474 means encode all charsets),
9475 @item body-list
9476 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
9477 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
9478 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
9479 @end table
9480
9481 @cindex Russian
9482 @cindex koi8-r
9483 @cindex koi8-u
9484 @cindex iso-8859-5
9485 @cindex coding system aliases
9486 @cindex preferred charset
9487
9488 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
9489 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
9490 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
9491
9492 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
9493
9494 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
9495 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
9496
9497 @lisp
9498 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
9499 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
9500 @end lisp
9501
9502 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
9503 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
9504
9505 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
9506
9507 @lisp
9508 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
9509 @end lisp
9510
9511 This will almost do the right thing.
9512
9513 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
9514 something like
9515
9516 @lisp
9517 (codepage-setup 1251)
9518 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
9519 @end lisp
9520
9521
9522 @node Article Commands
9523 @section Article Commands
9524
9525 @table @kbd
9526
9527 @item A P
9528 @cindex PostScript
9529 @cindex printing
9530 @kindex A P (Summary)
9531 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
9532 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
9533 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
9534 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
9535 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
9536 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
9537
9538 @end table
9539
9540
9541 @node Summary Sorting
9542 @section Summary Sorting
9543 @cindex summary sorting
9544
9545 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
9546 can't really see why you'd want that.
9547
9548 @table @kbd
9549
9550 @item C-c C-s C-n
9551 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
9552 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
9553 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
9554
9555 @item C-c C-s C-a
9556 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
9557 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
9558 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
9559
9560 @item C-c C-s C-s
9561 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
9562 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
9563 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
9564
9565 @item C-c C-s C-d
9566 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
9567 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
9568 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
9569
9570 @item C-c C-s C-l
9571 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
9572 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
9573 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
9574
9575 @item C-c C-s C-c
9576 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
9577 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
9578 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
9579
9580 @item C-c C-s C-i
9581 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
9582 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
9583 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
9584
9585 @item C-c C-s C-r
9586 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
9587 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
9588 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
9589
9590 @item C-c C-s C-o
9591 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
9592 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
9593 Sort using the default sorting method
9594 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
9595 @end table
9596
9597 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
9598 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
9599 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
9600 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
9601 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
9602 Commands}).
9603
9604
9605 @node Finding the Parent
9606 @section Finding the Parent
9607 @cindex parent articles
9608 @cindex referring articles
9609
9610 @table @kbd
9611 @item ^
9612 @kindex ^ (Summary)
9613 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
9614 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
9615 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
9616 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
9617 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
9618 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
9619 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
9620 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
9621 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
9622
9623 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
9624 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
9625 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
9626 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
9627 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
9628 article.
9629
9630 @item A R (Summary)
9631 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
9632 @kindex A R (Summary)
9633 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
9634 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
9635
9636 @item A T (Summary)
9637 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
9638 @kindex A T (Summary)
9639 Display the full thread where the current article appears
9640 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
9641 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
9642 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
9643 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
9644 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
9645 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
9646
9647 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
9648 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
9649 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
9650 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
9651 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
9652 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
9653
9654 @item M-^ (Summary)
9655 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
9656 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
9657 @cindex Message-ID
9658 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
9659 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
9660 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
9661 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
9662 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
9663 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
9664
9665 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
9666 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
9667 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
9668 @end table
9669
9670 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
9671 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
9672 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
9673 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
9674 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
9675 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
9676 necessary.
9677
9678 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
9679 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
9680 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
9681 match.
9682
9683 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
9684 then ask Google if that fails:
9685
9686 @lisp
9687 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
9688 '(current
9689 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
9690 @end lisp
9691
9692 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
9693 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
9694 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
9695 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
9696 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
9697 group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
9698 not support this at all.
9699
9700
9701 @node Alternative Approaches
9702 @section Alternative Approaches
9703
9704 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
9705 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
9706
9707 @menu
9708 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
9709 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
9710 @end menu
9711
9712
9713 @node Pick and Read
9714 @subsection Pick and Read
9715 @cindex pick and read
9716
9717 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
9718 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
9719 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
9720 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
9721
9722 @findex gnus-pick-mode
9723 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
9724 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
9725 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
9726 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
9727 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
9728
9729 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
9730
9731 @table @kbd
9732 @item .
9733 @kindex . (Pick)
9734 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
9735 Pick the article or thread on the current line
9736 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9737 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
9738 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
9739 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
9740 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
9741 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
9742
9743 @item SPACE
9744 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
9745 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
9746 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
9747 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
9748
9749 @item u
9750 @kindex u (Pick)
9751 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
9752 Unpick the thread or article
9753 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9754 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
9755 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
9756 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
9757 the thread or article at that line.
9758
9759 @item RET
9760 @kindex RET (Pick)
9761 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
9762 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
9763 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
9764 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
9765 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
9766 will still be visible when you are reading.
9767
9768 @end table
9769
9770 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
9771 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
9772 which is mapped to the same function
9773 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
9774
9775 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
9776
9777 @lisp
9778 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
9779 @end lisp
9780
9781 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
9782 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
9783
9784 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
9785 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
9786 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
9787
9788 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
9789 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
9790 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
9791 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
9792 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
9793 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
9794 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
9795
9796
9797 @node Binary Groups
9798 @subsection Binary Groups
9799 @cindex binary groups
9800
9801 @findex gnus-binary-mode
9802 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
9803 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
9804 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
9805 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
9806 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
9807 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
9808
9809 @kindex g (Binary)
9810 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
9811 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
9812 command, when you have turned on this mode
9813 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
9814
9815 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
9816 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
9817
9818
9819 @node Tree Display
9820 @section Tree Display
9821 @cindex trees
9822
9823 @vindex gnus-use-trees
9824 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
9825 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
9826 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
9827 in the tree buffer.
9828
9829 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
9830
9831 @table @code
9832 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
9833 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
9834 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
9835
9836 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9837 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9838 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
9839 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
9840 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
9841
9842 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
9843 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
9844 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
9845 default is @code{modeline}.
9846
9847 @item gnus-tree-line-format
9848 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
9849 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
9850 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
9851 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
9852 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
9853 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
9854
9855 Valid specs are:
9856
9857 @table @samp
9858 @item n
9859 The name of the poster.
9860 @item f
9861 The @code{From} header.
9862 @item N
9863 The number of the article.
9864 @item [
9865 The opening bracket.
9866 @item ]
9867 The closing bracket.
9868 @item s
9869 The subject.
9870 @end table
9871
9872 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
9873
9874 Variables related to the display are:
9875
9876 @table @code
9877 @item gnus-tree-brackets
9878 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
9879 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
9880 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
9881 @example
9882 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
9883 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
9884 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
9885 @end example
9886 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
9887
9888 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9889 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9890 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
9891 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
9892
9893 @end table
9894
9895 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
9896 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
9897 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
9898 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
9899 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
9900 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
9901 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
9902 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
9903 other windows displayed next to it.
9904
9905 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
9906 at all times:
9907
9908 @lisp
9909 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
9910 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
9911 @end lisp
9912
9913 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
9914 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
9915 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9916 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
9917 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
9918 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
9919 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
9920
9921 @end table
9922
9923 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
9924
9925 @example
9926 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
9927 | \[Jan]
9928 | \[odd]-[Eri]
9929 | \(***)-[Eri]
9930 | \[odd]-[Paa]
9931 \[Bjo]
9932 \[Gun]
9933 \[Gun]-[Jor]
9934 @end example
9935
9936 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
9937
9938 @example
9939 @group
9940 @{***@}
9941 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
9942 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
9943 |--\-----\-----\ |
9944 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
9945 | | |--\
9946 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
9947 |
9948 [Paa]
9949 @end group
9950 @end example
9951
9952 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
9953 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
9954 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
9955
9956 @lisp
9957 (setq gnus-use-trees t
9958 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9959 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
9960 (gnus-add-configuration
9961 '(article
9962 (vertical 1.0
9963 (horizontal 0.25
9964 (summary 0.75 point)
9965 (tree 1.0))
9966 (article 1.0))))
9967 @end lisp
9968
9969 @xref{Window Layout}.
9970
9971
9972 @node Mail Group Commands
9973 @section Mail Group Commands
9974 @cindex mail group commands
9975
9976 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
9977 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
9978
9979 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
9980 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9981
9982 @table @kbd
9983
9984 @item B e
9985 @kindex B e (Summary)
9986 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
9987 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
9988 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
9989 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
9990 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
9991
9992 @item B C-M-e
9993 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
9994 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
9995 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
9996 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
9997 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
9998 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
9999
10000 @item B DEL
10001 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10002 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10003 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10004 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10005 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10006 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10007
10008 @item B m
10009 @kindex B m (Summary)
10010 @cindex move mail
10011 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10012 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10013 Move the article from one mail group to another
10014 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10015 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10016
10017 @item B c
10018 @kindex B c (Summary)
10019 @cindex copy mail
10020 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10021 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10022 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10023 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10024 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10025
10026 @item B B
10027 @kindex B B (Summary)
10028 @cindex crosspost mail
10029 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10030 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10031 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10032 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10033 be properly updated.
10034
10035 @item B i
10036 @kindex B i (Summary)
10037 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10038 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10039 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10040 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10041
10042 @item B I
10043 @kindex B I (Summary)
10044 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10045 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10046 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10047 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10048
10049 @item B r
10050 @kindex B r (Summary)
10051 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10052 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10053 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10054 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10055 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10056 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10057 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10058 (which is the default).
10059
10060 @item B w
10061 @itemx e
10062 @kindex B w (Summary)
10063 @kindex e (Summary)
10064 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10065 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10066 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10067 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10068 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10069 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10070 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10071
10072 @item B q
10073 @kindex B q (Summary)
10074 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10075 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10076 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10077 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10078
10079 @item B t
10080 @kindex B t (Summary)
10081 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10082 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10083 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10084
10085 @item B p
10086 @kindex B p (Summary)
10087 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10088 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10089 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10090 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10091 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10092 article from your news server (or rather, from
10093 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10094 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10095 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10096 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10097 just not have arrived yet.
10098
10099 @item K E
10100 @kindex K E (Summary)
10101 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10102 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10103 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10104 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10105 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10106
10107 @end table
10108
10109 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10110 @cindex moving articles
10111 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10112 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10113 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10114 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10115 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10116 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10117 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10118
10119 @lisp
10120 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10121 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10122 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10123 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10124 @end lisp
10125
10126
10127 @node Various Summary Stuff
10128 @section Various Summary Stuff
10129
10130 @menu
10131 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10132 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10133 * Summary Generation Commands::
10134 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10135 @end menu
10136
10137 @table @code
10138 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10139 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10140 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10141 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10142 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10143 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10144
10145 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10146 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10147 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10148 current article.
10149
10150 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10151 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10152 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10153
10154 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10155 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10156 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10157 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10158 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10159 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10160 have been set.
10161
10162 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10163 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10164 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10165 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10166 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10167
10168 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10169 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10170 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10171 generated.
10172
10173 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10174 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10175 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10176 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10177 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10178 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10179 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10180 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10181 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10182 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10183
10184 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10185 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10186 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10187 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10188 list of articles to be selected.
10189
10190 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10191 the list in one particular group:
10192
10193 @lisp
10194 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10195 (if (string= group "some.group")
10196 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10197 articles))
10198 @end lisp
10199
10200 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10201 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10202 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10203 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10204 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10205 buffer is active.
10206
10207 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10208 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10209 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10210 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10211 variable will be used instead.
10212
10213 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10214 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10215 buffers. For example:
10216
10217 @lisp
10218 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10219 '(message-use-followup-to
10220 (gnus-visible-headers .
10221 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10222 @end lisp
10223
10224 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10225 @end table
10226
10227
10228 @node Summary Group Information
10229 @subsection Summary Group Information
10230
10231 @table @kbd
10232
10233 @item H f
10234 @kindex H f (Summary)
10235 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
10236 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
10237 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
10238 for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
10239 to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
10240 is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
10241 a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
10242 will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
10243 or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
10244
10245 @item H d
10246 @kindex H d (Summary)
10247 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10248 Give a brief description of the current group
10249 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10250 rereading the description from the server.
10251
10252 @item H h
10253 @kindex H h (Summary)
10254 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10255 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10256 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10257
10258 @item H i
10259 @kindex H i (Summary)
10260 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10261 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10262 @end table
10263
10264
10265 @node Searching for Articles
10266 @subsection Searching for Articles
10267
10268 @table @kbd
10269
10270 @item M-s
10271 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10272 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10273 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10274 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10275
10276 @item M-r
10277 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10278 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10279 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10280 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10281
10282 @item &
10283 @kindex & (Summary)
10284 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10285 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10286 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10287 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10288 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10289 search backward instead.
10290
10291 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10292 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10293
10294 @item M-&
10295 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10296 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10297 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10298 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10299 @end table
10300
10301 @node Summary Generation Commands
10302 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10303
10304 @table @kbd
10305
10306 @item Y g
10307 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10308 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10309 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10310
10311 @item Y c
10312 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10313 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10314 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10315 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10316
10317 @item Y d
10318 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10319 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10320 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10321 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10322
10323 @end table
10324
10325
10326 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10327 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10328
10329 @table @kbd
10330
10331 @item A D
10332 @itemx C-d
10333 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10334 @kindex A D (Summary)
10335 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10336 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10337 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10338 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10339 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10340 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10341 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10342 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10343 fashion.
10344
10345 @item C-M-d
10346 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10347 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10348 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10349 several documents into one biiig group
10350 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10351 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10352 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10353 command understands the process/prefix convention
10354 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10355
10356 @item C-t
10357 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10358 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10359 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10360 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10361 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10362 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10363
10364 @item =
10365 @kindex = (Summary)
10366 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10367 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10368 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10369
10370 @item C-M-e
10371 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10372 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10373 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10374 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10375
10376 @item C-M-a
10377 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10378 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10379 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10380 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
10381
10382 @end table
10383
10384
10385 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
10386 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
10387 @cindex summary exit
10388 @cindex exiting groups
10389
10390 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
10391 group and return you to the group buffer.
10392
10393 @table @kbd
10394
10395 @item Z Z
10396 @itemx Z Q
10397 @itemx q
10398 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
10399 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
10400 @kindex q (Summary)
10401 @findex gnus-summary-exit
10402 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
10403 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
10404 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
10405 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
10406 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
10407 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
10408 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
10409 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
10410 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
10411 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
10412 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
10413
10414 @item Z E
10415 @itemx Q
10416 @kindex Z E (Summary)
10417 @kindex Q (Summary)
10418 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
10419 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
10420 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
10421
10422 @item Z c
10423 @itemx c
10424 @kindex Z c (Summary)
10425 @kindex c (Summary)
10426 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
10427 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
10428 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
10429 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
10430
10431 @item Z C
10432 @kindex Z C (Summary)
10433 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
10434 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
10435 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
10436
10437 @item Z n
10438 @kindex Z n (Summary)
10439 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
10440 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
10441 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
10442
10443 @item Z R
10444 @itemx C-x C-s
10445 @kindex Z R (Summary)
10446 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
10447 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
10448 Exit this group, and then enter it again
10449 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
10450 all articles, both read and unread.
10451
10452 @item Z G
10453 @itemx M-g
10454 @kindex Z G (Summary)
10455 @kindex M-g (Summary)
10456 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
10457 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
10458 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
10459 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
10460 articles, both read and unread.
10461
10462 @item Z N
10463 @kindex Z N (Summary)
10464 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
10465 Exit the group and go to the next group
10466 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
10467
10468 @item Z P
10469 @kindex Z P (Summary)
10470 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
10471 Exit the group and go to the previous group
10472 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
10473
10474 @item Z s
10475 @kindex Z s (Summary)
10476 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
10477 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
10478 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
10479 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
10480 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
10481 @end table
10482
10483 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
10484 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
10485 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
10486 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
10487
10488 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
10489 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
10490 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
10491 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
10492 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
10493 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
10494 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
10495 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
10496 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
10497 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
10498 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
10499 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
10500
10501 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
10502
10503 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
10504 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
10505 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
10506 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
10507 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
10508 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
10509 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
10510 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
10511 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
10512
10513
10514 @node Crosspost Handling
10515 @section Crosspost Handling
10516
10517 @cindex velveeta
10518 @cindex spamming
10519 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
10520 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
10521 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
10522 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
10523 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
10524 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
10525 (@pxref{NoCeM}).
10526
10527 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
10528 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
10529 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
10530 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
10531 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
10532
10533 @cindex cross-posting
10534 @cindex Xref
10535 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
10536 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
10537 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
10538 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
10539 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
10540 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
10541 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
10542 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
10543 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
10544 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
10545 the cross reference mechanism.
10546
10547 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
10548 @cindex overview.fmt
10549 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
10550 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
10551 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
10552 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
10553 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
10554 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
10555 overview files.
10556
10557 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
10558 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
10559 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
10560 considerably.
10561
10562 C'est la vie.
10563
10564 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
10565
10566
10567 @node Duplicate Suppression
10568 @section Duplicate Suppression
10569
10570 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
10571 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
10572 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
10573 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
10574 reasons.
10575
10576 @enumerate
10577 @item
10578 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
10579 is evil and not very common.
10580
10581 @item
10582 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
10583 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
10584
10585 @item
10586 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
10587 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
10588
10589 @item
10590 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
10591 @end enumerate
10592
10593 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
10594 well, but these four are the most common situations.
10595
10596 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
10597 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
10598 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
10599 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
10600 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
10601 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
10602 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
10603 once.
10604
10605 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
10606 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
10607 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
10608 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
10609 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
10610 saw the article in.
10611
10612 @table @code
10613 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
10614 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
10615 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
10616
10617 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
10618 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
10619 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
10620 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
10621 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
10622 session are suppressed.
10623
10624 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
10625 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
10626 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
10627 suppression list. The default is 10000.
10628
10629 @item gnus-duplicate-file
10630 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
10631 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
10632 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
10633 @end table
10634
10635 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
10636 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
10637 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
10638 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
10639 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
10640 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
10641 to you to figure out, I think.
10642
10643 @node Security
10644 @section Security
10645
10646 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
10647 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
10648 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
10649 things to work:
10650
10651 @enumerate
10652 @item
10653 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
10654 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
10655 to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
10656 Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
10657
10658 @item
10659 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
10660 or newer is recommended.
10661
10662 @end enumerate
10663
10664 The variables that control security functionality on reading messages
10665 include:
10666
10667 @table @code
10668 @item mm-verify-option
10669 @vindex mm-verify-option
10670 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
10671 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
10672 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10673
10674 @item mm-decrypt-option
10675 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
10676 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
10677 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
10678 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10679
10680 @item mml1991-use
10681 @vindex mml1991-use
10682 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10683 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10684 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10685 deprecated.
10686
10687 @item mml2015-use
10688 @vindex mml2015-use
10689 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10690 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10691 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10692 deprecated.
10693
10694 @end table
10695
10696 By default the buttons that display security information are not
10697 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
10698 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
10699 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
10700 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
10701 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
10702 how to customize these variables to always display security
10703 information.
10704
10705 @cindex snarfing keys
10706 @cindex importing PGP keys
10707 @cindex PGP key ring import
10708 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
10709 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
10710 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
10711 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
10712 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
10713 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
10714 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
10715 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
10716 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
10717
10718 @example
10719 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
10720 @end example
10721 @noindent
10722 This happens to also be the default action defined in
10723 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
10724
10725 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
10726 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
10727 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
10728
10729 @node Mailing List
10730 @section Mailing List
10731 @cindex mailing list
10732 @cindex RFC 2396
10733
10734 @kindex A M (summary)
10735 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
10736 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
10737 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
10738 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
10739 summary buffer.
10740
10741 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
10742
10743 @table @kbd
10744
10745 @item C-c C-n h
10746 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
10747 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
10748 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
10749
10750 @item C-c C-n s
10751 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
10752 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
10753 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
10754
10755 @item C-c C-n u
10756 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
10757 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
10758 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
10759 field exists.
10760
10761 @item C-c C-n p
10762 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
10763 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
10764 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
10765
10766 @item C-c C-n o
10767 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
10768 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10769 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
10770
10771 @item C-c C-n a
10772 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
10773 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10774 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
10775
10776 @end table
10777
10778
10779 @node Article Buffer
10780 @chapter Article Buffer
10781 @cindex article buffer
10782
10783 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
10784 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
10785 tell Gnus otherwise.
10786
10787 @menu
10788 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
10789 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
10790 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
10791 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
10792 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
10793 @end menu
10794
10795
10796 @node Hiding Headers
10797 @section Hiding Headers
10798 @cindex hiding headers
10799 @cindex deleting headers
10800
10801 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
10802 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
10803
10804 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
10805 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
10806 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
10807 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
10808 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
10809 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
10810 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
10811 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
10812 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
10813
10814 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
10815
10816 @table @code
10817
10818 @item gnus-visible-headers
10819 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
10820 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
10821 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
10822 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
10823
10824 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
10825 the article and the subject, you'd say:
10826
10827 @lisp
10828 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
10829 @end lisp
10830
10831 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10832 remain visible.
10833
10834 @item gnus-ignored-headers
10835 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
10836 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
10837 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
10838 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
10839 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
10840
10841 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
10842 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
10843
10844 @lisp
10845 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
10846 @end lisp
10847
10848 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10849 be removed.
10850
10851 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
10852 variable will have no effect.
10853
10854 @end table
10855
10856 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
10857 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
10858 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
10859 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
10860 the headers are to be displayed.
10861
10862 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
10863 and then the subject, you might say something like:
10864
10865 @lisp
10866 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
10867 @end lisp
10868
10869 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
10870 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
10871
10872 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
10873 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
10874 You can hide further boring headers by setting
10875 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
10876 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
10877 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
10878 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
10879 from sight.
10880
10881 These conditions are:
10882 @table @code
10883 @item empty
10884 Remove all empty headers.
10885 @item followup-to
10886 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
10887 @code{Newsgroups} header.
10888 @item reply-to
10889 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
10890 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
10891 parameter is set.
10892 @item newsgroups
10893 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
10894 name.
10895 @item to-address
10896 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10897 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
10898 @item to-list
10899 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10900 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10901 @item cc-list
10902 Remove the @code{CC} header if it only contains the address identical to
10903 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10904 @item date
10905 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
10906 old.
10907 @item long-to
10908 Remove the @code{To} header if it is very long.
10909 @item many-to
10910 Remove all @code{To} headers if there are more than one.
10911 @end table
10912
10913 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
10914
10915 @lisp
10916 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
10917 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
10918 @end lisp
10919
10920 This is also the default value for this variable.
10921
10922
10923 @node Using MIME
10924 @section Using MIME
10925 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
10926
10927 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
10928 while people stand around yawning.
10929
10930 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
10931 while all newsreaders die of fear.
10932
10933 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
10934 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
10935 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
10936
10937 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
10938 @findex gnus-display-mime
10939 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
10940 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
10941 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
10942 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
10943
10944 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
10945 @acronym{MIME} button:
10946
10947 @table @kbd
10948 @findex gnus-article-press-button
10949 @item RET (Article)
10950 @kindex RET (Article)
10951 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
10952 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
10953 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
10954 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
10955 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
10956 object is displayed inline.
10957
10958 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
10959 @item M-RET (Article)
10960 @kindex M-RET (Article)
10961 @itemx v (Article)
10962 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
10963 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
10964
10965 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
10966 @item t (Article)
10967 @kindex t (Article)
10968 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
10969 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
10970
10971 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
10972 @item C (Article)
10973 @kindex C (Article)
10974 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
10975 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
10976
10977 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
10978 @item o (Article)
10979 @kindex o (Article)
10980 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
10981 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
10982
10983 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
10984 @item C-o (Article)
10985 @kindex C-o (Article)
10986 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
10987 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
10988 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
10989 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
10990 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
10991 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
10992
10993 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
10994 @item d (Article)
10995 @kindex d (Article)
10996 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
10997 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
10998 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
10999
11000 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11001 @item c (Article)
11002 @kindex c (Article)
11003 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11004 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11005 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11006 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11007 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11008
11009 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11010 @item p (Article)
11011 @kindex p (Article)
11012 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11013 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11014 @file{.mailcap} file.
11015
11016 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11017 @item i (Article)
11018 @kindex i (Article)
11019 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11020 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
11021 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11022 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11023 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11024 Article}).
11025
11026 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11027 @item E (Article)
11028 @kindex E (Article)
11029 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11030 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11031 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11032
11033 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11034 @item e (Article)
11035 @kindex e (Article)
11036 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11037 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11038
11039 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11040 @item | (Article)
11041 @kindex | (Article)
11042 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11043
11044 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11045 @item . (Article)
11046 @kindex . (Article)
11047 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11048 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11049
11050 @end table
11051
11052 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11053 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11054 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11055
11056 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11057 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11058 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11059 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11060 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11061 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11062 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11063 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11064 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11065
11066 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11067
11068 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11069
11070
11071 @node Customizing Articles
11072 @section Customizing Articles
11073 @cindex article customization
11074
11075 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11076 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11077 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11078 called automatically when you select the articles.
11079
11080 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11081 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11082 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11083 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11084
11085 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11086 for sensible values.
11087
11088 @enumerate
11089 @item
11090 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11091
11092 @item
11093 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11094
11095 @item
11096 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11097
11098 @item
11099 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
11100
11101 @item
11102 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11103 than this number.
11104
11105 @item
11106 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11107 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11108 regexps in the list.
11109
11110 @item
11111 A list where the first element is not a string:
11112
11113 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11114 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11115 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11116
11117 @lisp
11118 (or last
11119 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11120 @end lisp
11121
11122 @end enumerate
11123
11124 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11125 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11126 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11127 considered to contain just a single part.
11128
11129 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11130 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11131 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11132 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11133 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11134 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11135 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11136
11137 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11138 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11139 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11140 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11141
11142 @table @code
11143 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11144 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11145
11146 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11147
11148 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11149 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11150 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11151 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11152 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
11153 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11154 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11155 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11156 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11157 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11158
11159 @xref{Article Washing}.
11160
11161 @item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
11162 @item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
11163 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
11164 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
11165 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
11166 @item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
11167 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
11168
11169 @xref{Article Date}.
11170
11171 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11172 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11173 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11174
11175 @xref{Picons}.
11176
11177 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11178
11179 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11180
11181 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11182 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11183 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11184
11185 @xref{Smileys}.
11186
11187 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11188
11189 @xref{X-Face}.
11190
11191 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11192
11193 @xref{Face}.
11194
11195 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
11196 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
11197 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
11198 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
11199 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
11200 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
11201 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
11202 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
11203 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
11204 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
11205
11206 @xref{Article Hiding}.
11207
11208 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
11209 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
11210 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
11211
11212 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
11213
11214 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
11215 @item gnus-treat-translate
11216 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
11217
11218 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
11219 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
11220 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
11221 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
11222
11223 @xref{Article Header}.
11224
11225
11226 @end table
11227
11228 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
11229 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
11230 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
11231 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
11232 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
11233 everything.
11234
11235
11236 @node Article Keymap
11237 @section Article Keymap
11238
11239 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
11240 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
11241 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
11242 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
11243 buffer.
11244
11245 A few additional keystrokes are available:
11246
11247 @table @kbd
11248
11249 @item SPACE
11250 @kindex SPACE (Article)
11251 @findex gnus-article-next-page
11252 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
11253 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
11254
11255 @item DEL
11256 @kindex DEL (Article)
11257 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
11258 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
11259 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
11260
11261 @item C-c ^
11262 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
11263 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
11264 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
11265 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
11266 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
11267
11268 @item C-c C-m
11269 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
11270 @findex gnus-article-mail
11271 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
11272 given a prefix, include the mail.
11273
11274 @item s
11275 @kindex s (Article)
11276 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
11277 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
11278 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
11279
11280 @item ?
11281 @kindex ? (Article)
11282 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
11283 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
11284 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
11285
11286 @item TAB
11287 @kindex TAB (Article)
11288 @findex gnus-article-next-button
11289 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
11290 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
11291
11292 @item M-TAB
11293 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
11294 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
11295 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
11296
11297 @item R
11298 @kindex R (Article)
11299 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
11300 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
11301 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If given a prefix, make a
11302 wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11303 region.
11304
11305 @item F
11306 @kindex F (Article)
11307 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
11308 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
11309 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If given a prefix, make
11310 a wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11311 region.
11312
11313
11314 @end table
11315
11316
11317 @node Misc Article
11318 @section Misc Article
11319
11320 @table @code
11321
11322 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
11323 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
11324 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
11325 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
11326 article buffer.
11327
11328 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
11329 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
11330 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11331 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
11332 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
11333
11334 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
11335 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
11336 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
11337 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
11338 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
11339 the contents of the article buffer.
11340
11341 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
11342 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
11343 Hook called in article mode buffers.
11344
11345 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11346 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11347 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
11348 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
11349
11350 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
11351 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
11352 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
11353 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
11354
11355 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
11356 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
11357 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
11358 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
11359 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
11360 with two extensions:
11361
11362 @table @samp
11363
11364 @item w
11365 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
11366 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
11367 performed. The characters and their meaning:
11368
11369 @table @samp
11370
11371 @item c
11372 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
11373
11374 @item h
11375 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
11376
11377 @item p
11378 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
11379 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
11380 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
11381
11382 @item s
11383 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
11384
11385 @item o
11386 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
11387
11388 @item e
11389 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
11390
11391 @end table
11392
11393 @item m
11394 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
11395
11396 @end table
11397
11398 @vindex gnus-break-pages
11399
11400 @item gnus-break-pages
11401 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
11402 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
11403 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
11404 paging will not be done.
11405
11406 @item gnus-page-delimiter
11407 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
11408 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
11409 (formfeed).
11410
11411 @cindex IDNA
11412 @cindex internationalized domain names
11413 @vindex gnus-use-idna
11414 @item gnus-use-idna
11415 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
11416 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
11417 @samp{Cc} headers. This requires
11418 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
11419 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
11420
11421 @end table
11422
11423
11424 @node Composing Messages
11425 @chapter Composing Messages
11426 @cindex composing messages
11427 @cindex messages
11428 @cindex mail
11429 @cindex sending mail
11430 @cindex reply
11431 @cindex followup
11432 @cindex post
11433 @cindex using gpg
11434 @cindex using s/mime
11435 @cindex using smime
11436
11437 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
11438 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
11439 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
11440 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
11441 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
11442 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
11443
11444 @menu
11445 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
11446 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
11447 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
11448 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
11449 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
11450 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
11451 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
11452 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
11453 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
11454 @end menu
11455
11456 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
11457 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
11458
11459
11460 @node Mail
11461 @section Mail
11462
11463 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
11464
11465 @table @code
11466 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
11467 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
11468 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
11469 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
11470 @code{nil} include all headers.
11471
11472 @item gnus-add-to-list
11473 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
11474 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
11475 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
11476
11477 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11478 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11479 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
11480 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
11481 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
11482 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
11483 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
11484 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
11485
11486 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
11487 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
11488
11489 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11490 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11491 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
11492 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
11493 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
11494
11495 @end table
11496
11497
11498 @node Posting Server
11499 @section Posting Server
11500
11501 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
11502 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
11503
11504 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
11505
11506 It can be quite complicated.
11507
11508 @vindex gnus-post-method
11509 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
11510 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
11511 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
11512 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
11513 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
11514 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
11515 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
11516 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
11517 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
11518
11519 @lisp
11520 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
11521 @end lisp
11522
11523 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
11524 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
11525 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
11526 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
11527
11528 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
11529 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
11530
11531 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
11532 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
11533 for posting.
11534
11535 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
11536 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
11537
11538 When sending mail, Message invokes @code{message-send-mail-function}.
11539 The default function, @code{message-send-mail-with-sendmail}, pipes
11540 your article to the @code{sendmail} binary for further queuing and
11541 sending. When your local system is not configured for sending mail
11542 using @code{sendmail}, and you have access to a remote @acronym{SMTP}
11543 server, you can set @code{message-send-mail-function} to
11544 @code{smtpmail-send-it} and make sure to setup the @code{smtpmail}
11545 package correctly. An example:
11546
11547 @lisp
11548 (setq message-send-mail-function 'smtpmail-send-it
11549 smtpmail-default-smtp-server "YOUR SMTP HOST")
11550 @end lisp
11551
11552 To the thing similar to this, there is
11553 @code{message-smtpmail-send-it}. It is useful if your @acronym{ISP}
11554 requires the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication.
11555 @xref{POP before SMTP}.
11556
11557 Other possible choices for @code{message-send-mail-function} includes
11558 @code{message-send-mail-with-mh}, @code{message-send-mail-with-qmail},
11559 and @code{feedmail-send-it}.
11560
11561 @node POP before SMTP
11562 @section POP before SMTP
11563 @cindex pop before smtp
11564 @findex message-smtpmail-send-it
11565 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
11566
11567 Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
11568 authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
11569 mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
11570 a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
11571 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11572
11573 @lisp
11574 (setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
11575 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
11576 @end lisp
11577
11578 @noindent
11579 It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
11580 whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
11581 does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
11582 @code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
11583 Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
11584 @code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
11585 set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
11586 correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
11587
11588 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
11589 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
11590 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
11591 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
11592 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
11593 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
11594
11595 @lisp
11596 (setq mail-source-primary-source
11597 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11598 :password "secret"))
11599 @end lisp
11600
11601 @noindent
11602 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
11603 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
11604
11605 @lisp
11606 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
11607 (lambda ()
11608 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
11609 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11610 :password "secret")))
11611 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
11612 @end lisp
11613
11614 @node Mail and Post
11615 @section Mail and Post
11616
11617 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
11618 posting:
11619
11620 @table @code
11621 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
11622 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
11623 @cindex mailing lists
11624
11625 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
11626 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
11627 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
11628 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
11629 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
11630 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
11631 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
11632 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
11633 still a pain, though.
11634
11635 @item gnus-user-agent
11636 @vindex gnus-user-agent
11637 @cindex User-Agent
11638
11639 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
11640 User-Agent header. It can be one of the symbols @code{gnus} (show only
11641 Gnus version), @code{emacs-gnus} (show only Emacs and Gnus versions),
11642 @code{emacs-gnus-config} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus system
11643 configuration), @code{emacs-gnus-type} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus
11644 system type) or a custom string. If you set it to a string, be sure to
11645 use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
11646
11647 @end table
11648
11649 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
11650 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
11651 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
11652
11653 @cindex ispell
11654 @findex ispell-message
11655 @lisp
11656 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
11657 @end lisp
11658
11659 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
11660 you're in, you could say something like the following:
11661
11662 @lisp
11663 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
11664 (lambda ()
11665 (cond
11666 ((string-match
11667 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
11668 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
11669 (t
11670 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
11671 @end lisp
11672
11673 Modify to suit your needs.
11674
11675
11676 @node Archived Messages
11677 @section Archived Messages
11678 @cindex archived messages
11679 @cindex sent messages
11680
11681 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
11682 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
11683 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
11684 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
11685 is the default.
11686
11687 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
11688 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
11689 Group Commands}).
11690
11691 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
11692 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
11693 use to store sent messages. The default is:
11694
11695 @lisp
11696 (nnfolder "archive"
11697 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
11698 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
11699 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
11700 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
11701 @end lisp
11702
11703 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
11704 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
11705 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
11706 directory chosen, you could say something like:
11707
11708 @lisp
11709 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
11710 '(nnfolder "archive"
11711 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
11712 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
11713 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
11714 @end lisp
11715
11716 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
11717 @cindex Gcc
11718 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
11719 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
11720 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
11721
11722 This variable can be used to do the following:
11723
11724 @table @asis
11725 @item a string
11726 Messages will be saved in that group.
11727
11728 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
11729 message will not be stored in the select method given by
11730 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
11731 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
11732 has the default value shown above. Then setting
11733 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
11734 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
11735 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
11736 @samp{nnml:foo}.
11737
11738 @item a list of strings
11739 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
11740
11741 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
11742 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
11743
11744 @item @code{nil}
11745 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
11746 @end table
11747
11748 Let's illustrate:
11749
11750 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
11751 @lisp
11752 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
11753 @end lisp
11754
11755 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
11756 @lisp
11757 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
11758 @end lisp
11759
11760 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
11761 @lisp
11762 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11763 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
11764 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
11765 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
11766 @end lisp
11767
11768 More complex stuff:
11769 @lisp
11770 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11771 '((if (message-news-p)
11772 "misc-news"
11773 "misc-mail")))
11774 @end lisp
11775
11776 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
11777 messages in one file per month:
11778
11779 @lisp
11780 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11781 '((if (message-news-p)
11782 "misc-news"
11783 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
11784 @end lisp
11785
11786 @c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
11787 @c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
11788
11789 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
11790 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
11791 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
11792 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
11793 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
11794 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
11795 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
11796 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
11797 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
11798 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
11799
11800 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
11801 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
11802 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
11803 this will disable archiving.
11804
11805 @table @code
11806 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
11807 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
11808 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
11809 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
11810 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
11811 group names.
11812
11813 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
11814 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
11815 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
11816 of names).
11817
11818 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
11819 but the latter is the preferred method.
11820
11821 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11822 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11823 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
11824
11825 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11826 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11827 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
11828 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
11829 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
11830 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
11831 changed in the future.
11832
11833 @end table
11834
11835
11836 @node Posting Styles
11837 @section Posting Styles
11838 @cindex posting styles
11839 @cindex styles
11840
11841 All them variables, they make my head swim.
11842
11843 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
11844 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
11845 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
11846 on?
11847
11848 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
11849 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
11850 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
11851 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
11852 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
11853 variable:
11854
11855 @lisp
11856 ((".*"
11857 (signature "Peace and happiness")
11858 (organization "What me?"))
11859 ("^comp"
11860 (signature "Death to everybody"))
11861 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
11862 (organization "Emacs is it")))
11863 @end lisp
11864
11865 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
11866 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
11867 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
11868 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
11869 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
11870 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
11871 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
11872 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
11873
11874 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
11875 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
11876 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
11877 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
11878 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
11879 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
11880 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
11881 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
11882 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
11883 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
11884 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
11885 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
11886 said to @dfn{match}.
11887
11888 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
11889 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
11890 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
11891 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
11892 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
11893 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
11894 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
11895 name can be one of:
11896
11897 @itemize @bullet
11898 @item @code{signature}
11899 @item @code{signature-file}
11900 @item @code{x-face-file}
11901 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
11902 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
11903 @item @code{body}
11904 @end itemize
11905
11906 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
11907 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
11908 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
11909 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
11910 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
11911
11912 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
11913 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
11914 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
11915 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
11916 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
11917 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
11918 is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
11919 references chars lines xref extra.
11920
11921 @vindex message-reply-headers
11922
11923 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
11924 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
11925 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
11926
11927 @findex message-mail-p
11928 @findex message-news-p
11929
11930 So here's a new example:
11931
11932 @lisp
11933 (setq gnus-posting-styles
11934 '((".*"
11935 (signature-file "~/.signature")
11936 (name "User Name")
11937 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
11938 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
11939 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
11940 ("^rec.humor"
11941 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
11942 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
11943 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
11944 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
11945 (signature my-news-signature))
11946 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
11947 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
11948 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
11949 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
11950 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
11951 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
11952 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
11953 (address "user@@bar.foo")
11954 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
11955 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
11956 ("nnml:.*"
11957 (From (save-excursion
11958 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
11959 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
11960 ("^nn.+:"
11961 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
11962 @end lisp
11963
11964 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
11965 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
11966 if you fill many roles.
11967
11968
11969 @node Drafts
11970 @section Drafts
11971 @cindex drafts
11972
11973 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
11974 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
11975 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
11976 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
11977 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
11978
11979 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
11980 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
11981 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
11982 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
11983 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
11984 group.)
11985
11986 @cindex nndraft
11987 @vindex nndraft-directory
11988 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
11989 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
11990 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
11991 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
11992 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
11993 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
11994
11995 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
11996 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
11997 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
11998 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
11999 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12000 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12001 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12002 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12003 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12004
12005 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12006 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12007 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12008 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12009 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12010 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12011 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12012 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12013 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12014 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12015 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12016 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12017 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12018 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12019 @c
12020 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12021 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12022 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12023
12024 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12025 @kindex D e (Draft)
12026 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12027 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12028 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12029
12030 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12031 Articles}).
12032
12033 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12034 @kindex D s (Draft)
12035 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12036 @kindex D S (Draft)
12037 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12038 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12039 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12040 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12041 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12042 in the buffer.
12043
12044 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12045 @kindex D t (Draft)
12046 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12047 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12048 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12049
12050
12051 @node Rejected Articles
12052 @section Rejected Articles
12053 @cindex rejected articles
12054
12055 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12056 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12057 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12058 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12059
12060 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12061 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12062 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12063 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12064 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12065
12066 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12067 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12068 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12069
12070 @node Signing and encrypting
12071 @section Signing and encrypting
12072 @cindex using gpg
12073 @cindex using s/mime
12074 @cindex using smime
12075
12076 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12077 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12078 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12079 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12080
12081 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12082 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12083 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12084 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12085 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12086 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12087 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12088 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12089 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12090 automatically encrypted messages.
12091
12092 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12093 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12094 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12095
12096 @table @kbd
12097
12098 @item C-c C-m s s
12099 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12100 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12101
12102 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12103
12104 @item C-c C-m s o
12105 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12106 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12107
12108 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12109
12110 @item C-c C-m s p
12111 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12112 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12113
12114 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12115
12116 @item C-c C-m c s
12117 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12118 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12119
12120 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12121
12122 @item C-c C-m c o
12123 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12124 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
12125
12126 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12127
12128 @item C-c C-m c p
12129 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
12130 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
12131
12132 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12133
12134 @item C-c C-m C-n
12135 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
12136 @findex mml-unsecure-message
12137 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
12138
12139 @end table
12140
12141 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
12142
12143 @node Select Methods
12144 @chapter Select Methods
12145 @cindex foreign groups
12146 @cindex select methods
12147
12148 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
12149 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
12150 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
12151 personal mail group.
12152
12153 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
12154 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
12155 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
12156 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
12157 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
12158 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
12159
12160 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
12161 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
12162
12163 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
12164 group as.
12165
12166 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
12167 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
12168 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
12169 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
12170 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
12171
12172 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
12173
12174 @menu
12175 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
12176 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
12177 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
12178 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
12179 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
12180 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
12181 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
12182 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
12183 @end menu
12184
12185
12186 @node Server Buffer
12187 @section Server Buffer
12188
12189 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
12190 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
12191 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
12192 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
12193 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
12194 back end represents a virtual server.
12195
12196 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
12197 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
12198 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
12199 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
12200
12201 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
12202 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
12203 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
12204 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
12205 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
12206 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
12207 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
12208
12209 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
12210 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
12211
12212 @menu
12213 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
12214 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
12215 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
12216 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
12217 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
12218 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
12219 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
12220 @end menu
12221
12222 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
12223 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
12224
12225
12226 @node Server Buffer Format
12227 @subsection Server Buffer Format
12228 @cindex server buffer format
12229
12230 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
12231 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
12232 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
12233 variable, with some simple extensions:
12234
12235 @table @samp
12236
12237 @item h
12238 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
12239
12240 @item n
12241 The name of this server.
12242
12243 @item w
12244 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
12245
12246 @item s
12247 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
12248
12249 @item a
12250 Whether this server is agentized.
12251 @end table
12252
12253 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
12254 The mode line can also be customized by using the
12255 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
12256 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
12257
12258 @table @samp
12259 @item S
12260 Server name.
12261
12262 @item M
12263 Server method.
12264 @end table
12265
12266 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
12267
12268
12269 @node Server Commands
12270 @subsection Server Commands
12271 @cindex server commands
12272
12273 @table @kbd
12274
12275 @item a
12276 @kindex a (Server)
12277 @findex gnus-server-add-server
12278 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
12279
12280 @item e
12281 @kindex e (Server)
12282 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
12283 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
12284
12285 @item SPACE
12286 @kindex SPACE (Server)
12287 @findex gnus-server-read-server
12288 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
12289
12290 @item q
12291 @kindex q (Server)
12292 @findex gnus-server-exit
12293 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
12294
12295 @item k
12296 @kindex k (Server)
12297 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
12298 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
12299
12300 @item y
12301 @kindex y (Server)
12302 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
12303 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
12304
12305 @item c
12306 @kindex c (Server)
12307 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
12308 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
12309
12310 @item l
12311 @kindex l (Server)
12312 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
12313 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
12314
12315 @item s
12316 @kindex s (Server)
12317 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
12318 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
12319 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
12320 servers.
12321
12322 @item g
12323 @kindex g (Server)
12324 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
12325 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
12326 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
12327 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
12328
12329 @end table
12330
12331
12332 @node Example Methods
12333 @subsection Example Methods
12334
12335 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
12336
12337 @lisp
12338 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
12339 @end lisp
12340
12341 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
12342
12343 @lisp
12344 (nnspool "")
12345 @end lisp
12346
12347 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
12348 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
12349 will.
12350
12351 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
12352 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
12353
12354 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
12355 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
12356 look like then:
12357
12358 @lisp
12359 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
12360 @end lisp
12361
12362 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
12363 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
12364
12365 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
12366 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
12367 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
12368 your private mail:
12369
12370 @lisp
12371 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
12372 @end lisp
12373
12374 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
12375 that.)
12376
12377 Here's the method for a public spool:
12378
12379 @lisp
12380 (nnmh "public"
12381 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
12382 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
12383 @end lisp
12384
12385 @cindex proxy
12386 @cindex firewall
12387
12388 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
12389 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
12390 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12391 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
12392 should probably look something like this:
12393
12394 @lisp
12395 (nntp "firewall"
12396 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
12397 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
12398 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host")
12399 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12400 @end lisp
12401
12402 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
12403 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
12404 configuration to the example above:
12405
12406 @lisp
12407 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
12408 @end lisp
12409
12410 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}.
12411
12412 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
12413 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
12414 telnet connection to the news server as follows:
12415
12416 @lisp
12417 (nntp "outside"
12418 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12419 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-telnet)
12420 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
12421 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12422 @end lisp
12423
12424 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
12425 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
12426 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
12427 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
12428
12429
12430 @node Creating a Virtual Server
12431 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
12432
12433 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
12434 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
12435
12436 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
12437 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
12438 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
12439
12440 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
12441
12442 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
12443 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
12444 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
12445 will contain the following:
12446
12447 @lisp
12448 (nnml "cache")
12449 @end lisp
12450
12451 Change that to:
12452
12453 @lisp
12454 (nnml "cache"
12455 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
12456 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
12457 @end lisp
12458
12459 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
12460 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
12461 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
12462
12463
12464 @node Server Variables
12465 @subsection Server Variables
12466 @cindex server variables
12467 @cindex server parameters
12468
12469 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
12470 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
12471 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
12472 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
12473 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
12474
12475 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
12476 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
12477 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
12478 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
12479 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
12480 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
12481 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
12482 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
12483 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
12484
12485 @lisp
12486 (nnml "public"
12487 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
12488 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
12489 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
12490 @end lisp
12491
12492 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
12493
12494 @node Servers and Methods
12495 @subsection Servers and Methods
12496
12497 Wherever you would normally use a select method
12498 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
12499 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
12500 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
12501 over.
12502
12503
12504 @node Unavailable Servers
12505 @subsection Unavailable Servers
12506
12507 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
12508 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
12509 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
12510 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
12511 actually the case or not.
12512
12513 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
12514 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
12515 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
12516 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
12517 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
12518 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
12519 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
12520 it will regard that server as ``down''.
12521
12522 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
12523 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
12524
12525 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
12526 with the following commands:
12527
12528 @table @kbd
12529
12530 @item O
12531 @kindex O (Server)
12532 @findex gnus-server-open-server
12533 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
12534 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
12535
12536 @item C
12537 @kindex C (Server)
12538 @findex gnus-server-close-server
12539 Close the connection (if any) to the server
12540 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
12541
12542 @item D
12543 @kindex D (Server)
12544 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
12545 Mark the current server as unreachable
12546 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
12547
12548 @item M-o
12549 @kindex M-o (Server)
12550 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
12551 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
12552 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
12553
12554 @item M-c
12555 @kindex M-c (Server)
12556 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
12557 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
12558 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
12559
12560 @item R
12561 @kindex R (Server)
12562 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
12563 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
12564 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
12565
12566 @item L
12567 @kindex L (Server)
12568 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
12569 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
12570
12571 @end table
12572
12573
12574 @node Getting News
12575 @section Getting News
12576 @cindex reading news
12577 @cindex news back ends
12578
12579 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
12580 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
12581 or it can read from a local spool.
12582
12583 @menu
12584 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12585 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
12586 @end menu
12587
12588
12589 @node NNTP
12590 @subsection NNTP
12591 @cindex nntp
12592
12593 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
12594 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
12595 server as the, uhm, address.
12596
12597 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
12598 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
12599 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
12600 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12601
12602 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
12603 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
12604 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
12605
12606 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
12607 server:
12608
12609 @table @code
12610
12611 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
12612 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
12613 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
12614 @cindex authinfo
12615 @cindex authentification
12616 @cindex nntp authentification
12617 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12618 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
12619 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
12620 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
12621 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
12622 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
12623 present in this hook.
12624
12625 @item nntp-authinfo-function
12626 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
12627 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12628 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
12629 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
12630 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
12631 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
12632 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
12633 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
12634 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
12635 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
12636 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
12637
12638 @enumerate
12639 @item
12640 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
12641
12642 @item
12643 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
12644
12645 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
12646 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
12647 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
12648 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
12649 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
12650 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
12651 @samp{force} is explained below.
12652
12653 @end enumerate
12654
12655 Here's an example file:
12656
12657 @example
12658 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
12659 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
12660 @end example
12661
12662 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
12663 have to be first, for instance.
12664
12665 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
12666 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
12667 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
12668 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
12669 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
12670 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
12671 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
12672
12673 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
12674 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
12675
12676 @example
12677 default force yes
12678 @end example
12679
12680 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
12681 previously mentioned.
12682
12683 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
12684
12685 @item nntp-server-action-alist
12686 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
12687 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
12688 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
12689 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
12690
12691 @lisp
12692 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
12693 '(("innd" (ding))))
12694 @end lisp
12695
12696 You probably don't want to do that, though.
12697
12698 The default value is
12699
12700 @lisp
12701 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
12702 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
12703 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
12704 @end lisp
12705
12706 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
12707 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
12708
12709 @item nntp-maximum-request
12710 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
12711 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
12712 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
12713 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
12714 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
12715 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
12716 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
12717
12718 @item nntp-connection-timeout
12719 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
12720 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
12721 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
12722 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
12723 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
12724 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
12725 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
12726 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
12727 no timeouts are done.
12728
12729 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
12730 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
12731 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
12732 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
12733 can be used.
12734
12735 @item nntp-xover-commands
12736 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
12737 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
12738 @cindex XOVER
12739 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
12740 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
12741 "XOVERVIEW")}.
12742
12743 @item nntp-nov-gap
12744 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
12745 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
12746 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
12747 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
12748 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
12749 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
12750 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
12751 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
12752 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
12753 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
12754 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
12755
12756 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
12757 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
12758 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12759
12760 @item nntp-record-commands
12761 @vindex nntp-record-commands
12762 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
12763 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
12764 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
12765 that doesn't seem to work.
12766
12767 @item nntp-open-connection-function
12768 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
12769 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
12770 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
12771 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
12772 Six pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped in
12773 two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
12774 indirect ones (two pre-made).
12775
12776 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
12777 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
12778 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
12779 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
12780 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
12781 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
12782 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
12783
12784 @lisp
12785 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
12786 @end lisp
12787
12788 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
12789 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
12790
12791 @end table
12792
12793 @menu
12794 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
12795 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
12796 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
12797 @end menu
12798
12799
12800 @node Direct Functions
12801 @subsubsection Direct Functions
12802 @cindex direct connection functions
12803
12804 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
12805 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
12806 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
12807 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12808
12809 @table @code
12810 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
12811 @item nntp-open-network-stream
12812 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
12813 remote system.
12814
12815 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
12816 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
12817 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12818 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
12819 installed. You then define a server as follows:
12820
12821 @lisp
12822 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12823 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
12824 ;;
12825 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12826 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
12827 (nntp-port-number )
12828 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12829 @end lisp
12830
12831 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
12832 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
12833 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12834 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
12835 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
12836 then define a server as follows:
12837
12838 @lisp
12839 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12840 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
12841 ;;
12842 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12843 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
12844 (nntp-port-number 563)
12845 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12846 @end lisp
12847
12848 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
12849 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
12850 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server by simply @samp{telnet}'ing
12851 it. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have the
12852 default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
12853 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
12854 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
12855 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
12856
12857 @lisp
12858 (nntp "socksified"
12859 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12860 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
12861 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
12862 @end lisp
12863
12864 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
12865 session, which is not a good idea.
12866 @end table
12867
12868
12869 @node Indirect Functions
12870 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
12871 @cindex indirect connection functions
12872
12873 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
12874 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12875 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
12876 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
12877 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
12878 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12879
12880 @table @code
12881 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12882 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12883 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet}
12884 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
12885 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
12886
12887 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12888
12889 @table @code
12890 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
12891 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
12892 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
12893 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
12894
12895 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12896 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12897 List of strings to be used as the switches to
12898 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
12899 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
12900 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections, otherwise set
12901 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
12902 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
12903 host.
12904 @end table
12905
12906 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12907 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12908 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
12909 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
12910
12911 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12912
12913 @table @code
12914 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
12915 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
12916 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
12917 @samp{telnet}.
12918
12919 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
12920 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
12921 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
12922 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
12923
12924 @item nntp-via-user-password
12925 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
12926 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
12927
12928 @item nntp-via-envuser
12929 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
12930 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
12931 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
12932 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
12933
12934 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
12935 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
12936 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
12937 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
12938
12939 @end table
12940
12941 @end table
12942
12943
12944 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
12945 functions:
12946
12947 @table @code
12948
12949 @item nntp-via-user-name
12950 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
12951 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
12952
12953 @item nntp-via-address
12954 @vindex nntp-via-address
12955 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
12956
12957 @end table
12958
12959
12960 @node Common Variables
12961 @subsubsection Common Variables
12962
12963 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
12964 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
12965 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
12966 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
12967 variables individually).
12968
12969 @table @code
12970
12971 @item nntp-pre-command
12972 @vindex nntp-pre-command
12973 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
12974 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
12975 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
12976 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
12977
12978 @item nntp-address
12979 @vindex nntp-address
12980 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12981
12982 @item nntp-port-number
12983 @vindex nntp-port-number
12984 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
12985 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
12986 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
12987 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
12988 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
12989 not work with named ports.
12990
12991 @item nntp-end-of-line
12992 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
12993 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
12994 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
12995 using a non native connection function.
12996
12997 @item nntp-telnet-command
12998 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
12999 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
13000 @samp{telnet}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
13001 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
13002 @samp{telnet}.
13003
13004 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13005 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13006 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-telnet-command}. The default
13007 is @samp{("-8")}.
13008
13009 @end table
13010
13011
13012 @node News Spool
13013 @subsection News Spool
13014 @cindex nnspool
13015 @cindex news spool
13016
13017 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
13018 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
13019 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
13020 instance.
13021
13022 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
13023 anything else) as the address.
13024
13025 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
13026 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
13027 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
13028 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
13029
13030 @table @code
13031
13032 @item nnspool-inews-program
13033 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
13034 Program used to post an article.
13035
13036 @item nnspool-inews-switches
13037 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
13038 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
13039
13040 @item nnspool-spool-directory
13041 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
13042 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
13043 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
13044
13045 @item nnspool-nov-directory
13046 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
13047 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
13048 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
13049
13050 @item nnspool-lib-dir
13051 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
13052 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
13053
13054 @item nnspool-active-file
13055 @vindex nnspool-active-file
13056 The name of the active file.
13057
13058 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
13059 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
13060 The name of the group descriptions file.
13061
13062 @item nnspool-history-file
13063 @vindex nnspool-history-file
13064 The name of the news history file.
13065
13066 @item nnspool-active-times-file
13067 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
13068 The name of the active date file.
13069
13070 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
13071 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
13072 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
13073 that it finds.
13074
13075 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13076 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13077 @cindex sed
13078 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
13079 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
13080 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
13081 there.
13082
13083 @end table
13084
13085
13086 @node Getting Mail
13087 @section Getting Mail
13088 @cindex reading mail
13089 @cindex mail
13090
13091 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
13092 course.
13093
13094 @menu
13095 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
13096 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
13097 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
13098 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
13099 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
13100 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
13101 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
13102 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
13103 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
13104 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
13105 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
13106 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
13107 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
13108 @end menu
13109
13110
13111 @node Mail in a Newsreader
13112 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
13113
13114 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
13115 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
13116 of a culture shock.
13117
13118 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
13119 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
13120
13121 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
13122 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
13123 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
13124 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
13125
13126 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
13127
13128 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
13129 deleted? How awful!
13130
13131 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
13132 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
13133 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
13134 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
13135 Mail}.
13136
13137 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
13138 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
13139 they want to treat a message.
13140
13141 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
13142 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
13143 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
13144 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
13145 archived somewhere else.
13146
13147 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
13148 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
13149 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
13150 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
13151 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
13152
13153 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
13154 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
13155 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
13156
13157 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
13158 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
13159 differently.
13160
13161 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
13162 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
13163 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
13164 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
13165 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
13166
13167 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
13168 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
13169 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
13170 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
13171 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
13172 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
13173 You Do.)
13174
13175
13176 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
13177 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
13178
13179 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
13180 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
13181 and things will happen automatically.
13182
13183 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
13184 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13185
13186 @lisp
13187 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
13188 @end lisp
13189
13190 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
13191 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
13192 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
13193 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
13194 like any other group.
13195
13196 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
13197
13198 @lisp
13199 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13200 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13201 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13202 ("other" "")))
13203 @end lisp
13204
13205 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
13206 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
13207 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
13208 last group.
13209
13210 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
13211 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
13212 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
13213
13214
13215 @node Splitting Mail
13216 @subsection Splitting Mail
13217 @cindex splitting mail
13218 @cindex mail splitting
13219 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
13220
13221 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
13222 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
13223 to be split into groups.
13224
13225 @lisp
13226 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13227 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13228 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13229 ("mail.other" "")))
13230 @end lisp
13231
13232 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
13233 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
13234 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
13235 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
13236 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
13237 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
13238 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
13239
13240 @lisp
13241 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
13242 @end lisp
13243
13244 @noindent
13245 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
13246 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
13247
13248 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
13249 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
13250 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
13251 mail belongs in that group.
13252
13253 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
13254 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
13255 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
13256 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
13257 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
13258 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
13259 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
13260 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
13261 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
13262 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
13263
13264 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
13265 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
13266 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
13267 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
13268 thinks should carry this mail message.
13269
13270 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
13271 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
13272 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
13273 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
13274
13275 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
13276 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
13277 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
13278 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
13279 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
13280
13281 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
13282 @cindex crosspost
13283 @cindex links
13284 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
13285 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
13286 links. If that's the case for you, set
13287 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
13288 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
13289
13290 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
13291 @findex nnmail-split-history
13292 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
13293 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
13294 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
13295 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
13296 Group Commands}).
13297
13298 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
13299 Header lines longer than the value of
13300 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
13301 function.
13302
13303 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
13304 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
13305 By default the splitting codes @acronym{MIME} decodes headers so you
13306 can match on non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. The
13307 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset} variable specifies the default
13308 charset for decoding. The behavior can be turned off completely by
13309 binding @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} to @code{nil}, which is
13310 useful if you want to match articles based on the raw header data.
13311
13312 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13313 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
13314 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
13315 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
13316 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
13317 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
13318 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
13319 other kinds of entries.)
13320
13321 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
13322 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
13323 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
13324 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
13325 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
13326 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
13327 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
13328 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
13329 month's rent money.
13330
13331
13332 @node Mail Sources
13333 @subsection Mail Sources
13334
13335 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
13336 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
13337 maildir, for instance.
13338
13339 @menu
13340 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
13341 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
13342 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
13343 @end menu
13344
13345
13346 @node Mail Source Specifiers
13347 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
13348 @cindex POP
13349 @cindex mail server
13350 @cindex procmail
13351 @cindex mail spool
13352 @cindex mail source
13353
13354 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
13355 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
13356
13357 Here's an example:
13358
13359 @lisp
13360 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
13361 @end lisp
13362
13363 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
13364 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
13365 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
13366 default values.
13367
13368 The following mail source types are available:
13369
13370 @table @code
13371 @item file
13372 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
13373
13374 Keywords:
13375
13376 @table @code
13377 @item :path
13378 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
13379 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
13380 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
13381
13382 @item :prescript
13383 @itemx :postscript
13384 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13385 @end table
13386
13387 An example file mail source:
13388
13389 @lisp
13390 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
13391 @end lisp
13392
13393 Or using the default file name:
13394
13395 @lisp
13396 (file)
13397 @end lisp
13398
13399 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
13400 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
13401 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
13402 mail spool while moving the mail.
13403
13404 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
13405
13406 @lisp
13407 (setq mail-sources
13408 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
13409 @end lisp
13410
13411 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
13412
13413 @example
13414 #!/bin/sh
13415 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
13416 # flu@@iki.fi
13417
13418 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
13419 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
13420 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
13421 @end example
13422
13423 Alter this script to fit find the @samp{movemail} you want to use.
13424
13425
13426 @item directory
13427 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
13428 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
13429 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
13430 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
13431 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
13432 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
13433 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
13434 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
13435 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
13436 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
13437
13438 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13439 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
13440 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
13441 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
13442
13443 Keywords:
13444
13445 @table @code
13446 @item :path
13447 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
13448 value.
13449
13450 @item :suffix
13451 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
13452 @samp{.spool}.
13453
13454 @item :predicate
13455 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
13456 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
13457 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
13458 predicate are considered.
13459
13460 @item :prescript
13461 @itemx :postscript
13462 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13463
13464 @end table
13465
13466 An example directory mail source:
13467
13468 @lisp
13469 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
13470 :suffix ".prcml")
13471 @end lisp
13472
13473 @item pop
13474 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13475
13476 Keywords:
13477
13478 @table @code
13479 @item :server
13480 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
13481 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13482
13483 @item :port
13484 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
13485 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
13486 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
13487 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
13488 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
13489
13490 @item :user
13491 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
13492 name.
13493
13494 @item :password
13495 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
13496 the user is prompted.
13497
13498 @item :program
13499 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
13500 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
13501
13502 @example
13503 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
13504 @end example
13505
13506 The valid format specifier characters are:
13507
13508 @table @samp
13509 @item t
13510 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
13511 included in this string.
13512
13513 @item s
13514 The name of the server.
13515
13516 @item P
13517 The port number of the server.
13518
13519 @item u
13520 The user name to use.
13521
13522 @item p
13523 The password to use.
13524 @end table
13525
13526 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13527 corresponding keywords.
13528
13529 @item :prescript
13530 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13531 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13532
13533 @item :postscript
13534 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13535 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13536
13537 @item :function
13538 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
13539 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
13540 mail should be moved to.
13541
13542 @item :authentication
13543 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
13544 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
13545 @code{password}.
13546
13547 @end table
13548
13549 @vindex pop3-movemail
13550 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
13551 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
13552 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If the
13553 @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server} is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be
13554 left on the @acronym{POP} server after fetching when using
13555 @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers maintain no state
13556 information between sessions, so what the client believes is there and
13557 what is actually there may not match up. If they do not, then the whole
13558 thing can fall apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
13559
13560 Here are some examples. Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server,
13561 using the default user name, and default fetcher:
13562
13563 @lisp
13564 (pop)
13565 @end lisp
13566
13567 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
13568
13569 @lisp
13570 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
13571 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
13572 @end lisp
13573
13574 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
13575
13576 @lisp
13577 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
13578 @end lisp
13579
13580 @item maildir
13581 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
13582 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
13583 contains exactly one mail.
13584
13585 Keywords:
13586
13587 @table @code
13588 @item :path
13589 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
13590 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
13591 @file{~/Maildir/}.
13592 @item :subdirs
13593 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
13594 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
13595
13596 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
13597 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
13598 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
13599 @c below.
13600
13601 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
13602 from locking problems).
13603
13604 @end table
13605
13606 Two example maildir mail sources:
13607
13608 @lisp
13609 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
13610 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
13611 @end lisp
13612
13613 @lisp
13614 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
13615 :subdirs ("new"))
13616 @end lisp
13617
13618 @item imap
13619 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
13620 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
13621 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
13622 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
13623 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
13624
13625 Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
13626 may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
13627
13628 Keywords:
13629
13630 @table @code
13631 @item :server
13632 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
13633 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13634
13635 @item :port
13636 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
13637 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
13638
13639 @item :user
13640 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
13641 name.
13642
13643 @item :password
13644 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
13645 prompted.
13646
13647 @item :stream
13648 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
13649 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
13650 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
13651 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
13652
13653 @item :authentication
13654 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
13655 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
13656 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
13657 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
13658
13659 @item :program
13660 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
13661 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
13662 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
13663
13664 @example
13665 ssh %s imapd
13666 @end example
13667
13668 The valid format specifier characters are:
13669
13670 @table @samp
13671 @item s
13672 The name of the server.
13673
13674 @item l
13675 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
13676
13677 @item p
13678 The port number of the server.
13679 @end table
13680
13681 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13682 corresponding keywords.
13683
13684 @item :mailbox
13685 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
13686 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
13687
13688 @item :predicate
13689 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
13690 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
13691 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
13692 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
13693 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
13694 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
13695
13696 @item :fetchflag
13697 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
13698 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
13699 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
13700 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
13701
13702 @item :dontexpunge
13703 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
13704 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
13705
13706 @end table
13707
13708 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
13709
13710 @lisp
13711 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
13712 :stream kerberos4
13713 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
13714 @end lisp
13715
13716 @item webmail
13717 Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
13718 @uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
13719 @uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
13720
13721 NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
13722 required for url "4.0pre.46".
13723
13724 WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
13725
13726 Keywords:
13727
13728 @table @code
13729 @item :subtype
13730 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
13731 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
13732
13733 @item :user
13734 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
13735 name.
13736
13737 @item :password
13738 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
13739 prompted.
13740
13741 @item :dontexpunge
13742 If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
13743 trash folder after finishing the fetch.
13744
13745 @end table
13746
13747 An example webmail source:
13748
13749 @lisp
13750 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
13751 :user "user-name"
13752 :password "secret")
13753 @end lisp
13754 @end table
13755
13756 @table @dfn
13757 @item Common Keywords
13758 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
13759
13760 Keywords:
13761
13762 @table @code
13763 @item :plugged
13764 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
13765 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
13766 example:
13767
13768 @lisp
13769 (setq mail-sources
13770 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
13771 :suffix ""
13772 :plugged t)))
13773 @end lisp
13774
13775 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
13776 useful when you use local mail and news.
13777
13778 @end table
13779 @end table
13780
13781 @subsubsection Function Interface
13782
13783 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
13784 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
13785 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
13786 consider the following mail-source setting:
13787
13788 @lisp
13789 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
13790 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
13791 @end lisp
13792
13793 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
13794 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
13795 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
13796 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
13797 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
13798
13799 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
13800
13801
13802 @node Mail Source Customization
13803 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
13804
13805 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
13806 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
13807 variables.
13808
13809 @table @code
13810 @item mail-source-crash-box
13811 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
13812 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
13813 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
13814
13815 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
13816 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
13817 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
13818 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
13819 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
13820 (This will only happen, when receiving new mail). You may also set
13821 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
13822 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
13823
13824 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13825 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13826 If non-@code{nil}, ask for for confirmation before deleting old incoming
13827 files. This variable only applies when
13828 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
13829
13830 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
13831 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
13832 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
13833
13834 @item mail-source-directory
13835 @vindex mail-source-directory
13836 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
13837 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
13838 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
13839 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
13840
13841 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13842 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13843 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
13844 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
13845 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
13846 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
13847 number.
13848
13849 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
13850 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
13851 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
13852
13853 @item mail-source-movemail-program
13854 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
13855 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
13856 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
13857
13858 @end table
13859
13860
13861 @node Fetching Mail
13862 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
13863
13864 @vindex mail-sources
13865 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
13866 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
13867 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
13868 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
13869
13870 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
13871 @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to fetch mail by
13872 themselves.
13873
13874 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
13875 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
13876
13877 @lisp
13878 (setq mail-sources
13879 '((file)
13880 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13881 :password "secret")))
13882 @end lisp
13883
13884 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
13885
13886 @lisp
13887 (setq mail-sources
13888 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
13889 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13890 :user "user-name"
13891 :port "pop3"
13892 :password "secret")))
13893 @end lisp
13894
13895
13896 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
13897 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
13898 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
13899 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
13900 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
13901 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
13902
13903
13904
13905 @node Mail Back End Variables
13906 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
13907
13908 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
13909 mail back ends.
13910
13911 @table @code
13912 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13913 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13914 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
13915 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
13916
13917 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
13918 @item nnmail-split-hook
13919 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
13920 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
13921 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
13922 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
13923 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
13924 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
13925 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
13926 in the buffer will show up in any files.
13927 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
13928 to this hook.
13929
13930 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13931 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13932 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13933 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13934 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
13935 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
13936 starting to handle the new mail) and
13937 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
13938 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
13939 default file modes the new mail files get:
13940
13941 @lisp
13942 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13943 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
13944
13945 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13946 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
13947 @end lisp
13948
13949 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
13950 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
13951 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
13952 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
13953 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
13954 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
13955 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
13956
13957 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
13958 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
13959 @findex delete-file
13960 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
13961
13962 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13963 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13964 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
13965 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
13966 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
13967
13968 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13969 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13970 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
13971 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
13972 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
13973
13974 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
13975 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
13976 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
13977
13978 @end table
13979
13980
13981 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
13982 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
13983 @cindex mail splitting
13984 @cindex fancy mail splitting
13985
13986 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
13987 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
13988 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
13989 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
13990 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
13991 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
13992
13993 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
13994
13995 @lisp
13996 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
13997 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
13998 ;; @r{from real errors.}
13999 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
14000 "mail.misc"))
14001 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
14002 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
14003 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
14004 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
14005 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
14006 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
14007 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
14008 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
14009 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
14010 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
14011 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
14012 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
14013 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
14014 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
14015 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
14016 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
14017 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
14018 "misc.misc")
14019 @end lisp
14020
14021 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
14022 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
14023 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
14024
14025 @table @code
14026
14027 @item group
14028 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
14029 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
14030
14031 @c Don't fold this line.
14032 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
14033 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
14034 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
14035 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
14036 @var{split}.
14037
14038 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
14039 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
14040 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
14041 @var{split} is processed.
14042
14043 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
14044 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
14045 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
14046 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14047
14048 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
14049 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
14050 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
14051 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
14052 stored in one or more groups.
14053
14054 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
14055 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
14056 process all @var{split}s in the list.
14057
14058 @item junk
14059 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
14060 this message. Use with extreme caution.
14061
14062 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
14063 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
14064 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
14065 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
14066
14067 @cindex body split
14068 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
14069 body of the messages:
14070
14071 @lisp
14072 (defun split-on-body ()
14073 (save-excursion
14074 (save-restriction
14075 (widen)
14076 (goto-char (point-min))
14077 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
14078 "string.group"))))
14079 @end lisp
14080
14081 The buffer is narrowed to the message in question when @var{function}
14082 is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called after
14083 @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
14084 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
14085 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
14086 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
14087 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
14088
14089 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
14090 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
14091 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
14092 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
14093 should return a split.
14094
14095 @item nil
14096 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
14097
14098 @end table
14099
14100 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
14101
14102 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
14103 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
14104 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
14105 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
14106 for example,
14107
14108 @example
14109 (any "joe" "joemail")
14110 @end example
14111
14112 @noindent
14113 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
14114 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
14115 of the following three ways:
14116
14117 @enumerate
14118 @item
14119 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
14120 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
14121 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
14122 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
14123 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
14124 @code{nil}.
14125
14126 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
14127
14128 @item
14129 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
14130 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
14131 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
14132 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
14133 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
14134
14135 @item
14136 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
14137 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
14138 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
14139 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14140 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
14141 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14142 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14143 @end enumerate
14144
14145 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
14146 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
14147 they are expanded as specified by the variable
14148 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
14149 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
14150 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
14151 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
14152
14153 @table @code
14154 @item from
14155 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
14156 @item to
14157 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
14158 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
14159 @item any
14160 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
14161 @end table
14162
14163 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
14164 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
14165 when all this splitting is performed.
14166
14167 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
14168 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
14169 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
14170
14171 @example
14172 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
14173 @end example
14174
14175 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
14176 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
14177
14178 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
14179 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
14180 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
14181 groupings 1 through 9.
14182
14183 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
14184 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
14185 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
14186 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
14187 groups when users send to an address using different case
14188 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
14189 is @code{t}.
14190
14191 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
14192 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
14193 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
14194 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
14195 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
14196 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
14197 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
14198 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
14199 it once per thread.
14200
14201 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
14202 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
14203 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
14204 using the colon feature, like so:
14205 @lisp
14206 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
14207 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
14208 nnmail-split-fancy
14209 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
14210 ;; @r{other splits go here}
14211 ))
14212 @end lisp
14213
14214 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
14215 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
14216 in the file specified by the variable
14217 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
14218 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
14219 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
14220 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
14221 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
14222 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
14223 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
14224 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
14225 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
14226 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
14227 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
14228 300 kBytes in size.)
14229 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14230 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
14231 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
14232 messages goes into the new group.
14233
14234 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
14235 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
14236 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
14237 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
14238 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
14239 ``outgoing'' group.
14240
14241
14242 @node Group Mail Splitting
14243 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
14244 @cindex mail splitting
14245 @cindex group mail splitting
14246
14247 @findex gnus-group-split
14248 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
14249 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
14250 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
14251 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
14252 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
14253 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
14254 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
14255 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
14256
14257 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
14258 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
14259 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
14260 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
14261
14262 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
14263 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
14264 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
14265 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
14266 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
14267 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
14268 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
14269
14270 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
14271 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
14272 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
14273 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
14274 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
14275 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
14276 @code{gnus-group-split}.
14277
14278 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
14279 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
14280 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
14281 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
14282 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
14283 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
14284 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
14285 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
14286 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
14287 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
14288 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
14289 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
14290 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
14291
14292 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
14293 been defined:
14294
14295 @example
14296 nnml:mail.bar:
14297 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
14298 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
14299 nnml:mail.foo:
14300 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
14301 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
14302 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
14303 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
14304 nnml:mail.others:
14305 ((split-spec . catch-all))
14306 @end example
14307
14308 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
14309 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
14310 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
14311
14312 @lisp
14313 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
14314 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
14315 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
14316 "mail.others")
14317 @end lisp
14318
14319 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
14320 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
14321 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
14322 splits like this:
14323
14324 @lisp
14325 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
14326 @end lisp
14327
14328 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
14329 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
14330 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
14331 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
14332 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
14333 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
14334 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
14335 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
14336 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
14337
14338 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
14339 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
14340 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
14341 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
14342 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
14343 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
14344 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
14345 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
14346 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
14347
14348 @findex gnus-group-split-update
14349 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
14350 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
14351 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
14352 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
14353 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
14354
14355 @lisp
14356 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
14357 @end lisp
14358
14359 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
14360 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
14361 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
14362 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
14363 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
14364 value.
14365
14366 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
14367 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
14368 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
14369 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
14370
14371 @node Incorporating Old Mail
14372 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
14373 @cindex incorporating old mail
14374 @cindex import old mail
14375
14376 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
14377 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
14378 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
14379 your mail groups.
14380
14381 Doing so can be quite easy.
14382
14383 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
14384 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
14385 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
14386 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
14387 your @code{nnml} groups.
14388
14389 Here's how:
14390
14391 @enumerate
14392 @item
14393 Go to the group buffer.
14394
14395 @item
14396 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
14397 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14398
14399 @item
14400 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
14401
14402 @item
14403 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
14404 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
14405
14406 @item
14407 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
14408 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
14409 @end enumerate
14410
14411 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
14412 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
14413 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
14414 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
14415 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
14416
14417 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
14418 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
14419 using the new mail back end.
14420
14421
14422 @node Expiring Mail
14423 @subsection Expiring Mail
14424 @cindex article expiry
14425
14426 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
14427 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
14428 different approach to mail reading.
14429
14430 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
14431 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
14432 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
14433 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
14434 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
14435 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
14436 course.
14437
14438 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
14439 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
14440 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
14441 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
14442 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
14443 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
14444 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
14445 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
14446 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
14447
14448 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
14449 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
14450 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
14451 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
14452 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
14453 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
14454 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
14455 expirable.
14456
14457 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
14458 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
14459 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
14460 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
14461 into its own group.)
14462
14463 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
14464 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
14465 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
14466 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
14467 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
14468 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
14469 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
14470 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
14471 scoring.
14472
14473 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14474 Groups that match the regular expression
14475 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
14476 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
14477 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
14478
14479 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
14480 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
14481 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
14482 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
14483 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14484
14485 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
14486 @lisp
14487 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
14488 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
14489 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
14490 @end lisp
14491
14492 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
14493 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
14494 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
14495 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
14496 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
14497
14498 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
14499 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
14500
14501 @lisp
14502 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14503 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
14504 @end lisp
14505
14506 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
14507 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
14508
14509 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
14510 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
14511 don't really mix very well.
14512
14513 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
14514 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
14515 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
14516 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
14517 days.
14518
14519 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
14520 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
14521 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
14522 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
14523 everywhere else:
14524
14525 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14526 @lisp
14527 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14528 (lambda (group)
14529 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
14530 31)
14531 ((string= group "mail.junk")
14532 1)
14533 ((string= group "important")
14534 'never)
14535 (t
14536 6))))
14537 @end lisp
14538
14539 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
14540 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
14541
14542 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
14543 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
14544 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
14545 @code{never}.
14546
14547 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
14548 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
14549
14550 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
14551 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
14552 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
14553 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
14554 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
14555 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
14556 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
14557 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
14558 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
14559 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
14560 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
14561 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
14562 name or @code{delete}.
14563
14564 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
14565 @lisp
14566 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
14567 @end lisp
14568
14569 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14570 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14571 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
14572 expire mail to groups according to the variable
14573 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
14574
14575 @lisp
14576 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14577 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14578 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
14579 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
14580 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
14581 @end lisp
14582
14583 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
14584 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
14585 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
14586 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
14587 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
14588 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
14589
14590 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
14591 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
14592 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
14593 easier for procmail users.
14594
14595 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
14596 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
14597 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
14598 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
14599 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
14600 caution. Even more dangerous is the
14601 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
14602 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
14603 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
14604 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
14605 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
14606 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
14607 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
14608 with! So there!
14609
14610 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
14611
14612 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
14613 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
14614 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
14615 auto-expire turned on.
14616
14617
14618 @node Washing Mail
14619 @subsection Washing Mail
14620 @cindex mail washing
14621 @cindex list server brain damage
14622 @cindex incoming mail treatment
14623
14624 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
14625 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
14626 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
14627 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
14628 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
14629 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
14630
14631 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
14632 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
14633 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
14634 laugh.
14635
14636 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
14637 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
14638 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
14639 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
14640
14641 @table @code
14642 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14643 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14644 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
14645 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
14646 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
14647
14648 @table @code
14649 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14650 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14651 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
14652 Emacs running on MS machines.
14653
14654 @end table
14655
14656 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14657 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14658 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
14659 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
14660
14661 @table @code
14662 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14663 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14664 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
14665 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
14666
14667 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
14668 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
14669 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
14670 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
14671 into a feature by documenting it.)
14672
14673 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14674 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14675 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
14676 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
14677 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
14678 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
14679 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
14680 @code{\\(..\\)}.
14681
14682 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
14683 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
14684
14685 @lisp
14686 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
14687 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
14688 @end lisp
14689
14690 This can also be done non-destructively with
14691 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
14692
14693 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
14694 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
14695 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
14696
14697 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14698 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14699 @cindex Eudora
14700 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
14701 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
14702 @code{References} headers.
14703
14704 @end table
14705
14706 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14707 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14708 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
14709 include:
14710
14711 @table @code
14712 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
14713 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
14714 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
14715
14716 @end table
14717 @end table
14718
14719
14720 @node Duplicates
14721 @subsection Duplicates
14722
14723 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
14724 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
14725 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
14726 @cindex duplicate mails
14727 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
14728 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
14729 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
14730 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
14731 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
14732 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
14733 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
14734 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
14735 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
14736 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
14737 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
14738 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
14739 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
14740
14741 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
14742 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
14743 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
14744 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
14745
14746 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
14747 @code{nil}.
14748
14749 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
14750 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
14751 methods:
14752
14753 @lisp
14754 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
14755 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
14756 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
14757 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
14758 (any mail "mail.misc")
14759 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14760 [...] ))
14761 @end lisp
14762 @noindent
14763 Or something like:
14764 @lisp
14765 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14766 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
14767 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14768 [...]))
14769 @end lisp
14770
14771 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
14772 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
14773 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
14774 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
14775 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
14776
14777
14778 @node Not Reading Mail
14779 @subsection Not Reading Mail
14780
14781 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
14782 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
14783 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
14784
14785 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
14786 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
14787 mail, which should help.
14788
14789 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14790 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14791 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14792 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14793 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
14794 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
14795 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
14796 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
14797 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
14798 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
14799 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
14800
14801 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
14802 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
14803 incoming mail.
14804
14805
14806 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
14807 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
14808
14809 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
14810 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
14811 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
14812
14813 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
14814 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
14815 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
14816 Spool}).
14817
14818 @menu
14819 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
14820 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
14821 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
14822 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
14823 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
14824 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
14825 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
14826 @end menu
14827
14828
14829 @node Unix Mail Box
14830 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
14831 @cindex nnmbox
14832 @cindex unix mail box
14833
14834 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14835 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14836 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
14837 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
14838 which group it belongs in.
14839
14840 Virtual server settings:
14841
14842 @table @code
14843 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
14844 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14845 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
14846 @file{~/mbox}.
14847
14848 @item nnmbox-active-file
14849 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14850 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
14851 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
14852
14853 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
14854 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14855 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
14856 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
14857 @end table
14858
14859
14860 @node Rmail Babyl
14861 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
14862 @cindex nnbabyl
14863 @cindex Rmail mbox
14864
14865 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14866 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14867 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
14868 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
14869 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
14870
14871 Virtual server settings:
14872
14873 @table @code
14874 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
14875 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14876 The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
14877
14878 @item nnbabyl-active-file
14879 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14880 The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
14881 @file{~/.rmail-active}
14882
14883 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14884 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14885 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
14886 @code{t}
14887 @end table
14888
14889
14890 @node Mail Spool
14891 @subsubsection Mail Spool
14892 @cindex nnml
14893 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
14894
14895 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
14896 format. It should be used with some caution.
14897
14898 @vindex nnml-directory
14899 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
14900 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
14901 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
14902 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
14903
14904 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
14905 care of all that.
14906
14907 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
14908 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
14909 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
14910 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
14911 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
14912 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
14913 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
14914 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
14915
14916 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
14917 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
14918 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
14919 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
14920
14921 @cindex self contained nnml servers
14922 @cindex marks
14923 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
14924 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
14925 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
14926 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
14927 for a group is usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
14928 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
14929 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
14930 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
14931 directory).
14932
14933 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
14934 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
14935 them next time it starts.
14936
14937 Virtual server settings:
14938
14939 @table @code
14940 @item nnml-directory
14941 @vindex nnml-directory
14942 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
14943 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
14944 is @file{~/Mail}).
14945
14946 @item nnml-active-file
14947 @vindex nnml-active-file
14948 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
14949 @file{~/Mail/active}.
14950
14951 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
14952 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
14953 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
14954 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
14955
14956 @item nnml-get-new-mail
14957 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14958 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
14959 @code{t}.
14960
14961 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
14962 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
14963 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
14964 default is @code{nil}.
14965
14966 @item nnml-nov-file-name
14967 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
14968 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
14969
14970 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
14971 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
14972 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
14973
14974 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
14975 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
14976 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
14977 default is @code{nil}.
14978
14979 @item nnml-marks-file-name
14980 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
14981 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
14982
14983 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
14984 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
14985 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
14986 files.
14987
14988 @end table
14989
14990 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
14991 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
14992 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
14993 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
14994 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
14995 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
14996 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
14997 Commands}).
14998
14999
15000 @node MH Spool
15001 @subsubsection MH Spool
15002 @cindex nnmh
15003 @cindex mh-e mail spool
15004
15005 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
15006 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
15007 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
15008 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
15009 for.
15010
15011 Virtual server settings:
15012
15013 @table @code
15014 @item nnmh-directory
15015 @vindex nnmh-directory
15016 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
15017 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
15018 @file{~/Mail})
15019
15020 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
15021 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
15022 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
15023 @code{t}.
15024
15025 @item nnmh-be-safe
15026 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
15027 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
15028 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
15029 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
15030 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
15031 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
15032 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
15033 @end table
15034
15035
15036 @node Maildir
15037 @subsubsection Maildir
15038 @cindex nnmaildir
15039 @cindex maildir
15040
15041 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
15042 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
15043 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
15044 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
15045 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
15046 within a maildir.
15047
15048 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
15049 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
15050 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
15051 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
15052 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
15053 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
15054 that appear as group in Gnus.
15055
15056 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
15057 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
15058 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
15059
15060 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
15061 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
15062 another, and you will keep your marks.
15063
15064 Virtual server settings:
15065
15066 @table @code
15067 @item directory
15068 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
15069 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
15070 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
15071 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
15072 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
15073 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
15074 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
15075 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
15076 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
15077 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
15078
15079 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
15080 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
15081 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
15082 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
15083 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
15084 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
15085 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
15086 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
15087 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
15088 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
15089 value.
15090
15091 @item target-prefix
15092 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
15093 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
15094 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
15095 closed.
15096
15097 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
15098 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
15099 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
15100 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
15101 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
15102 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
15103 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
15104 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
15105 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
15106
15107 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
15108 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
15109 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
15110 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
15111 symlinks pointing to them will be).
15112
15113 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
15114 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
15115 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
15116 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
15117 @code{force} argument.
15118
15119 @item directory-files
15120 This should be a function with the same interface as
15121 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
15122 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
15123 parameter is optional; the default is
15124 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
15125 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
15126 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
15127 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
15128 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
15129 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
15130
15131 @item get-new-mail
15132 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
15133 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
15134 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
15135 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
15136 value is @code{nil}.
15137
15138 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
15139 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
15140 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
15141 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
15142 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
15143 @end table
15144
15145 @subsubsection Group parameters
15146
15147 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
15148 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
15149 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
15150 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
15151 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
15152 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
15153 another back end.
15154
15155 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
15156 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
15157 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
15158 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
15159 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
15160 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
15161 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
15162 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
15163 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
15164
15165 @table @code
15166 @item expire-age
15167 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
15168 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
15169 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
15170 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
15171 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
15172 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
15173 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
15174 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
15175 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
15176 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
15177 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
15178 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
15179 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
15180
15181 @item expire-group
15182 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
15183 @example
15184 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
15185 @end example
15186 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
15187 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
15188 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
15189 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
15190 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
15191 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
15192 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
15193 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
15194 article. So that form can refer to
15195 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
15196 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
15197 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
15198 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
15199
15200 @item read-only
15201 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
15202 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
15203 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
15204 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
15205 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
15206 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
15207 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
15208 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
15209 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
15210 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
15211 contain extra copies of the articles.
15212
15213 @item directory-files
15214 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
15215 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
15216 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
15217 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
15218
15219 @item distrust-Lines:
15220 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
15221 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
15222 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
15223
15224 @item always-marks
15225 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
15226 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15227 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
15228 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
15229 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
15230 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15231
15232 @item never-marks
15233 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
15234 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15235 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
15236 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
15237 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
15238 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
15239 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15240
15241 @item nov-cache-size
15242 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
15243 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
15244 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
15245 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
15246 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
15247 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
15248 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
15249 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
15250 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
15251 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
15252 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
15253 @end table
15254
15255 @subsubsection Article identification
15256 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
15257 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
15258 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
15259 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
15260 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
15261 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
15262 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
15263 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
15264 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
15265 request the article in the summary buffer.
15266
15267 @subsubsection NOV data
15268 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
15269 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
15270 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
15271 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
15272 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
15273 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
15274 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
15275 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
15276 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
15277 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
15278 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
15279
15280 @subsubsection Article marks
15281 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
15282 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
15283 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15284 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
15285 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15286 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
15287 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
15288 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
15289
15290 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
15291 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
15292 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
15293 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
15294 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
15295 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
15296 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
15297 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
15298 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
15299
15300
15301 @node Mail Folders
15302 @subsubsection Mail Folders
15303 @cindex nnfolder
15304 @cindex mbox folders
15305 @cindex mail folders
15306
15307 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
15308 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
15309 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
15310 numbers and arrival dates.
15311
15312 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
15313 @cindex marks
15314 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
15315 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15316 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15317 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
15318 Marks for a group are usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
15319 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
15320 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
15321 directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
15322 backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
15323 into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
15324
15325 Virtual server settings:
15326
15327 @table @code
15328 @item nnfolder-directory
15329 @vindex nnfolder-directory
15330 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
15331 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
15332 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
15333
15334 @item nnfolder-active-file
15335 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
15336 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
15337
15338 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15339 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15340 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15341 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
15342
15343 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
15344 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15345 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
15346 default is @code{t}
15347
15348 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15349 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15350 @cindex backup files
15351 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
15352 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
15353 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
15354 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
15355
15356 @lisp
15357 (defun turn-off-backup ()
15358 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
15359
15360 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
15361 @end lisp
15362
15363 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15364 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15365 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
15366 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
15367 extract some information from it before removing it.
15368
15369 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15370 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15371 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15372 default is @code{nil}.
15373
15374 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15375 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15376 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
15377
15378 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
15379 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
15380 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
15381 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15382
15383 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15384 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15385 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15386 default is @code{nil}.
15387
15388 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15389 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15390 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
15391
15392 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
15393 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
15394 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
15395 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15396
15397 @end table
15398
15399
15400 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
15401 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
15402 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
15403 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
15404 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
15405 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
15406 though.
15407
15408 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
15409 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
15410
15411 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
15412 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
15413 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
15414 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
15415 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
15416
15417 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
15418 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
15419 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
15420 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
15421 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
15422 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
15423 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
15424 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
15425 via NFS).
15426
15427 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
15428 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
15429 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
15430 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
15431
15432 @table @code
15433 @item nnmbox
15434
15435 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
15436 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
15437 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
15438 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
15439 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
15440 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
15441 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
15442 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
15443 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
15444 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
15445 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
15446 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
15447 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
15448 what's where.
15449
15450 @item nnbabyl
15451
15452 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
15453 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
15454 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
15455 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
15456 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
15457 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
15458 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
15459 Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
15460 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
15461 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
15462 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
15463 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
15464 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
15465 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
15466
15467 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
15468 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
15469 look at your mail.
15470
15471 @item nnml
15472
15473 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
15474 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
15475 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
15476 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
15477 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
15478 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
15479 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
15480 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
15481 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
15482 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
15483 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
15484 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
15485 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
15486 provided by the active file and overviews.
15487
15488 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
15489 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
15490 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
15491 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
15492 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
15493 wins big.
15494
15495 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
15496 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
15497 tiny files.
15498
15499 @item nnmh
15500
15501 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
15502 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
15503 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
15504 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
15505 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
15506 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
15507 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
15508
15509 @item nnfolder
15510
15511 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
15512 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
15513 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
15514 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
15515 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
15516 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
15517 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
15518 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
15519 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
15520
15521 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
15522 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
15523 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
15524 friendly mail back end all over.
15525
15526 @item nnmaildir
15527
15528 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
15529 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
15530 mail back ends.
15531
15532 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
15533 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
15534 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
15535 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
15536 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
15537 @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
15538 you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
15539 @uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
15540 file system.
15541
15542 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
15543 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
15544 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
15545 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
15546 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
15547 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
15548 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
15549 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
15550 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
15551 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
15552 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
15553
15554 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
15555 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
15556 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
15557 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
15558 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
15559 @code{nnmaildir}.
15560
15561 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
15562 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
15563 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
15564 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
15565 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
15566 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
15567 removed in the future.
15568
15569 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
15570 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
15571 on your file system.
15572
15573 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
15574 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
15575
15576 @end table
15577
15578
15579 @node Browsing the Web
15580 @section Browsing the Web
15581 @cindex web
15582 @cindex browsing the web
15583 @cindex www
15584 @cindex http
15585
15586 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
15587 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
15588 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
15589 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
15590 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
15591 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
15592 even know what a news group is.
15593
15594 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
15595 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
15596 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
15597 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
15598 you mad in the end.
15599
15600 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
15601 to do it instead?
15602
15603 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
15604 interfaces to these sources.
15605
15606 @menu
15607 * Archiving Mail::
15608 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
15609 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
15610 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
15611 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
15612 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
15613 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
15614 @end menu
15615
15616 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
15617 alternatives to work.
15618
15619 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
15620 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
15621 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
15622 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
15623 though, you should be ok.
15624
15625 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
15626 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
15627 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
15628 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
15629 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
15630
15631 @node Archiving Mail
15632 @subsection Archiving Mail
15633 @cindex archiving mail
15634 @cindex backup of mail
15635
15636 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
15637 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
15638 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
15639 marks is fairly simple.
15640
15641 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
15642 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
15643 though.)
15644
15645 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
15646 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
15647 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
15648 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
15649 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
15650 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
15651 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
15652 before you restore the data.
15653
15654 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
15655 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
15656 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
15657 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
15658 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
15659 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
15660 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
15661 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
15662 is unnecessary in that case.
15663
15664 @node Web Searches
15665 @subsection Web Searches
15666 @cindex nnweb
15667 @cindex Google
15668 @cindex dejanews
15669 @cindex gmane
15670 @cindex Usenet searches
15671 @cindex searching the Usenet
15672
15673 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
15674 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
15675 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
15676 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
15677 searches without having to use a browser.
15678
15679 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
15680 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
15681 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
15682 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
15683 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
15684
15685 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
15686 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
15687 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
15688 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
15689 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
15690 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
15691 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
15692 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
15693 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
15694 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
15695 group as read.
15696
15697 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
15698 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
15699 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
15700 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
15701 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
15702 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
15703
15704 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
15705 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
15706 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
15707
15708 Virtual server variables:
15709
15710 @table @code
15711 @item nnweb-type
15712 @vindex nnweb-type
15713 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
15714 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
15715 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
15716
15717 @item nnweb-search
15718 @vindex nnweb-search
15719 The search string to feed to the search engine.
15720
15721 @item nnweb-max-hits
15722 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
15723 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
15724 999.
15725
15726 @item nnweb-type-definition
15727 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
15728 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
15729 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
15730 present:
15731
15732 @table @code
15733 @item article
15734 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
15735 understands.
15736
15737 @item map
15738 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
15739
15740 @item search
15741 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
15742
15743 @item address
15744 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
15745 to.
15746
15747 @item id
15748 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
15749 @end table
15750
15751 @end table
15752
15753
15754 @node Slashdot
15755 @subsection Slashdot
15756 @cindex Slashdot
15757 @cindex nnslashdot
15758
15759 @uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
15760 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
15761 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
15762
15763 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
15764 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15765
15766 @lisp
15767 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
15768 '((nnslashdot "")))
15769 @end lisp
15770
15771 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
15772 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
15773 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
15774 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
15775 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
15776 Methods}).
15777
15778 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
15779 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15780
15781 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
15782 comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
15783 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
15784 @samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
15785 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
15786 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
15787 @acronym{HTML} forms.
15788
15789 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
15790
15791 @table @code
15792 @item nnslashdot-threaded
15793 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
15794 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
15795 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
15796 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
15797 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
15798 but much, much slower than unthreaded.
15799
15800 @item nnslashdot-login-name
15801 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
15802 The login name to use when posting.
15803
15804 @item nnslashdot-password
15805 @vindex nnslashdot-password
15806 The password to use when posting.
15807
15808 @item nnslashdot-directory
15809 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
15810 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
15811 @file{~/News/slashdot/}.
15812
15813 @item nnslashdot-active-url
15814 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
15815 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
15816 information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
15817 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
15818
15819 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
15820 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
15821 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
15822
15823 @item nnslashdot-article-url
15824 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
15825 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
15826 article. The default is
15827 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
15828
15829 @item nnslashdot-threshold
15830 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
15831 The score threshold. The default is -1.
15832
15833 @item nnslashdot-group-number
15834 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
15835 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
15836 updated. The default is 0.
15837
15838 @end table
15839
15840
15841
15842 @node Ultimate
15843 @subsection Ultimate
15844 @cindex nnultimate
15845 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
15846
15847 @uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
15848 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
15849 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
15850 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15851
15852 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
15853 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
15854 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
15855 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
15856 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
15857 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
15858 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
15859
15860 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
15861
15862 @table @code
15863 @item nnultimate-directory
15864 @vindex nnultimate-directory
15865 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
15866 @file{~/News/ultimate/}.
15867 @end table
15868
15869
15870 @node Web Archive
15871 @subsection Web Archive
15872 @cindex nnwarchive
15873 @cindex Web Archive
15874
15875 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
15876 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
15877 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
15878 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
15879 groups updated.
15880
15881 @findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
15882 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
15883 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
15884 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
15885 www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
15886 @var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
15887 @var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
15888 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
15889
15890 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
15891
15892 @table @code
15893 @item nnwarchive-directory
15894 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
15895 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
15896 @file{~/News/warchive/}.
15897
15898 @item nnwarchive-login
15899 @vindex nnwarchive-login
15900 The account name on the web server.
15901
15902 @item nnwarchive-passwd
15903 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
15904 The password for your account on the web server.
15905 @end table
15906
15907 @node RSS
15908 @subsection RSS
15909 @cindex nnrss
15910 @cindex RSS
15911
15912 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
15913 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
15914 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
15915 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
15916 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
15917
15918 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
15919 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15920
15921 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
15922 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
15923 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
15924 group names.
15925
15926 @kindex G R (Group)
15927 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
15928 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
15929 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
15930 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
15931
15932 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
15933 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
15934 subscribe to groups.
15935
15936 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
15937 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
15938 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
15939 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
15940 variable. If it is @code{nil}, in Emacs the coding system defaults to
15941 the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system}. If you are using
15942 XEmacs and want to use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names, you should set
15943 the value for the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} variable properly.
15944
15945 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
15946 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
15947 and a @samp{text/html} part.
15948
15949 @cindex OPML
15950 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
15951 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
15952 Markup Language).
15953
15954 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
15955 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
15956 file.
15957 @end defun
15958
15959 @defun nnrss-opml-export
15960 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
15961 @acronym{OPML} format.
15962 @end defun
15963
15964 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
15965
15966 @table @code
15967 @item nnrss-directory
15968 @vindex nnrss-directory
15969 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
15970 @file{~/News/rss/}.
15971
15972 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
15973 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
15974 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
15975 data files. The default is the value of
15976 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
15977 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
15978
15979 @item nnrss-use-local
15980 @vindex nnrss-use-local
15981 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
15982 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
15983 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
15984 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
15985 download script using @command{wget}.
15986
15987 @item nnrss-wash-html-in-text-plain-parts
15988 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{nnrss} renders text in @samp{text/plain}
15989 parts as @acronym{HTML}. The function specified by the
15990 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} variable (@pxref{Display Customization,
15991 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) will be used
15992 to render text. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default, text will
15993 simply be folded. Leave it @code{nil} if you prefer to see
15994 @samp{text/html} parts.
15995 @end table
15996
15997 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
15998 the summary buffer.
15999
16000 @lisp
16001 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
16002 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
16003
16004 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
16005 (let ((descr
16006 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
16007 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
16008 @end lisp
16009
16010 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
16011 summary buffer.
16012
16013 @lisp
16014 (require 'browse-url)
16015
16016 (defun browse-nnrss-url( arg )
16017 (interactive "p")
16018 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
16019 (mail-header-extra
16020 (gnus-data-header
16021 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
16022 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
16023 (if url
16024 (progn
16025 (browse-url (cdr url))
16026 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
16027 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
16028
16029 (eval-after-load "gnus"
16030 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
16031 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
16032 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
16033 @end lisp
16034
16035 Even if you have added @code{"text/html"} to the
16036 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
16037 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
16038 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
16039 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
16040 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
16041 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
16042 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
16043 @code{nnrss} groups:
16044
16045 @lisp
16046 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
16047 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
16048 '(add-to-list
16049 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
16050 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
16051 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
16052
16053 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
16054 (add-to-list
16055 'gnus-parameters
16056 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
16057 @end lisp
16058
16059
16060 @node Customizing W3
16061 @subsection Customizing W3
16062 @cindex W3
16063 @cindex html
16064 @cindex url
16065 @cindex Netscape
16066
16067 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
16068 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
16069 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
16070 users.
16071
16072 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
16073 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
16074 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
16075
16076 @lisp
16077 (eval-after-load "w3"
16078 '(progn
16079 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
16080 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
16081 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
16082 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
16083 (browse-url url)
16084 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
16085 @end lisp
16086
16087 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
16088 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
16089 follow the link.
16090
16091
16092 @node IMAP
16093 @section IMAP
16094 @cindex nnimap
16095 @cindex @acronym{IMAP}
16096
16097 @acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
16098 think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
16099 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
16100 specify the network address of the server.
16101
16102 @acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
16103 everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
16104 @acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
16105 similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
16106 @acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
16107 is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
16108
16109 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
16110 entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
16111 the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
16112 not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
16113
16114 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
16115 entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
16116 manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
16117 usage explained in this section.
16118
16119 A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
16120 servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
16121 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
16122 see below.)
16123
16124 @lisp
16125 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16126 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
16127 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
16128 (nnimap "dolk"
16129 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16130 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
16131 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
16132 (nnimap "barbar"
16133 (nnimap-server-port 143)
16134 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16135 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
16136 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
16137 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
16138 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
16139 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
16140 (nnimap-stream network))
16141 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
16142 (nnimap "vic20"
16143 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
16144 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
16145 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
16146 @end lisp
16147
16148 After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
16149 server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
16150 (@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
16151 (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
16152
16153 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
16154 server:
16155
16156 @table @code
16157
16158 @item nnimap-address
16159 @vindex nnimap-address
16160
16161 The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
16162 server name if not specified.
16163
16164 @item nnimap-server-port
16165 @vindex nnimap-server-port
16166 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
16167
16168 Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
16169
16170 @lisp
16171 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16172 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
16173 @end lisp
16174
16175 @item nnimap-list-pattern
16176 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
16177 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
16178 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
16179 interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
16180 @acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
16181 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
16182
16183 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
16184 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
16185 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
16186 mailbox.
16187
16188 Example server specification:
16189
16190 @lisp
16191 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16192 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
16193 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
16194 @end lisp
16195
16196 @item nnimap-stream
16197 @vindex nnimap-stream
16198 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
16199 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
16200 of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
16201 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
16202 be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
16203
16204 Example server specification:
16205
16206 @lisp
16207 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16208 (nnimap-stream ssl))
16209 @end lisp
16210
16211 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
16212
16213 @itemize @bullet
16214 @item
16215 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
16216 @samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
16217 @item
16218 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
16219 @item
16220 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
16221 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
16222 @samp{starttls}.
16223 @item
16224 @dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
16225 @samp{gnutls-cli}).
16226 @item
16227 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
16228 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
16229 @item
16230 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
16231 @item
16232 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
16233 @end itemize
16234
16235 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
16236 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
16237 using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
16238 1.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
16239 to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
16240 with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
16241 restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
16242 indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
16243 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
16244 program.
16245
16246 For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
16247 needed. It is available from
16248 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
16249
16250 @vindex imap-gssapi-program
16251 This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
16252 authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
16253 sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
16254 exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
16255 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
16256 program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
16257 tried.
16258
16259 @vindex imap-ssl-program
16260 For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
16261 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
16262 and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
16263 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
16264 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
16265 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
16266 to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
16267
16268 @vindex imap-shell-program
16269 @vindex imap-shell-host
16270 For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
16271 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
16272
16273 @item nnimap-authenticator
16274 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
16275
16276 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
16277 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
16278
16279 Example server specification:
16280
16281 @lisp
16282 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16283 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
16284 @end lisp
16285
16286 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
16287
16288 @itemize @bullet
16289 @item
16290 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
16291 external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
16292 @item
16293 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
16294 @code{imtest}.
16295 @item
16296 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
16297 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
16298 @item
16299 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
16300 @item
16301 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
16302 @item
16303 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
16304 @end itemize
16305
16306 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
16307 @cindex expunging
16308 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
16309 Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
16310 don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
16311 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
16312 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
16313 nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
16314 similar).
16315
16316 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
16317 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
16318 running in circles yet?
16319
16320 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
16321 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
16322 variable.
16323
16324 The possible options are:
16325
16326 @table @code
16327
16328 @item always
16329 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
16330 closing a mailbox.
16331 @item never
16332 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
16333 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
16334 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
16335 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
16336 @item ask
16337 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
16338 articles or not.
16339
16340 @end table
16341
16342 @item nnimap-importantize-dormant
16343 @vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
16344
16345 If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
16346 well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
16347 naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
16348 articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
16349 clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
16350 has only one.)
16351
16352 Probably the only reason for frobing this would be if you're trying
16353 enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
16354
16355 @lisp
16356 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
16357 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16358 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
16359 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16360 @end lisp
16361
16362 In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
16363 as ticked for other users.
16364
16365 @item nnimap-expunge-search-string
16366 @cindex expunging
16367 @vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
16368
16369 This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
16370 searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
16371 @code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
16372 UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
16373
16374 Probably the only useful value to change this to is
16375 @code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
16376 messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
16377 RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
16378
16379 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
16380 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
16381
16382 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
16383 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
16384 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
16385 @ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
16386
16387 @example
16388 machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
16389 @end example
16390
16391 Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
16392 use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
16393 actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
16394 convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
16395 @code{port imap}.
16396
16397 @item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16398 @vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16399
16400 Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
16401 seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
16402 Courier 1.7.1 did.
16403
16404 @end table
16405
16406 @menu
16407 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
16408 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
16409 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
16410 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
16411 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
16412 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
16413 @end menu
16414
16415
16416
16417 @node Splitting in IMAP
16418 @subsection Splitting in IMAP
16419 @cindex splitting imap mail
16420
16421 Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
16422 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
16423 @acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
16424 splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
16425 @acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
16426
16427 And it does.
16428
16429 (Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
16430 gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
16431 Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
16432
16433 Here are the variables of interest:
16434
16435 @table @code
16436
16437 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
16438 @cindex splitting, crosspost
16439 @cindex crosspost
16440 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
16441
16442 If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
16443 mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
16444 found will be used.
16445
16446 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
16447
16448 @item nnimap-split-inbox
16449 @cindex splitting, inbox
16450 @cindex inbox
16451 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
16452
16453 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
16454 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
16455 splitting is disabled!
16456
16457 @lisp
16458 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
16459 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
16460 @end lisp
16461
16462 No nnmail equivalent.
16463
16464 @item nnimap-split-rule
16465 @cindex splitting, rules
16466 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
16467
16468 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
16469 this variable.
16470
16471 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
16472 sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
16473 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
16474 Neither did I, we need examples.
16475
16476 @lisp
16477 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16478 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
16479 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
16480 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
16481 ("INBOX.private" "")))
16482 @end lisp
16483
16484 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
16485 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
16486 into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
16487
16488 The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
16489 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
16490 instance:
16491
16492 @lisp
16493 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
16494 @end lisp
16495
16496 The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
16497 matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
16498
16499 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
16500 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
16501 containing the headers of the article. It should return a
16502 non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
16503
16504 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
16505 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
16506 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
16507 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
16508 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
16509 them every time you fetch new mail.)
16510
16511 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
16512 end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
16513 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
16514
16515 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
16516 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
16517 thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16518
16519 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
16520
16521 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
16522 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
16523 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
16524
16525 @lisp
16526 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16527 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
16528 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
16529 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
16530 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
16531 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
16532 @end lisp
16533
16534 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
16535 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
16536 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
16537 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
16538 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
16539 group/function elements.
16540
16541 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
16542
16543 @item nnimap-split-predicate
16544 @cindex splitting
16545 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
16546
16547 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
16548 split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
16549
16550 This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
16551 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
16552 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
16553 @samp{UNDELETED}.
16554
16555 @item nnimap-split-fancy
16556 @cindex splitting, fancy
16557 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
16558 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
16559
16560 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16561 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
16562 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
16563
16564 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
16565 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16566 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
16567 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16568
16569 Example:
16570
16571 @lisp
16572 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
16573 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
16574 @end lisp
16575
16576 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
16577
16578 @item nnimap-split-download-body
16579 @findex nnimap-split-download-body
16580 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
16581
16582 Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
16583 This is generally not required, and will slow things down
16584 considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
16585 splitting function that analyzes the body to split the article.
16586
16587 @end table
16588
16589 @node Expiring in IMAP
16590 @subsection Expiring in IMAP
16591 @cindex expiring imap mail
16592
16593 Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
16594 end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
16595 Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
16596 IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
16597 @var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
16598 follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
16599 process.
16600
16601 A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
16602 appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
16603 @code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
16604 message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
16605 the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
16606 you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
16607 your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
16608 messages. Most do, fortunately.
16609
16610 @table @code
16611
16612 @item nnmail-expiry-wait
16613 @item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16614
16615 These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
16616 number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
16617
16618 @item nnmail-expiry-target
16619
16620 This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
16621 @code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
16622 that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
16623 article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
16624
16625 @end table
16626
16627 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
16628 @subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
16629 @cindex editing imap acls
16630 @cindex Access Control Lists
16631 @cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
16632 @kindex G l (Group)
16633 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
16634
16635 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
16636 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
16637 @acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
16638 doesn't.
16639
16640 To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
16641 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
16642 editing window with detailed instructions.
16643
16644 Some possible uses:
16645
16646 @itemize @bullet
16647 @item
16648 Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
16649 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
16650 follow the list without subscribing to it.
16651 @item
16652 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
16653 ``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
16654 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
16655 INBOX.mailbox).
16656 @end itemize
16657
16658 @node Expunging mailboxes
16659 @subsection Expunging mailboxes
16660 @cindex expunging
16661
16662 @cindex expunge
16663 @cindex manual expunging
16664 @kindex G x (Group)
16665 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
16666
16667 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
16668 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
16669 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
16670
16671 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
16672 delete them.
16673
16674 @node A note on namespaces
16675 @subsection A note on namespaces
16676 @cindex IMAP namespace
16677 @cindex namespaces
16678
16679 The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
16680 by the following text in the RFC2060:
16681
16682 @display
16683 5.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
16684
16685 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
16686 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
16687 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
16688 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
16689
16690 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
16691 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
16692 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
16693 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
16694 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
16695 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
16696 @end display
16697
16698 While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
16699 @acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
16700 prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
16701
16702 Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
16703 mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
16704 in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
16705 created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
16706 without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
16707 not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
16708 mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
16709 you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
16710 Gnus.
16711
16712 See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
16713 for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
16714 tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
16715
16716 @node Debugging IMAP
16717 @subsection Debugging IMAP
16718 @cindex IMAP debugging
16719 @cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
16720
16721 @acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
16722 @acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
16723 best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behavior, chances
16724 are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
16725
16726 If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
16727 probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
16728 exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
16729 with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
16730 @acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
16731 critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
16732 to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
16733
16734
16735 @vindex imap-log
16736 Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
16737 disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
16738 follows:
16739
16740 @lisp
16741 (setq imap-log t)
16742 @end lisp
16743
16744 This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
16745 the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
16746 for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
16747 @code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
16748 data.
16749
16750 @node Other Sources
16751 @section Other Sources
16752
16753 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
16754 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
16755 newsgroups.
16756
16757 @menu
16758 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
16759 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
16760 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
16761 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
16762 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
16763 @end menu
16764
16765
16766 @node Directory Groups
16767 @subsection Directory Groups
16768 @cindex nndir
16769 @cindex directory groups
16770
16771 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
16772 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
16773 names, of course.
16774
16775 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
16776 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
16777 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
16778 back end to read directories. Big deal.
16779
16780 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
16781 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
16782 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
16783 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
16784 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
16785
16786 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
16787
16788 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
16789 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
16790 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
16791 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
16792
16793
16794 @node Anything Groups
16795 @subsection Anything Groups
16796 @cindex nneething
16797
16798 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
16799 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
16800 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
16801 true.
16802
16803 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
16804 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
16805 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
16806 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
16807 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
16808 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
16809 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
16810 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
16811 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
16812 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
16813 elements.
16814
16815 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
16816 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
16817 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
16818 in the article buffer, just as usual.
16819
16820 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
16821 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
16822 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
16823 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
16824
16825 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
16826 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
16827 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
16828 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
16829 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
16830 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
16831 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
16832 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
16833
16834 Some variables:
16835
16836 @table @code
16837 @item nneething-map-file-directory
16838 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
16839 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
16840 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
16841
16842 @item nneething-exclude-files
16843 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
16844 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
16845 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
16846
16847 @item nneething-include-files
16848 @vindex nneething-include-files
16849 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
16850 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
16851
16852 @item nneething-map-file
16853 @vindex nneething-map-file
16854 Name of the map files.
16855 @end table
16856
16857
16858 @node Document Groups
16859 @subsection Document Groups
16860 @cindex nndoc
16861 @cindex documentation group
16862 @cindex help group
16863
16864 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
16865 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
16866
16867 @table @code
16868 @cindex Babyl
16869 @cindex Rmail mbox
16870 @item babyl
16871 The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
16872
16873 @cindex mbox
16874 @cindex Unix mbox
16875 @item mbox
16876 The standard Unix mbox file.
16877
16878 @cindex MMDF mail box
16879 @item mmdf
16880 The MMDF mail box format.
16881
16882 @item news
16883 Several news articles appended into a file.
16884
16885 @cindex rnews batch files
16886 @item rnews
16887 The rnews batch transport format.
16888
16889 @item nsmail
16890 Netscape mail boxes.
16891
16892 @item mime-parts
16893 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
16894
16895 @item standard-digest
16896 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
16897
16898 @item mime-digest
16899 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
16900
16901 @item lanl-gov-announce
16902 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
16903
16904 @cindex forwarded messages
16905 @item rfc822-forward
16906 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
16907
16908 @item outlook
16909 The Outlook mail box.
16910
16911 @item oe-dbx
16912 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
16913
16914 @item exim-bounce
16915 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
16916
16917 @item forward
16918 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
16919
16920 @item rfc934
16921 An RFC934-forwarded message.
16922
16923 @item mailman
16924 A mailman digest.
16925
16926 @item clari-briefs
16927 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
16928
16929 @item slack-digest
16930 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
16931
16932 @item mail-in-mail
16933 The last resort.
16934 @end table
16935
16936 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
16937 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
16938 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
16939 file is.
16940
16941 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
16942 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
16943 group. And that's it.
16944
16945 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
16946 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
16947 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
16948 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
16949 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
16950 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
16951 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
16952 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
16953 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
16954 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
16955
16956 Virtual server variables:
16957
16958 @table @code
16959 @item nndoc-article-type
16960 @vindex nndoc-article-type
16961 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
16962 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
16963 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
16964 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
16965 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
16966
16967 @item nndoc-post-type
16968 @vindex nndoc-post-type
16969 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
16970 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
16971 and @code{news}.
16972 @end table
16973
16974 @menu
16975 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
16976 @end menu
16977
16978
16979 @node Document Server Internals
16980 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
16981
16982 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
16983 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
16984 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
16985 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
16986
16987 First, here's an example document type definition:
16988
16989 @example
16990 (mmdf
16991 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
16992 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
16993 @end example
16994
16995 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
16996 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
16997 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
16998 types can be defined with very few settings:
16999
17000 @table @code
17001 @item first-article
17002 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17003 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17004 totally ignored.
17005
17006 @item article-begin
17007 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17008 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17009 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17010 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17011
17012 @item article-begin-function
17013 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17014 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17015
17016 @item head-begin
17017 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17018 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17019 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17020
17021 @item head-begin-function
17022 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17023 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17024
17025 @item head-end
17026 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17027 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17028
17029 @item body-begin
17030 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17031 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17032 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17033
17034 @item body-begin-function
17035 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17036 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17037
17038 @item body-end
17039 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17040 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17041 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17042
17043 @item body-end-function
17044 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17045 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17046
17047 @item file-begin
17048 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17049 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17050
17051 @item file-end
17052 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17053 regexp will be totally ignored.
17054
17055 @end table
17056
17057 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17058 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17059 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17060 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17061 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17062
17063 @table @code
17064 @item prepare-body-function
17065 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17066 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17067 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17068
17069 @item article-transform-function
17070 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17071 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17072 body of the article.
17073
17074 @item generate-head-function
17075 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17076 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17077 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17078 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17079
17080 @item generate-article-function
17081 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17082 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17083 parameter when requesting all articles.
17084
17085 @item dissection-function
17086 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17087 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17088 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17089 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17090 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17091 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17092
17093 @end table
17094
17095 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17096 digests:
17097
17098 @example
17099 (standard-digest
17100 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17101 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17102 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17103 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17104 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17105 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17106 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17107 (subtype digest guess))
17108 @end example
17109
17110 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17111 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17112 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17113 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17114 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17115
17116 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17117 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17118 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17119 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17120 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17121 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17122 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17123 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17124 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17125 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17126 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17127 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17128
17129
17130 @node SOUP
17131 @subsection SOUP
17132 @cindex SOUP
17133 @cindex offline
17134
17135 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
17136 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
17137 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
17138
17139 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
17140 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
17141 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
17142 newsreaders.
17143
17144 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
17145 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
17146 that interested in doing things properly.
17147
17148 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
17149 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
17150 fiddly.
17151
17152 First some terminology:
17153
17154 @table @dfn
17155
17156 @item server
17157 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
17158 get news and/or mail from.
17159
17160 @item home machine
17161 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
17162 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
17163
17164 @item packet
17165 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
17166 of packets:
17167
17168 @table @dfn
17169 @item message packets
17170 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
17171 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
17172 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17173
17174 @item response packets
17175 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
17176 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
17177 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17178
17179 @end table
17180
17181 @end table
17182
17183
17184 @enumerate
17185
17186 @item
17187 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
17188 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
17189 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
17190 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
17191
17192 @item
17193 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
17194
17195 @item
17196 You put the packet in your home directory.
17197
17198 @item
17199 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
17200 the native or secondary server.
17201
17202 @item
17203 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
17204 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
17205
17206 @item
17207 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
17208 packet.
17209
17210 @item
17211 You transfer this packet to the server.
17212
17213 @item
17214 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
17215
17216 @item
17217 You then repeat until you die.
17218
17219 @end enumerate
17220
17221 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
17222 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
17223
17224 @menu
17225 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
17226 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
17227 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
17228 @end menu
17229
17230
17231 @node SOUP Commands
17232 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
17233
17234 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
17235
17236 @table @kbd
17237 @item G s b
17238 @kindex G s b (Group)
17239 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
17240 Pack all unread articles in the current group
17241 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
17242 process/prefix convention.
17243
17244 @item G s w
17245 @kindex G s w (Group)
17246 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
17247 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
17248
17249 @item G s s
17250 @kindex G s s (Group)
17251 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
17252 Send all replies from the replies packet
17253 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
17254
17255 @item G s p
17256 @kindex G s p (Group)
17257 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
17258 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
17259
17260 @item G s r
17261 @kindex G s r (Group)
17262 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
17263 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
17264
17265 @item O s
17266 @kindex O s (Summary)
17267 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
17268 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
17269 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
17270 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
17271
17272 @end table
17273
17274
17275 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
17276 thingies:
17277
17278 @table @code
17279
17280 @item gnus-soup-directory
17281 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
17282 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
17283 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
17284
17285 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
17286 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
17287 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
17288 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
17289
17290 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
17291 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
17292 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
17293 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
17294
17295 @item gnus-soup-packer
17296 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
17297 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17298 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
17299
17300 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
17301 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
17302 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17303 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17304
17305 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
17306 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
17307 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
17308
17309 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17310 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17311 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
17312 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
17313
17314 @end table
17315
17316
17317 @node SOUP Groups
17318 @subsubsection SOUP Groups
17319 @cindex nnsoup
17320
17321 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
17322 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
17323 you can read them at leisure.
17324
17325 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
17326
17327 @table @code
17328
17329 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
17330 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
17331 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
17332 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
17333
17334 @item nnsoup-directory
17335 @vindex nnsoup-directory
17336 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
17337 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
17338
17339 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
17340 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
17341 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
17342 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
17343
17344 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
17345 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
17346 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
17347 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
17348 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
17349
17350 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
17351 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
17352 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
17353 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
17354
17355 @item nnsoup-active-file
17356 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
17357 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
17358 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
17359 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
17360 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
17361
17362 @item nnsoup-packer
17363 @vindex nnsoup-packer
17364 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
17365 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
17366
17367 @item nnsoup-unpacker
17368 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
17369 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
17370 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17371
17372 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
17373 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
17374 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
17375 @file{~/}.
17376
17377 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
17378 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
17379 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
17380 @samp{Soupout}.
17381
17382 @item nnsoup-always-save
17383 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
17384 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
17385
17386 @end table
17387
17388
17389 @node SOUP Replies
17390 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
17391
17392 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
17393 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
17394 more for that to happen.
17395
17396 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
17397 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
17398 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
17399 @sc{soup} system.
17400
17401 In specific, this is what it does:
17402
17403 @lisp
17404 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
17405 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
17406 @end lisp
17407
17408 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
17409 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
17410 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
17411
17412
17413 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17414 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17415 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17416 @cindex gateways
17417
17418 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17419 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17420 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17421
17422 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17423 used to post with.
17424
17425 Server variables:
17426
17427 @table @code
17428 @item nngateway-address
17429 @vindex nngateway-address
17430 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17431
17432 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17433 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17434 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17435 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17436 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17437 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17438 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17439 gateway address.
17440
17441 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17442 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17443 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17444
17445 @example
17446 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17447 @end example
17448
17449 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17450
17451 @example
17452 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17453 @end example
17454
17455 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17456
17457 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17458 @table @code
17459
17460 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17461 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17462 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17463
17464 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17465
17466 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17467 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17468 @code{nngateway-address}.
17469 @end table
17470
17471 @end table
17472
17473 Here's an example:
17474
17475 @lisp
17476 (setq gnus-post-method
17477 '(nngateway
17478 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17479 (nngateway-header-transformation
17480 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17481 @end lisp
17482
17483 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17484
17485 @lisp
17486 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17487 @end lisp
17488
17489
17490
17491 @node Combined Groups
17492 @section Combined Groups
17493
17494 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17495 groups.
17496
17497 @menu
17498 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17499 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
17500 @end menu
17501
17502
17503 @node Virtual Groups
17504 @subsection Virtual Groups
17505 @cindex nnvirtual
17506 @cindex virtual groups
17507 @cindex merging groups
17508
17509 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17510 other groups.
17511
17512 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17513 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17514 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17515
17516 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17517 regexp to match component groups.
17518
17519 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17520 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17521 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17522 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17523 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17524 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17525 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17526 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17527
17528 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17529 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17530
17531 @lisp
17532 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17533 @end lisp
17534
17535 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17536 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17537
17538 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17539 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17540 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17541 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17542
17543 @example
17544 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17545 @end example
17546
17547 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17548 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17549 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17550
17551 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17552 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17553 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17554 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17555 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17556
17557 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17558 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17559 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17560
17561 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17562 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17563 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17564 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17565 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17566 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17567 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17568 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17569 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17570 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17571 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17572
17573 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17574 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17575 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17576 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17577 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17578 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17579 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17580
17581 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17582 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17583
17584 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17585 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17586 inherited.
17587
17588
17589 @node Kibozed Groups
17590 @subsection Kibozed Groups
17591 @cindex nnkiboze
17592 @cindex kibozing
17593
17594 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
17595 (parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
17596 do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
17597 down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
17598
17599 @kindex G k (Group)
17600 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
17601 buffer.
17602
17603 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
17604 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
17605 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
17606 @code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
17607
17608 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
17609 @code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
17610 to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
17611
17612 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
17613 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
17614 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
17615 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
17616 Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
17617 headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
17618 through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
17619 the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
17620
17621 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
17622 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
17623 @acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
17624 Stranger things have happened.
17625
17626 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
17627 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
17628
17629 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
17630 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
17631 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
17632 One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
17633 the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
17634 information on what groups have been searched through to find
17635 component articles.
17636
17637 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
17638 their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
17639
17640
17641 @node Gnus Unplugged
17642 @section Gnus Unplugged
17643 @cindex offline
17644 @cindex unplugged
17645 @cindex agent
17646 @cindex Gnus agent
17647 @cindex Gnus unplugged
17648
17649 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
17650 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
17651 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
17652 read news. Believe it or not.
17653
17654 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
17655 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
17656 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
17657 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
17658 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
17659
17660 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
17661 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
17662 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
17663 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
17664 reading news on a machine.
17665
17666 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
17667 fact, you don't even have to configure anything.
17668
17669 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
17670
17671 @menu
17672 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
17673 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
17674 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
17675 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
17676 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
17677 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
17678 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
17679 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
17680 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
17681 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
17682 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
17683 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
17684 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
17685 @end menu
17686
17687
17688 @node Agent Basics
17689 @subsection Agent Basics
17690
17691 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
17692
17693 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
17694 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
17695 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
17696 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
17697
17698 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
17699 connected to the net continuously.
17700
17701 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
17702 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
17703
17704 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
17705 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
17706 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
17707 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
17708 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
17709
17710 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
17711 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
17712 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
17713 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
17714 they're kinda like plugged always).
17715
17716 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
17717 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
17718 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
17719 the culprit.
17720
17721 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
17722 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
17723 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
17724 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
17725 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
17726
17727 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
17728
17729 @itemize @bullet
17730
17731 @item
17732 @findex gnus-unplugged
17733 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
17734 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
17735 already fetched while in this mode.
17736
17737 @item
17738 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
17739 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
17740 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
17741 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
17742 Source Specifiers}).
17743
17744 @item
17745 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
17746 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
17747 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
17748 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
17749 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
17750
17751 @item
17752 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
17753 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
17754 then you read the news offline.
17755
17756 @item
17757 And then you go to step 2.
17758 @end itemize
17759
17760 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
17761 the Agent.
17762
17763 @itemize @bullet
17764
17765 @item
17766 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
17767 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
17768 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
17769 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
17770 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
17771 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
17772 all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
17773 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
17774
17775 @item
17776 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
17777 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
17778 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
17779 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
17780
17781 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
17782 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
17783 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
17784 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
17785 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
17786 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
17787 configure them.
17788
17789 @item
17790 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
17791 @end itemize
17792
17793
17794 @node Agent Categories
17795 @subsection Agent Categories
17796
17797 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
17798 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
17799 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
17800 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
17801 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
17802 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
17803 you're interested in the articles anyway.
17804
17805 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
17806 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
17807 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
17808 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
17809 buffer for creating and managing categories.
17810
17811 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
17812 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
17813 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
17814 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
17815 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
17816 sink.
17817
17818 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
17819 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
17820 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
17821 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
17822 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
17823 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
17824 your settings.
17825
17826 @menu
17827 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
17828 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
17829 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
17830 @end menu
17831
17832
17833 @node Category Syntax
17834 @subsubsection Category Syntax
17835
17836 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
17837 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
17838 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
17839 listed below.
17840
17841 @cindex Agent Parameters
17842 @table @code
17843 @item gnus-agent-cat-name
17844 The name of the category.
17845
17846 @item gnus-agent-cat-groups
17847 The list of groups that are in this category.
17848
17849 @item gnus-agent-cat-predicate
17850 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
17851 are eligible for downloading; and
17852
17853 @item gnus-agent-cat-score-file
17854 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
17855 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
17856 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
17857
17858 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-expiration
17859 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
17860 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
17861 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
17862 only groups that should not be expired.
17863
17864 @item gnus-agent-cat-days-until-old
17865 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
17866 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
17867
17868 @item gnus-agent-cat-low-score
17869 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
17870
17871 @item gnus-agent-cat-high-score
17872 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
17873
17874 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-short
17875 an integer that overrides the value of
17876 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
17877
17878 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-long
17879 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
17880
17881 @c @item gnus-agent-cat-disable-undownloaded-faces
17882 @c a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should @emph{not} display
17883 @c undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17884 @c faces. The symbol nil will enable the use of undownloaded faces while
17885 @c all other symbols disable them.
17886
17887 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-undownloaded-faces
17888 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
17889 undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17890 faces. The symbol nil will disable the use of undownloaded faces while
17891 all other symbols enable them.
17892 @end table
17893
17894 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
17895 created.
17896
17897 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
17898 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
17899 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
17900 category.
17901
17902 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
17903 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
17904 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
17905 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
17906
17907 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
17908 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
17909 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
17910
17911 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
17912 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
17913 operators sprinkled in between.
17914
17915 Perhaps some examples are in order.
17916
17917 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
17918 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
17919
17920 @lisp
17921 short
17922 @end lisp
17923
17924 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
17925 short (for some value of ``short'').
17926
17927 Here's a more complex predicate:
17928
17929 @lisp
17930 (or high
17931 (and
17932 (not low)
17933 (not long)))
17934 @end lisp
17935
17936 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
17937 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
17938 drift.
17939
17940 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
17941 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
17942 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
17943
17944 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
17945 you want to do, you can write your own.
17946
17947 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
17948 bound to the value determined by calling
17949 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
17950 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
17951 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
17952 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
17953 predicate to individual groups.
17954
17955 @table @code
17956 @item short
17957 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
17958 lines; default 100.
17959
17960 @item long
17961 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
17962 lines; default 200.
17963
17964 @item low
17965 True iff the article has a download score less than
17966 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
17967
17968 @item high
17969 True iff the article has a download score greater than
17970 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
17971
17972 @item spam
17973 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
17974 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
17975 checksum and sees whether articles match.
17976
17977 @item true
17978 Always true.
17979
17980 @item false
17981 Always false.
17982 @end table
17983
17984 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
17985 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
17986 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
17987 useful values.
17988
17989 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
17990 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
17991 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
17992 something along the lines of the following:
17993
17994 @lisp
17995 (defun my-article-old-p ()
17996 "Say whether an article is old."
17997 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
17998 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
17999 @end lisp
18000
18001 with the predicate then defined as:
18002
18003 @lisp
18004 (not my-article-old-p)
18005 @end lisp
18006
18007 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18008 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18009 wherever.
18010
18011 @lisp
18012 (require 'gnus-agent)
18013 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18014 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18015 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18016 @end lisp
18017
18018 and simply specify your predicate as:
18019
18020 @lisp
18021 (not old)
18022 @end lisp
18023
18024 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18025 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18026 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18027 just don't give a damn.
18028
18029 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18030 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18031 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18032 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18033 parameters like so:
18034
18035 @lisp
18036 (agent-predicate . short)
18037 @end lisp
18038
18039 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18040 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18041 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18042
18043 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18044
18045 @lisp
18046 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18047 @end lisp
18048
18049 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18050 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18051 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18052
18053
18054 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18055 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18056 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18057 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18058 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18059 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18060
18061 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18062 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18063 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18064 if it's to be specific to that group.
18065
18066 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18067 three forms:
18068
18069 @enumerate
18070 @item
18071 Score rule
18072
18073 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18074 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18075
18076 example:
18077
18078 @itemize @bullet
18079 @item
18080 Category specification
18081
18082 @lisp
18083 (("from"
18084 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18085 ("lines"
18086 (500 -100 nil <)))
18087 @end lisp
18088
18089 @item
18090 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18091
18092 @lisp
18093 (agent-score ("from"
18094 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18095 ("lines"
18096 (500 -100 nil <)))
18097 @end lisp
18098
18099 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18100 @end itemize
18101
18102 @item
18103 Agent score file
18104
18105 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18106 keywords stated above.
18107
18108 example:
18109
18110 @itemize @bullet
18111 @item
18112 Category specification
18113
18114 @lisp
18115 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18116 @end lisp
18117
18118 or perhaps
18119
18120 @lisp
18121 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18122 @end lisp
18123
18124 @item
18125 Group Parameter specification
18126
18127 @lisp
18128 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18129 @end lisp
18130
18131 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18132 about parenthesis?
18133 @end itemize
18134
18135 @item
18136 Use @code{normal} score files
18137
18138 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18139 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18140 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18141 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18142
18143 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18144 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18145 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18146 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18147
18148 @itemize @bullet
18149 @item
18150 Category Specification
18151
18152 @lisp
18153 file
18154 @end lisp
18155
18156 @item
18157 Group Parameter specification
18158
18159 @lisp
18160 (agent-score . file)
18161 @end lisp
18162 @end itemize
18163 @end enumerate
18164
18165 @node Category Buffer
18166 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18167
18168 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18169 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18170 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18171
18172 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18173
18174 @table @kbd
18175 @item q
18176 @kindex q (Category)
18177 @findex gnus-category-exit
18178 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18179
18180 @item e
18181 @kindex e (Category)
18182 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18183 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18184 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18185
18186 @item k
18187 @kindex k (Category)
18188 @findex gnus-category-kill
18189 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18190
18191 @item c
18192 @kindex c (Category)
18193 @findex gnus-category-copy
18194 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18195
18196 @item a
18197 @kindex a (Category)
18198 @findex gnus-category-add
18199 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18200
18201 @item p
18202 @kindex p (Category)
18203 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18204 Edit the predicate of the current category
18205 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18206
18207 @item g
18208 @kindex g (Category)
18209 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18210 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18211 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18212
18213 @item s
18214 @kindex s (Category)
18215 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18216 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18217 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18218
18219 @item l
18220 @kindex l (Category)
18221 @findex gnus-category-list
18222 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18223 @end table
18224
18225
18226 @node Category Variables
18227 @subsubsection Category Variables
18228
18229 @table @code
18230 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18231 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18232 Hook run in category buffers.
18233
18234 @item gnus-category-line-format
18235 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18236 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18237 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18238
18239 @table @samp
18240 @item c
18241 The name of the category.
18242
18243 @item g
18244 The number of groups in the category.
18245 @end table
18246
18247 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18248 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18249 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18250
18251 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18252 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18253 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18254
18255 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18256 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18257 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18258
18259 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18260 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18261 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18262 0.
18263
18264 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18265 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18266 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18267 0.
18268
18269 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18270 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18271 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18272 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18273 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18274 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18275 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18276 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18277 read.
18278 Default 7.
18279
18280 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18281 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18282 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18283 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18284 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18285 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18286 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18287
18288 @end table
18289
18290
18291 @node Agent Commands
18292 @subsection Agent Commands
18293 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18294 @kindex J j (Agent)
18295
18296 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18297 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18298 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18299
18300
18301 @menu
18302 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18303 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18304 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18305 @end menu
18306
18307
18308
18309
18310 @node Group Agent Commands
18311 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18312
18313 @table @kbd
18314 @item J u
18315 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18316 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18317 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18318 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18319
18320 @item J c
18321 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18322 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18323 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18324
18325 @item J s
18326 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18327 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18328 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18329 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18330
18331 @item J S
18332 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18333 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18334 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18335 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18336
18337 @item J a
18338 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18339 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18340 Add the current group to an Agent category
18341 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18342 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18343
18344 @item J r
18345 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18346 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18347 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18348 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18349 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18350
18351 @item J Y
18352 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18353 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18354 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18355
18356
18357 @end table
18358
18359
18360 @node Summary Agent Commands
18361 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18362
18363 @table @kbd
18364 @item J #
18365 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18366 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18367 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18368
18369 @item J M-#
18370 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18371 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18372 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18373 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18374
18375 @cindex %
18376 @item @@
18377 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18378 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18379 Toggle whether to download the article
18380 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18381 default.
18382
18383 @item J c
18384 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18385 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18386 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18387
18388 @item J S
18389 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18390 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18391 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18392 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18393
18394 @item J s
18395 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18396 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-series
18397 Download all processable articles in this group.
18398 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-series}).
18399
18400 @item J u
18401 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18402 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18403 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18404 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18405
18406 @end table
18407
18408
18409 @node Server Agent Commands
18410 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18411
18412 @table @kbd
18413 @item J a
18414 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18415 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18416 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18417 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18418
18419 @item J r
18420 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18421 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18422 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18423 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18424
18425 @end table
18426
18427
18428 @node Agent Visuals
18429 @subsection Agent Visuals
18430
18431 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18432 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18433 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18434 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18435 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18436 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18437 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18438 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18439 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18440 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18441
18442 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18443 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18444 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18445 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18446 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18447 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18448 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18449 articles will be available when unplugged.
18450
18451 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18452 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18453 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18454 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18455 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18456 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18457 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18458 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18459
18460 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18461 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18462 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18463 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18464 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18465 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18466 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18467 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18468 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18469
18470 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18471 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18472 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18473 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18474 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear.
18475
18476 For occasional Agent users, the undownloaded faces may appear to be an
18477 absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since most of their
18478 articles have not been fetched into the Agent, most of the normal
18479 faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces. If this is your
18480 situation, you have two choices available. First, you can completely
18481 disable the undownload faces by customizing
18482 @code{gnus-summary-highlight} to delete the three cons-cells that
18483 refer to the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face} faces. Second,
18484 if you prefer to take a more fine-grained approach, you may set the
18485 @code{agent-disable-undownloaded-faces} group parameter to @code{t}.
18486 This parameter, like all other agent parameters, may be set on an
18487 Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}), a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic
18488 Parameters}), or an individual group (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18489
18490 @node Agent as Cache
18491 @subsection Agent as Cache
18492
18493 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18494 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18495 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18496 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18497 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18498 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18499 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18500 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18501 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18502
18503 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18504 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18505 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18506 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18507 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18508
18509 @node Agent Expiry
18510 @subsection Agent Expiry
18511
18512 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18513 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18514 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18515 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18516 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18517 @cindex agent expiry
18518 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18519 @cindex expiry
18520
18521 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18522 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18523 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18524 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18525 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18526 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18527 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18528 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18529
18530 Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
18531 might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
18532 synchronized with the group.
18533
18534 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18535 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18536
18537 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18538 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18539 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18540 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18541 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18542 be kept indefinitely.
18543
18544 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18545 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18546 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18547 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18548
18549 @node Agent Regeneration
18550 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18551
18552 @cindex agent regeneration
18553 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18554 @cindex regeneration
18555
18556 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
18557 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
18558 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
18559 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
18560 internal inconsistencies.
18561
18562 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
18563 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
18564 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
18565 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
18566 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
18567 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
18568
18569 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
18570 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
18571 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
18572 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
18573 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
18574 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
18575
18576 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18577 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18578 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
18579 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
18580 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
18581 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
18582 agent as unread.
18583
18584 @node Agent and IMAP
18585 @subsection Agent and IMAP
18586
18587 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
18588 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
18589 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
18590 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
18591
18592 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
18593 are kept on the @acronym{IMAP} server, rather than in @file{.newsrc} as is the
18594 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
18595 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
18596
18597 Gnus keeps track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
18598 Agent. When you plug back in, Gnus will check if you have any changed
18599 any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the server.
18600 The behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
18601
18602 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18603 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
18604 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
18605 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
18606 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
18607 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
18608
18609 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
18610 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
18611 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
18612 in the group buffer.
18613
18614 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
18615 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
18616
18617 @itemize @bullet
18618
18619 @item
18620 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
18621
18622 @item
18623 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
18624
18625 @end itemize
18626
18627 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
18628 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
18629 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
18630 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group and
18631 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
18632 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
18633 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
18634 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
18635
18636
18637 @node Outgoing Messages
18638 @subsection Outgoing Messages
18639
18640 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
18641 stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view
18642 them there after posting, and edit them at will.
18643
18644 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
18645 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
18646 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
18647 messages in the draft group.
18648
18649
18650
18651 @node Agent Variables
18652 @subsection Agent Variables
18653
18654 @table @code
18655 @item gnus-agent-directory
18656 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
18657 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
18658 @file{~/News/agent/}.
18659
18660 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
18661 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
18662 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
18663 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
18664 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
18665 by default.
18666
18667 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18668 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18669 Hook run when connecting to the network.
18670
18671 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18672 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18673 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
18674
18675 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18676 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18677 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
18678
18679 @item gnus-agent-cache
18680 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
18681 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
18682 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
18683 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
18684
18685 @item gnus-agent-go-online
18686 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
18687 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
18688 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
18689 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
18690 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
18691 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
18692 online status.
18693
18694 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18695 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18696 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
18697 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
18698 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
18699 read. The default is @code{t}.
18700
18701 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18702 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18703 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
18704 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
18705 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
18706 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
18707 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
18708 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
18709 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
18710 over and over again.
18711
18712 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18713 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18714 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
18715 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
18716 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
18717 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
18718 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
18719 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
18720 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
18721 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
18722 However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
18723 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
18724 see any cycling.
18725
18726 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
18727 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
18728 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
18729 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
18730 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
18731 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
18732 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
18733 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
18734 is only valid if the Agent is used.
18735
18736 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18737 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18738 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
18739 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
18740 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
18741 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
18742
18743 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
18744 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
18745 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
18746 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
18747 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
18748
18749 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18750 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18751 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
18752 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
18753 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
18754 which backends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
18755 to agentize remote backends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
18756 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
18757 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
18758 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
18759 start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
18760
18761 @end table
18762
18763
18764 @node Example Setup
18765 @subsection Example Setup
18766
18767 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
18768 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
18769 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
18770
18771 @lisp
18772 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
18773 ;;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
18774 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
18775
18776 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
18777 ;;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
18778 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
18779
18780 ;;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
18781 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
18782
18783 ;;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
18784 ;;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
18785 ;;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
18786 @end lisp
18787
18788 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
18789 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
18790 gnus}.
18791
18792 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
18793 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
18794 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
18795 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
18796 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
18797 once.
18798
18799 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
18800 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
18801 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
18802 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
18803 back all the killed groups.)
18804
18805 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
18806 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
18807 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
18808
18809
18810 @node Batching Agents
18811 @subsection Batching Agents
18812 @findex gnus-agent-batch
18813
18814 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
18815 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
18816 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
18817
18818 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
18819 following incantation:
18820
18821 @example
18822 #!/bin/sh
18823 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
18824 @end example
18825
18826
18827 @node Agent Caveats
18828 @subsection Agent Caveats
18829
18830 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
18831 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
18832 may ask:
18833
18834 @table @dfn
18835 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
18836
18837 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
18838 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
18839 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
18840
18841 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
18842 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
18843
18844 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
18845
18846 @end table
18847
18848 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
18849 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
18850 locally stored articles.
18851
18852
18853 @node Scoring
18854 @chapter Scoring
18855 @cindex scoring
18856
18857 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
18858 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
18859 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
18860 attention!
18861
18862 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
18863 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
18864 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
18865 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
18866 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
18867
18868 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
18869 before generating the summary buffer.
18870
18871 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
18872 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
18873 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
18874
18875 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
18876 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
18877 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
18878 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
18879
18880 @menu
18881 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
18882 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
18883 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
18884 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
18885 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
18886 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
18887 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
18888 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
18889 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
18890 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
18891 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
18892 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
18893 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
18894 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
18895 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
18896 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
18897 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
18898 @end menu
18899
18900
18901 @node Summary Score Commands
18902 @section Summary Score Commands
18903 @cindex score commands
18904
18905 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
18906 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
18907 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
18908 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
18909 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
18910
18911 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
18912 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
18913 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
18914 score file the current one.
18915
18916 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
18917
18918 @table @kbd
18919
18920 @item V s
18921 @kindex V s (Summary)
18922 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
18923 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
18924
18925 @item V S
18926 @kindex V S (Summary)
18927 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
18928 Display the score of the current article
18929 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
18930
18931 @item V t
18932 @kindex V t (Summary)
18933 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
18934 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
18935 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
18936 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
18937 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
18938 score file and edit it.
18939
18940 @item V w
18941 @kindex V w (Summary)
18942 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
18943 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
18944
18945 @item V R
18946 @kindex V R (Summary)
18947 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
18948 Run the current summary through the scoring process
18949 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
18950 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
18951 effect you're having.
18952
18953 @item V c
18954 @kindex V c (Summary)
18955 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
18956 Make a different score file the current
18957 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
18958
18959 @item V e
18960 @kindex V e (Summary)
18961 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
18962 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
18963 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
18964 File Editing}).
18965
18966 @item V f
18967 @kindex V f (Summary)
18968 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
18969 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
18970 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
18971
18972 @item V F
18973 @kindex V F (Summary)
18974 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
18975 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
18976 after editing score files.
18977
18978 @item V C
18979 @kindex V C (Summary)
18980 @findex gnus-score-customize
18981 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
18982 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
18983
18984 @end table
18985
18986 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
18987
18988 @table @kbd
18989
18990 @item V m
18991 @kindex V m (Summary)
18992 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
18993 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
18994 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
18995
18996 @item V x
18997 @kindex V x (Summary)
18998 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
18999 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19000 expunge all articles below this score
19001 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19002 @end table
19003
19004 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19005 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19006 them.)
19007
19008 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19009 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19010
19011 @enumerate
19012 @item
19013 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19014 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19015 @item
19016 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19017 keys are available:
19018 @table @kbd
19019
19020 @item a
19021 Score on the author name.
19022
19023 @item s
19024 Score on the subject line.
19025
19026 @item x
19027 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19028
19029 @item r
19030 Score on the @code{References} line.
19031
19032 @item d
19033 Score on the date.
19034
19035 @item l
19036 Score on the number of lines.
19037
19038 @item i
19039 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19040
19041 @item e
19042 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19043 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19044
19045 @item f
19046 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19047 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19048 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19049
19050 @item b
19051 Score on the body.
19052
19053 @item h
19054 Score on the head.
19055
19056 @item t
19057 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19058 files.)
19059
19060 @end table
19061
19062 @item
19063 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19064 what headers you are scoring on.
19065
19066 @table @code
19067
19068 @item strings
19069
19070 @table @kbd
19071
19072 @item e
19073 Exact matching.
19074
19075 @item s
19076 Substring matching.
19077
19078 @item f
19079 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19080
19081 @item r
19082 Regexp matching
19083 @end table
19084
19085 @item date
19086 @table @kbd
19087
19088 @item b
19089 Before date.
19090
19091 @item a
19092 After date.
19093
19094 @item n
19095 This date.
19096 @end table
19097
19098 @item number
19099 @table @kbd
19100
19101 @item <
19102 Less than number.
19103
19104 @item =
19105 Equal to number.
19106
19107 @item >
19108 Greater than number.
19109 @end table
19110 @end table
19111
19112 @item
19113 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19114 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19115 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19116 file.
19117 @table @kbd
19118
19119 @item t
19120 Temporary score entry.
19121
19122 @item p
19123 Permanent score entry.
19124
19125 @item i
19126 Immediately scoring.
19127 @end table
19128
19129 @item
19130 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19131 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19132 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19133
19134 @end enumerate
19135
19136 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19137 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19138 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19139 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19140
19141 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19142 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19143 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19144 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19145 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19146
19147 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19148 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19149 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19150 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19151 current score file.
19152
19153 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19154 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19155 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19156
19157
19158 @node Group Score Commands
19159 @section Group Score Commands
19160 @cindex group score commands
19161
19162 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19163
19164 @table @kbd
19165
19166 @item W f
19167 @kindex W f (Group)
19168 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19169 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19170 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19171 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19172
19173 @end table
19174
19175 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19176
19177 @findex gnus-batch-score
19178 @cindex batch scoring
19179 @example
19180 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19181 @end example
19182
19183
19184 @node Score Variables
19185 @section Score Variables
19186 @cindex score variables
19187
19188 @table @code
19189
19190 @item gnus-use-scoring
19191 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19192 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19193 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19194
19195 @item gnus-kill-killed
19196 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19197 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19198 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19199 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19200 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19201 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19202 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19203
19204 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19205 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19206 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19207 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19208 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19209
19210 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19211 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19212 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19213 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19214
19215 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19216 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19217 @cindex score cache
19218 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19219 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
19220 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19221 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19222 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19223 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19224 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19225 be cached.
19226
19227 @item gnus-save-score
19228 @vindex gnus-save-score
19229 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19230 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19231 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19232
19233 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19234 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19235 across group visits.
19236
19237 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19238 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19239 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19240 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19241 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19242 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19243 manually entered data.
19244
19245 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19246 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19247 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19248
19249 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19250 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19251 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19252 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19253 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19254 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19255
19256 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19257 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19258 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19259 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19260
19261 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19262 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19263 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19264 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19265
19266 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19267 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19268 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19269 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19270
19271 Predefined functions available are:
19272 @table @code
19273
19274 @item gnus-score-find-single
19275 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19276 Only apply the group's own score file.
19277
19278 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19279 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19280 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19281 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19282 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19283 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19284 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19285 then a regexp match is done.
19286
19287 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19288 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19289
19290 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19291 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19292 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19293 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19294
19295 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19296 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19297 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19298 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19299 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19300 server.
19301
19302 @end table
19303 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19304 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19305 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19306 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19307 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19308 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19309 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19310 Phu.
19311
19312 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19313 overall score file, you could use the value
19314 @example
19315 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19316 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19317 @end example
19318
19319 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19320 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19321 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19322 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19323 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19324
19325 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19326 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19327 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19328 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19329 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19330 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19331 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19332 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19333
19334 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19335 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19336 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19337
19338 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19339 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19340 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19341 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19342 threading---according to the current value of
19343 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19344 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19345 simplified in this manner.
19346
19347 @end table
19348
19349
19350 @node Score File Format
19351 @section Score File Format
19352 @cindex score file format
19353
19354 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19355 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19356 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19357
19358 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19359
19360 @lisp
19361 (("from"
19362 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19363 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19364 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19365 ("subject"
19366 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19367 ("xref"
19368 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19369 ("lines"
19370 (2 -100 nil <))
19371 (mark 0)
19372 (expunge -1000)
19373 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19374 (read-only nil)
19375 (orphan -10)
19376 (adapt t)
19377 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19378 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19379 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19380 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19381 (eval (ding)))
19382 @end lisp
19383
19384 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19385 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19386
19387 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19388 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19389 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19390
19391 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19392
19393 @table @code
19394
19395 @item STRING
19396 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19397 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19398 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19399 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19400 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19401 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19402 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19403 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19404 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19405 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19406 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19407 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19408 to articles that matches these score entries.
19409
19410 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19411 score entry has one to four elements.
19412 @enumerate
19413
19414 @item
19415 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19416 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19417 integer.
19418
19419 @item
19420 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19421 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19422 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19423 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19424 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19425 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19426
19427 @item
19428 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19429 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19430 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19431 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19432 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19433
19434 @item
19435 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19436 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19437 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19438 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19439 @table @dfn
19440
19441 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19442 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19443 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19444 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19445 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19446 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19447 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19448 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19449 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19450 instead, if you feel like.
19451
19452 @item Extra
19453 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19454 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19455 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19456 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19457 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19458 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19459 overviews:
19460
19461 @lisp
19462 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19463 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19464 @end lisp
19465
19466 @item Lines, Chars
19467 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19468 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19469
19470 These predicates are true if
19471
19472 @example
19473 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19474 @end example
19475
19476 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19477 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19478 following form:
19479
19480 @lisp
19481 (< header-value 4)
19482 @end lisp
19483
19484 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19485 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19486 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19487 it's not. I think.)
19488
19489 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19490 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19491 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19492 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19493
19494 @item Date
19495 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19496 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19497 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19498 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19499 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19500 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19501 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19502
19503 @cindex ISO8601
19504 @cindex date
19505 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19506 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19507 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
19508 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
19509 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
19510 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
19511 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
19512 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
19513 whole family, eh?)
19514
19515 @item Head, Body, All
19516 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
19517 header uses.
19518
19519 @item Followup
19520 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
19521 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
19522 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
19523 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
19524 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
19525 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
19526 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
19527 files.)
19528
19529 @item Thread
19530 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
19531 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
19532 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
19533 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
19534 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
19535 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
19536 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
19537 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
19538 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
19539 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
19540 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
19541 @end table
19542 @end enumerate
19543
19544 @cindex score file atoms
19545 @item mark
19546 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19547 lower than this number will be marked as read.
19548
19549 @item expunge
19550 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19551 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
19552
19553 @item mark-and-expunge
19554 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19555 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
19556 summary buffer.
19557
19558 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
19559 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
19560 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
19561 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
19562 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
19563
19564 @item files
19565 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
19566 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
19567 this one was.
19568
19569 @item exclude-files
19570 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
19571 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
19572 other.
19573
19574 @item eval
19575 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
19576 ignored when handling global score files.
19577
19578 @item read-only
19579 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
19580 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
19581 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
19582 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
19583
19584 @item orphan
19585 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
19586 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
19587 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
19588 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
19589
19590 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
19591
19592 @example
19593 (orphan -500)
19594 (mark-and-expunge -100)
19595 @end example
19596
19597 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
19598 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
19599 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
19600 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
19601 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
19602
19603 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
19604 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
19605 scoring rules exist.
19606
19607 @item adapt
19608 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
19609 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
19610 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
19611 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
19612 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
19613 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
19614 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19615 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
19616 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
19617 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
19618 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
19619 it.
19620
19621 @item adapt-file
19622 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
19623 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
19624 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
19625 file for a number of groups.
19626
19627 @item local
19628 @cindex local variables
19629 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
19630 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
19631 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
19632 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
19633 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
19634 be evaluated.
19635 @end table
19636
19637
19638 @node Score File Editing
19639 @section Score File Editing
19640
19641 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
19642 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
19643 with a mode for that.
19644
19645 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
19646 additional commands:
19647
19648 @table @kbd
19649
19650 @item C-c C-c
19651 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
19652 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
19653 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
19654 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
19655
19656 @item C-c C-d
19657 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
19658 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
19659 Insert the current date in numerical format
19660 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
19661 you were wondering.
19662
19663 @item C-c C-p
19664 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
19665 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
19666 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
19667 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
19668 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
19669 you.
19670
19671 @end table
19672
19673 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
19674
19675 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
19676 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
19677
19678 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
19679 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
19680
19681
19682 @node Adaptive Scoring
19683 @section Adaptive Scoring
19684 @cindex adaptive scoring
19685
19686 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
19687 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
19688 stupidity, to be precise.
19689
19690 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
19691 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
19692 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
19693 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
19694 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19695 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
19696 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
19697 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
19698 variable to @code{(word line)}.
19699
19700 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19701 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
19702 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
19703 might look something like this:
19704
19705 @lisp
19706 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19707 '((gnus-unread-mark)
19708 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
19709 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
19710 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
19711 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
19712 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
19713 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
19714 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
19715 (gnus-ancient-mark)
19716 (gnus-low-score-mark)
19717 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
19718 @end lisp
19719
19720 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
19721 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
19722 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
19723 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
19724 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
19725 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
19726 entries.
19727
19728 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
19729 will be applied to each article.
19730
19731 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
19732 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
19733 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
19734 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
19735
19736 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
19737 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
19738 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
19739 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
19740
19741 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
19742 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
19743 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
19744 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
19745
19746 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
19747 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
19748 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
19749 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
19750 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
19751 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
19752
19753 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
19754 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
19755 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
19756
19757 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
19758 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
19759 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
19760
19761 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
19762 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
19763 let you use different rules in different groups.
19764
19765 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
19766 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
19767 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
19768 is @file{ADAPT}.
19769
19770 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
19771 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
19772 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
19773 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
19774 the length of the match is less than
19775 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
19776 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
19777 this problem.
19778
19779 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19780 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
19781 headers. If you adapt on words, the
19782 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
19783 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
19784
19785 @lisp
19786 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19787 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
19788 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
19789 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
19790 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
19791 @end lisp
19792
19793 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
19794 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
19795 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
19796 score with 30 points.
19797
19798 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
19799 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
19800 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
19801 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
19802 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
19803
19804 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
19805 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
19806 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
19807 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
19808 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
19809
19810 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
19811 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
19812 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
19813 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
19814
19815 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
19816 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
19817 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
19818 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
19819
19820 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
19821 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
19822 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
19823 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
19824 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
19825
19826 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
19827 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
19828 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
19829
19830 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
19831 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
19832 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
19833 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
19834
19835
19836 @node Home Score File
19837 @section Home Score File
19838
19839 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
19840 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
19841 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
19842 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
19843
19844 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
19845 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
19846 could perhaps use the same home score file.
19847
19848 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
19849 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
19850 be:
19851
19852 @enumerate
19853 @item
19854 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
19855 groups.
19856
19857 @item
19858 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
19859 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
19860 parameter.
19861
19862 @item
19863 A list. The elements in this list can be:
19864
19865 @enumerate
19866 @item
19867 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
19868 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
19869
19870 @item
19871 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
19872 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
19873 name of the group as the parameter.
19874
19875 @item
19876 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
19877 @end enumerate
19878
19879 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
19880 for matches.
19881
19882 @end enumerate
19883
19884 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
19885
19886 @lisp
19887 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19888 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
19889 @end lisp
19890
19891 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
19892 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
19893
19894 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
19895 @lisp
19896 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19897 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
19898 @end lisp
19899
19900 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
19901 Other functions include
19902
19903 @table @code
19904 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
19905 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
19906 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
19907 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
19908
19909 @end table
19910
19911 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
19912 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
19913 their own home score files:
19914
19915 @lisp
19916 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19917 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
19918 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
19919 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
19920 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
19921 @end lisp
19922
19923 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
19924 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
19925 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
19926 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
19927 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
19928
19929 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
19930 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
19931 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
19932 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
19933 precedence over this variable.
19934
19935
19936 @node Followups To Yourself
19937 @section Followups To Yourself
19938
19939 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
19940 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
19941 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
19942 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
19943 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
19944 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
19945
19946 @table @code
19947
19948 @item gnus-score-followup-article
19949 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
19950 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
19951 article.
19952
19953 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
19954 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
19955 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
19956 your own article.
19957 @end table
19958
19959 @vindex message-sent-hook
19960 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
19961 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
19962 @lisp
19963 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
19964 @end lisp
19965
19966
19967 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
19968 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
19969 mine:
19970
19971 @example
19972 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
19973 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
19974 @end example
19975
19976 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
19977 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
19978 myself:
19979
19980 @lisp
19981 ("references"
19982 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
19983 1000 nil r))
19984 @end lisp
19985
19986 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
19987 is system-dependent.
19988
19989
19990 @node Scoring On Other Headers
19991 @section Scoring On Other Headers
19992 @cindex scoring on other headers
19993
19994 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
19995 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
19996 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
19997 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
19998 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
19999
20000 Now, there's not much you can do about this for news groups, but for
20001 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20002 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20003 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20004 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20005
20006 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20007
20008 @lisp
20009 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20010 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20011 @end lisp
20012
20013 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20014 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20015 time if you have much mail.
20016
20017 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20018 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20019
20020 See? Simple.
20021
20022
20023 @node Scoring Tips
20024 @section Scoring Tips
20025 @cindex scoring tips
20026
20027 @table @dfn
20028
20029 @item Crossposts
20030 @cindex crossposts
20031 @cindex scoring crossposts
20032 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20033 the @code{Xref} header.
20034 @lisp
20035 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20036 @end lisp
20037
20038 @item Multiple crossposts
20039 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20040 more than, say, 3 groups:
20041 @lisp
20042 ("xref"
20043 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20044 -1000 nil r))
20045 @end lisp
20046
20047 @item Matching on the body
20048 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20049 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20050 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20051 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20052 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20053 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20054 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20055 the matches.
20056
20057 @item Marking as read
20058 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20059 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20060 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20061 @lisp
20062 ((mark -100))
20063 @end lisp
20064 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20065
20066 @item Negated character classes
20067 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20068 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20069 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20070 @end table
20071
20072
20073 @node Reverse Scoring
20074 @section Reverse Scoring
20075 @cindex reverse scoring
20076
20077 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20078 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20079 like this in your score file:
20080
20081 @lisp
20082 (("subject"
20083 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20084 (mark 1)
20085 (expunge 1))
20086 @end lisp
20087
20088 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20089 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20090
20091
20092 @node Global Score Files
20093 @section Global Score Files
20094 @cindex global score files
20095
20096 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20097 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20098 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20099
20100 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20101 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20102 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20103
20104 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20105 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20106 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20107 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20108 files are applicable to which group.
20109
20110 To use the score file
20111 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20112 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20113 say this:
20114
20115 @lisp
20116 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20117 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20118 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20119 @end lisp
20120
20121 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20122 @noindent
20123 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20124 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20125 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20126 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20127
20128 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20129 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20130
20131 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20132 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20133 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20134 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20135 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20136 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20137
20138 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20139 head:
20140
20141 @itemize @bullet
20142
20143 @item
20144 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20145 @item
20146 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20147 @item
20148 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20149 @item
20150 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20151 lowered out of existence.
20152 @item
20153 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20154 articles completely.
20155
20156 @item
20157 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20158 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20159 old articles for a long time.
20160 @end itemize
20161
20162 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20163 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20164 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20165 holding our breath yet?
20166
20167
20168 @node Kill Files
20169 @section Kill Files
20170 @cindex kill files
20171
20172 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20173 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20174 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20175
20176 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20177 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20178 files into score files.
20179
20180 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20181 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20182 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20183 that isn't a very good idea.
20184
20185 Normal kill files look like this:
20186
20187 @lisp
20188 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20189 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20190 (gnus-expunge "X")
20191 @end lisp
20192
20193 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20194 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20195
20196 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20197 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20198 interpreting it.
20199
20200 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20201
20202 @table @kbd
20203
20204 @item M-k
20205 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20206 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20207 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20208
20209 @item M-K
20210 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20211 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20212 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20213 @end table
20214
20215 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20216
20217 @table @kbd
20218
20219 @item M-k
20220 @kindex M-k (Group)
20221 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20222 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20223
20224 @item M-K
20225 @kindex M-K (Group)
20226 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20227 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20228 @end table
20229
20230 Kill file variables:
20231
20232 @table @code
20233 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20234 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20235 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20236 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20237 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20238 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20239 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20240
20241 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20242 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20243 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20244 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20245 kills.
20246
20247 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20248 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20249 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20250 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20251 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20252 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20253 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20254 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20255 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20256
20257 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20258 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20259 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20260
20261 @end table
20262
20263
20264 @node Converting Kill Files
20265 @section Converting Kill Files
20266 @cindex kill files
20267 @cindex converting kill files
20268
20269 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20270 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20271 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20272 by hand.
20273
20274 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
20275 You can fetch it from
20276 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20277
20278 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20279 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20280 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20281 before.
20282
20283
20284 @node GroupLens
20285 @section GroupLens
20286 @cindex GroupLens
20287
20288 @sc{Note:} Unfortunately the GroupLens system seems to have shut down,
20289 so this section is mostly of historical interest.
20290
20291 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/, GroupLens} is a
20292 collaborative filtering system that helps you work together with other
20293 people to find the quality news articles out of the huge volume of
20294 news articles generated every day.
20295
20296 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
20297 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
20298 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
20299 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
20300 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
20301 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
20302 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
20303 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
20304 article.
20305
20306 @menu
20307 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
20308 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
20309 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
20310 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
20311 @end menu
20312
20313
20314 @node Using GroupLens
20315 @subsection Using GroupLens
20316
20317 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local
20318 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html, Better Bit
20319 Bureau (BBB)} is the only better bit in town at the moment.
20320
20321 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
20322
20323 @table @code
20324
20325 @item gnus-use-grouplens
20326 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
20327 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
20328 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
20329
20330 @item grouplens-pseudonym
20331 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
20332 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
20333 with the Better Bit Bureau.
20334
20335 @item grouplens-newsgroups
20336 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
20337 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
20338
20339 @end table
20340
20341 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
20342 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
20343 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
20344 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
20345 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
20346 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
20347
20348
20349 @node Rating Articles
20350 @subsection Rating Articles
20351
20352 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
20353 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
20354 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
20355 yourself is, ``on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
20356 like this one?''
20357
20358 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
20359
20360 @table @kbd
20361
20362 @item r
20363 @kindex r (GroupLens)
20364 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
20365 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
20366
20367 @item k
20368 @kindex k (GroupLens)
20369 @findex grouplens-score-thread
20370 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
20371 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
20372 threads in rec.humor.
20373
20374 @end table
20375
20376 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
20377 the score of the article you're reading.
20378
20379 @table @kbd
20380
20381 @item 1-5 n
20382 @kindex n (GroupLens)
20383 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
20384 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
20385
20386 @item 1-5 ,
20387 @kindex , (GroupLens)
20388 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
20389 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
20390
20391 @end table
20392
20393 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
20394 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
20395
20396
20397 @node Displaying Predictions
20398 @subsection Displaying Predictions
20399
20400 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
20401 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
20402 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
20403 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
20404 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
20405
20406 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
20407 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
20408 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
20409 regular Gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
20410 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
20411 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
20412 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
20413 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
20414 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
20415 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
20416 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
20417 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
20418 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
20419
20420 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
20421 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
20422 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
20423 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
20424
20425 The following are valid values for that variable.
20426
20427 @table @code
20428 @item prediction-spot
20429 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
20430 displayed.
20431
20432 @item confidence-interval
20433 A numeric confidence interval.
20434
20435 @item prediction-bar
20436 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
20437
20438 @item confidence-bar
20439 Numerical confidence.
20440
20441 @item confidence-spot
20442 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
20443
20444 @item prediction-num
20445 Plain-old numeric value.
20446
20447 @item confidence-plus-minus
20448 Prediction +/- confidence.
20449
20450 @end table
20451
20452
20453 @node GroupLens Variables
20454 @subsection GroupLens Variables
20455
20456 @table @code
20457
20458 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
20459 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
20460 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
20461 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23n%]%)
20462 %s\n}.
20463
20464 @item grouplens-bbb-host
20465 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
20466 default.
20467
20468 @item grouplens-bbb-port
20469 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
20470
20471 @item grouplens-score-offset
20472 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
20473 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
20474 default is 0.
20475
20476 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
20477 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
20478 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
20479
20480 @end table
20481
20482
20483 @node Advanced Scoring
20484 @section Advanced Scoring
20485
20486 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20487 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20488 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20489 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20490 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20491
20492 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20493 scoring patterns.
20494
20495 @menu
20496 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20497 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20498 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20499 @end menu
20500
20501
20502 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20503 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20504
20505 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20506 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20507 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20508 non-@code{nil} value.
20509
20510 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20511 operator, and various match operators.
20512
20513 Logical operators:
20514
20515 @table @code
20516 @item &
20517 @itemx and
20518 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20519 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20520 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20521 @code{true}.
20522
20523 @item |
20524 @itemx or
20525 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20526 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20527 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20528
20529 @item !
20530 @itemx not
20531 @itemx ¬
20532 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20533 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20534
20535 @end table
20536
20537 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20538 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20539 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20540 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20541 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20542 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20543 the ancestry you want to go.
20544
20545 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20546 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20547 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20548 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20549 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20550
20551
20552 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20553 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20554
20555 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20556 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20557 of parentheses.
20558
20559 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20560 when he's talking about Gnus:
20561
20562 @example
20563 @group
20564 ((&
20565 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20566 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20567 1000)
20568 @end group
20569 @end example
20570
20571 Quite simple, huh?
20572
20573 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20574
20575 @example
20576 ((&
20577 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20578 (|
20579 ("subject" "Gnus")
20580 ("lines" 100 >)))
20581 1000)
20582 @end example
20583
20584 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20585 really don't want to read what he's written:
20586
20587 @example
20588 ((&
20589 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20590 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigir Logge")))
20591 -100000)
20592 @end example
20593
20594 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20595 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20596 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20597 very interesting:
20598
20599 @example
20600 ((&
20601 (1-
20602 (&
20603 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20604 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20605 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20606 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20607 1000)
20608 @end example
20609
20610 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20611 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20612 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20613 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20614
20615 @example
20616 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20617 -200)
20618 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20619 200)
20620 @end example
20621
20622 The possibilities are endless.
20623
20624 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20625 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20626
20627 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20628 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20629 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20630 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20631 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20632 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20633 @samp{subject}) first.
20634
20635 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20636 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20637 something like:
20638
20639 @example
20640 ...
20641 (1-
20642 (1-
20643 ("from" "lars")))
20644 ...
20645 @end example
20646
20647 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20648 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20649
20650 @example
20651 (1-
20652 (&
20653 ("from" "Lars")
20654 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20655 @end example
20656
20657 than it is to say:
20658
20659 @example
20660 (&
20661 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20662 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20663 @end example
20664
20665
20666 @node Score Decays
20667 @section Score Decays
20668 @cindex score decays
20669 @cindex decays
20670
20671 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20672 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20673 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20674 use them in any sensible way.
20675
20676 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20677 @findex gnus-decay-score
20678 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20679 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20680 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20681 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20682 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20683 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
20684 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
20685 definition of that function:
20686
20687 @lisp
20688 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20689 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20690 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
20691 (let ((n (- score
20692 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
20693 (min (abs score)
20694 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
20695 (* (abs score)
20696 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
20697 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
20698 ;; XEmacs' floor can handle only the floating point
20699 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
20700 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
20701 (string-to-number
20702 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
20703 (floor n))))
20704 @end lisp
20705
20706 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
20707 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
20708 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
20709 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
20710
20711 @enumerate
20712 @item
20713 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
20714
20715 @item
20716 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
20717
20718 @item
20719 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
20720 score.
20721 @end enumerate
20722
20723 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
20724 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
20725 the new score, which should be an integer.
20726
20727 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
20728 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
20729
20730 @iftex
20731 @iflatex
20732 @chapter Message
20733 @include message.texi
20734 @chapter Emacs MIME
20735 @include emacs-mime.texi
20736 @chapter Sieve
20737 @include sieve.texi
20738 @chapter PGG
20739 @include pgg.texi
20740 @end iflatex
20741 @end iftex
20742
20743 @node Various
20744 @chapter Various
20745
20746 @menu
20747 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
20748 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
20749 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
20750 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
20751 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
20752 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
20753 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
20754 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
20755 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
20756 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
20757 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
20758 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
20759 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
20760 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
20761 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
20762 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
20763 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
20764 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
20765 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
20766 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
20767 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
20768 @end menu
20769
20770
20771 @node Process/Prefix
20772 @section Process/Prefix
20773 @cindex process/prefix convention
20774
20775 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
20776 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
20777
20778 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
20779 command to be performed on.
20780
20781 It goes like this:
20782
20783 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
20784 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
20785 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
20786 with the current one.
20787
20788 @vindex transient-mark-mode
20789 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
20790 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
20791
20792 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
20793 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
20794 the process mark.
20795
20796 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
20797 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
20798
20799 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
20800 are avoided.
20801
20802 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
20803 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
20804 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
20805 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
20806
20807 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
20808 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
20809 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
20810 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
20811 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
20812 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
20813 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
20814 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
20815
20816 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
20817 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
20818 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
20819 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
20820 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
20821
20822
20823 @node Interactive
20824 @section Interactive
20825 @cindex interaction
20826
20827 @table @code
20828
20829 @item gnus-novice-user
20830 @vindex gnus-novice-user
20831 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
20832 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
20833 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
20834 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
20835 default.
20836
20837 @item gnus-expert-user
20838 @vindex gnus-expert-user
20839 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
20840 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
20841 matter how strange.
20842
20843 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
20844 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
20845 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
20846 is @code{t} by default.
20847
20848 @item gnus-interactive-exit
20849 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
20850 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
20851 default.
20852 @end table
20853
20854
20855 @node Symbolic Prefixes
20856 @section Symbolic Prefixes
20857 @cindex symbolic prefixes
20858
20859 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
20860 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
20861 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
20862 rule of 900 to the current article.
20863
20864 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
20865 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
20866 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
20867 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
20868 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
20869 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
20870 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
20871
20872 @kindex M-i (Summary)
20873 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
20874 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
20875 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
20876 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
20877 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
20878 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
20879 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
20880 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
20881
20882 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
20883 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
20884 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
20885
20886 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
20887 Interactive}.
20888
20889
20890 @node Formatting Variables
20891 @section Formatting Variables
20892 @cindex formatting variables
20893
20894 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
20895 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
20896 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
20897 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
20898 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
20899 be annoyed by.
20900
20901 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
20902 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
20903 lots of percentages everywhere.
20904
20905 @menu
20906 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
20907 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
20908 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
20909 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
20910 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
20911 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
20912 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
20913 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
20914 @end menu
20915
20916 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
20917 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
20918 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
20919 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
20920 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
20921 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
20922 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
20923 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
20924
20925 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
20926 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
20927
20928 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
20929 @findex gnus-update-format
20930 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
20931 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
20932 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
20933 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
20934
20935
20936
20937 @node Formatting Basics
20938 @subsection Formatting Basics
20939
20940 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
20941 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
20942 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
20943
20944 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
20945 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
20946 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
20947 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
20948 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
20949 the right instead.
20950
20951 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
20952 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
20953 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
20954 less than 4 characters wide.
20955
20956 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
20957 @samp{%&user-date;}.
20958
20959
20960 @node Mode Line Formatting
20961 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
20962
20963 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
20964 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
20965 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
20966 with the following two differences:
20967
20968 @enumerate
20969
20970 @item
20971 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
20972
20973 @item
20974 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
20975 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
20976 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
20977 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
20978 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
20979 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
20980 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
20981
20982 @end enumerate
20983
20984
20985 @node Advanced Formatting
20986 @subsection Advanced Formatting
20987
20988 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
20989 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
20990 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
20991 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
20992
20993 These are the valid modifiers:
20994
20995 @table @code
20996 @item pad
20997 @itemx pad-left
20998 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
20999 length.
21000
21001 @item pad-right
21002 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
21003 length.
21004
21005 @item max
21006 @itemx max-left
21007 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
21008
21009 @item max-right
21010 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
21011 length.
21012
21013 @item cut
21014 @itemx cut-left
21015 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
21016
21017 @item cut-right
21018 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
21019
21020 @item ignore
21021 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
21022
21023 @item form
21024 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
21025 used.
21026
21027 Here's an example:
21028
21029 @lisp
21030 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
21031 @end lisp
21032
21033 @end table
21034
21035 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
21036 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
21037 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
21038 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
21039 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
21040 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
21041 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
21042
21043 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
21044 last operation, padding.
21045
21046 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
21047 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
21048 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
21049 @xref{Compilation}.
21050
21051
21052 @node User-Defined Specs
21053 @subsection User-Defined Specs
21054
21055 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
21056 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
21057 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
21058 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
21059 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
21060 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
21061 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
21062 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
21063 should protect against that.
21064
21065 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
21066 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
21067
21068 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
21069 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
21070 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
21071 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
21072 inserted.
21073
21074
21075 @node Formatting Fonts
21076 @subsection Formatting Fonts
21077
21078 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
21079 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
21080 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
21081 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
21082 over it.
21083
21084 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
21085 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
21086 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
21087 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
21088 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
21089 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
21090
21091 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
21092 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
21093 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
21094 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
21095 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
21096 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
21097 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
21098 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
21099 (in GNU Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
21100 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
21101 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
21102 paragraph.)
21103
21104 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
21105
21106 @lisp
21107 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
21108 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
21109 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
21110
21111 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
21112 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
21113 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
21114 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
21115 ;; @r{Set the color.}
21116 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
21117 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
21118
21119 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
21120 (setq gnus-group-line-format
21121 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
21122 @end lisp
21123
21124 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
21125 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
21126
21127 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
21128 mode-line variables.
21129
21130 @node Positioning Point
21131 @subsection Positioning Point
21132
21133 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
21134 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
21135 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
21136
21137 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
21138
21139 @findex gnus-goto-colon
21140 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
21141 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
21142
21143 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
21144 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
21145 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
21146 place point there.
21147
21148
21149 @node Tabulation
21150 @subsection Tabulation
21151
21152 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
21153 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
21154 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
21155 about lining up the following text afterwards.
21156
21157 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
21158 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
21159
21160 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21161 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
21162 This is the soft tabulator.
21163
21164 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21165 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
21166 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
21167
21168
21169 @node Wide Characters
21170 @subsection Wide Characters
21171
21172 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
21173 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
21174 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
21175
21176 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
21177 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
21178 these countries, that's not true.
21179
21180 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
21181 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
21182 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
21183 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
21184 for Emacs.
21185
21186
21187 @node Window Layout
21188 @section Window Layout
21189 @cindex window layout
21190
21191 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
21192
21193 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
21194 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
21195 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
21196 @code{t} by default.
21197
21198 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
21199 glitches. Use at your own peril.
21200
21201 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
21202 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
21203 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
21204
21205 @lisp
21206 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
21207 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
21208 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21209 (article 1.0))))
21210 @end lisp
21211
21212 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
21213 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
21214 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
21215 possible names is listed below.
21216
21217 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
21218 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
21219
21220 @lisp
21221 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21222 (article 1.0)))
21223 @end lisp
21224
21225 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
21226 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
21227 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
21228 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
21229 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
21230 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
21231 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
21232 size spec per split.
21233
21234 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
21235 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
21236 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
21237 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
21238 present) gets focus.
21239
21240 Here's a more complicated example:
21241
21242 @lisp
21243 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
21244 (summary 0.25 point)
21245 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
21246 (article 1.0)))
21247 @end lisp
21248
21249 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
21250 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
21251 occupy, not a percentage.
21252
21253 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
21254 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
21255 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
21256 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
21257 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
21258 is non-@code{nil}.
21259
21260 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
21261
21262 @lisp
21263 (article (horizontal 1.0
21264 (vertical 0.5
21265 (group 1.0)
21266 (gnus-carpal 4))
21267 (vertical 1.0
21268 (summary 0.25 point)
21269 (summary-carpal 4)
21270 (article 1.0))))
21271 @end lisp
21272
21273 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
21274 @code{horizontal} thingie?
21275
21276 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
21277 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
21278 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
21279 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
21280 the screen is to be given to this strip.
21281
21282 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
21283 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
21284 lines from the splits.
21285
21286 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
21287 may look like:
21288
21289 @example
21290 @group
21291 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
21292 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
21293 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
21294 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
21295 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
21296 size = number | frame-params
21297 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
21298 @end group
21299 @end example
21300
21301 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
21302 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
21303 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
21304 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
21305
21306 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
21307 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
21308 @cindex window height
21309 @cindex window width
21310 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
21311 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
21312 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
21313 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
21314 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
21315 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
21316
21317 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
21318 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
21319 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
21320 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
21321
21322 @findex gnus-configure-frame
21323 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
21324 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
21325 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
21326 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
21327 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
21328 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
21329 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
21330 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
21331 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
21332 configuration list.
21333
21334 @lisp
21335 (gnus-configure-frame
21336 '(horizontal 1.0
21337 (vertical 10
21338 (group 1.0)
21339 (article 0.3 point))
21340 (vertical 1.0
21341 (article 1.0)
21342 (horizontal 4
21343 (group 1.0)
21344 (article 10)))))
21345 @end lisp
21346
21347 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
21348 @code{frame} split:
21349
21350 @lisp
21351 (gnus-configure-frame
21352 '(frame 1.0
21353 (vertical 1.0
21354 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
21355 (article 1.0))
21356 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
21357 (user-position . t)
21358 (left . -1) (top . 1))
21359 (picon 1.0))))
21360
21361 @end lisp
21362
21363 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
21364 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
21365 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
21366 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
21367 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
21368 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
21369 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
21370 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
21371 is such a plist.
21372 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
21373 be found in its default value.
21374
21375 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
21376 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
21377 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
21378 might be used:
21379
21380 @lisp
21381 (message (horizontal 1.0
21382 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
21383 (vertical 0.24
21384 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
21385 '(summary 0.5))
21386 (group 1.0))))
21387 @end lisp
21388
21389 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
21390 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
21391 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
21392
21393 @lisp
21394 (message
21395 (frame 1.0
21396 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
21397 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
21398 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
21399 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
21400 (name . "Message"))
21401 (message 1.0 point))))
21402 @end lisp
21403
21404 @findex gnus-add-configuration
21405 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
21406 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
21407 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
21408 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
21409
21410 @lisp
21411 (gnus-add-configuration
21412 '(article (vertical 1.0
21413 (group 4)
21414 (summary .25 point)
21415 (article 1.0))))
21416 @end lisp
21417
21418 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
21419 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
21420 Gnus has been loaded.
21421
21422 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
21423 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
21424 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
21425 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
21426 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
21427
21428 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
21429 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
21430 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
21431 windows resized.
21432
21433 @subsection Example Window Configurations
21434
21435 @itemize @bullet
21436 @item
21437 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
21438 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
21439
21440 @ifinfo
21441 @example
21442 +---+---------+
21443 | G | Summary |
21444 | r +---------+
21445 | o | |
21446 | u | Article |
21447 | p | |
21448 +---+---------+
21449 @end example
21450 @end ifinfo
21451
21452 @lisp
21453 (gnus-add-configuration
21454 '(article
21455 (horizontal 1.0
21456 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21457 (vertical 1.0
21458 (summary 0.16 point)
21459 (article 1.0)))))
21460
21461 (gnus-add-configuration
21462 '(summary
21463 (horizontal 1.0
21464 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21465 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
21466 @end lisp
21467
21468 @end itemize
21469
21470
21471 @node Faces and Fonts
21472 @section Faces and Fonts
21473 @cindex faces
21474 @cindex fonts
21475 @cindex colors
21476
21477 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
21478 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
21479 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
21480 interface.
21481
21482
21483 @node Compilation
21484 @section Compilation
21485 @cindex compilation
21486 @cindex byte-compilation
21487
21488 @findex gnus-compile
21489
21490 Remember all those line format specification variables?
21491 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
21492 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
21493 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
21494 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
21495 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
21496 course.)
21497
21498 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
21499 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
21500 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
21501 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
21502 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
21503 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
21504 them into the @file{~/.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
21505
21506
21507 @node Mode Lines
21508 @section Mode Lines
21509 @cindex mode lines
21510
21511 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
21512 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
21513 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
21514 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
21515 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
21516 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
21517 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
21518 quicker.
21519
21520 @cindex display-time
21521
21522 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
21523 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
21524 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
21525 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
21526 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
21527 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
21528 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
21529 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
21530 this variable:
21531
21532 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
21533 @lisp
21534 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
21535 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
21536 (+ 21
21537 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
21538 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
21539 (length display-time-string)))))
21540 @end lisp
21541
21542 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
21543 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
21544 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
21545 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
21546 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
21547
21548
21549 @node Highlighting and Menus
21550 @section Highlighting and Menus
21551 @cindex visual
21552 @cindex highlighting
21553 @cindex menus
21554
21555 @vindex gnus-visual
21556 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
21557 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
21558 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
21559 file.
21560
21561 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
21562 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
21563
21564 @table @code
21565 @item group-highlight
21566 Do highlights in the group buffer.
21567 @item summary-highlight
21568 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
21569 @item article-highlight
21570 Do highlights in the article buffer.
21571 @item highlight
21572 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
21573 @item group-menu
21574 Create menus in the group buffer.
21575 @item summary-menu
21576 Create menus in the summary buffers.
21577 @item article-menu
21578 Create menus in the article buffer.
21579 @item browse-menu
21580 Create menus in the browse buffer.
21581 @item server-menu
21582 Create menus in the server buffer.
21583 @item score-menu
21584 Create menus in the score buffers.
21585 @item menu
21586 Create menus in all buffers.
21587 @end table
21588
21589 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
21590 buffers, you could say something like:
21591
21592 @lisp
21593 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
21594 @end lisp
21595
21596 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
21597
21598 @lisp
21599 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
21600 @end lisp
21601
21602 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
21603 in all Gnus buffers.
21604
21605 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
21606
21607 @table @code
21608 @item gnus-mouse-face
21609 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
21610 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
21611 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
21612
21613 @end table
21614
21615 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
21616
21617 @table @code
21618
21619 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
21620 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
21621 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
21622
21623 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
21624 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
21625 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
21626
21627 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
21628 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
21629 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
21630
21631 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
21632 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
21633 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
21634
21635 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
21636 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
21637 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
21638
21639 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
21640 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
21641 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
21642
21643 @end table
21644
21645
21646 @node Buttons
21647 @section Buttons
21648 @cindex buttons
21649 @cindex mouse
21650 @cindex click
21651
21652 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
21653 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
21654 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
21655 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
21656 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
21657
21658 Right.
21659
21660 @vindex gnus-carpal
21661 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
21662 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
21663 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
21664
21665
21666 @table @code
21667
21668 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21669 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21670 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
21671
21672 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
21673 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
21674 Face used on buttons.
21675
21676 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
21677 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
21678 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
21679
21680 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21681 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21682 Buttons in the group buffer.
21683
21684 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21685 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21686 Buttons in the summary buffer.
21687
21688 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21689 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21690 Buttons in the server buffer.
21691
21692 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21693 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21694 Buttons in the browse buffer.
21695 @end table
21696
21697 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
21698 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
21699 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
21700
21701
21702 @node Daemons
21703 @section Daemons
21704 @cindex demons
21705 @cindex daemons
21706
21707 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
21708 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
21709 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
21710 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
21711 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
21712
21713 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
21714 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
21715 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
21716
21717 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
21718 been idle for thirty minutes:
21719
21720 @lisp
21721 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
21722 @end lisp
21723
21724 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
21725 Emacs is idle:
21726
21727 @lisp
21728 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
21729 @end lisp
21730
21731 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
21732 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
21733 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21734
21735 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
21736 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
21737 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
21738 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21739
21740 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
21741 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
21742 @var{idle} minutes.
21743
21744 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
21745 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
21746 minutes.
21747
21748 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
21749 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
21750 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
21751
21752 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
21753 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
21754 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
21755 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
21756
21757 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
21758 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
21759
21760 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
21761 @lisp
21762 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
21763 @end lisp
21764
21765 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
21766 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
21767 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
21768 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
21769 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
21770 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
21771 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
21772 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
21773 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
21774 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
21775 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
21776
21777 @findex gnus-demon-init
21778 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
21779 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
21780 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
21781 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
21782 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
21783
21784 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
21785 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
21786 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
21787 behave.
21788
21789
21790 @node NoCeM
21791 @section NoCeM
21792 @cindex nocem
21793 @cindex spam
21794
21795 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
21796 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
21797
21798 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
21799 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
21800 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
21801 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
21802 away.
21803
21804 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
21805 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
21806 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
21807 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
21808
21809 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
21810 this will make spam disappear.
21811
21812 There are some variables to customize, of course:
21813
21814 @table @code
21815 @item gnus-use-nocem
21816 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
21817 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
21818 by default.
21819
21820 You can also set this variable to a positive number as a group level.
21821 In that case, Gnus scans NoCeM messages when checking new news if this
21822 value is not exceeding a group level that you specify as the prefix
21823 argument to some commands, e.g. @code{gnus},
21824 @code{gnus-group-get-new-news}, etc. Otherwise, Gnus does not scan
21825 NoCeM messages if you specify a group level to those commands. For
21826 example, if you use 1 or 2 on the mail groups and the levels on the news
21827 groups remain the default, 3 is the best choice.
21828
21829 @item gnus-nocem-groups
21830 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
21831 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
21832 default is
21833 @lisp
21834 ("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
21835 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")
21836 @end lisp
21837
21838 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
21839 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
21840 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
21841 people you want to listen to. The default is
21842 @lisp
21843 ("Automoose-1" "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca"
21844 "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo" "hweede@@snafu.de")
21845 @end lisp
21846 fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
21847
21848 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at@*
21849 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
21850
21851 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
21852 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
21853 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
21854 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
21855 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
21856 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
21857 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
21858 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
21859 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
21860 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
21861
21862 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
21863 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
21864
21865 @lisp
21866 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
21867 @end lisp
21868
21869 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
21870 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
21871
21872 @lisp
21873 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
21874 @end lisp
21875
21876 The specs are applied left-to-right.
21877
21878
21879 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
21880 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
21881 @findex pgg-verify
21882 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
21883 says she is. The default is @code{pgg-verify}, which returns
21884 non-@code{nil} if the verification is successful, otherwise (including
21885 the case the NoCeM message was not signed) returns @code{nil}. If this
21886 is too slow and you don't care for verification (which may be dangerous),
21887 you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
21888
21889 Formerly the default was @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
21890 function. While you can still use it, you can change it into
21891 @code{pgg-verify} running with GnuPG if you are willing to add the
21892 @acronym{PGP} public keys to GnuPG's keyring.
21893
21894 @item gnus-nocem-directory
21895 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
21896 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is@*
21897 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
21898
21899 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21900 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21901 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
21902 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
21903 might then see old spam.
21904
21905 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
21906 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
21907 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
21908 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
21909 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
21910 issuers.
21911
21912 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21913 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21914 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
21915 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
21916
21917 @end table
21918
21919 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
21920 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
21921 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
21922 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
21923
21924
21925 @node Undo
21926 @section Undo
21927 @cindex undo
21928
21929 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
21930 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
21931 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
21932
21933 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
21934 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
21935 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
21936 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
21937 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
21938 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
21939 @code{undo} function.
21940
21941 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
21942 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
21943 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
21944 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
21945 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
21946 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
21947 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
21948 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
21949 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
21950 never be totally undoable.
21951
21952 @findex gnus-undo-mode
21953 @vindex gnus-use-undo
21954 @findex gnus-undo
21955 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
21956 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
21957 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
21958 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
21959 command.
21960
21961
21962 @node Predicate Specifiers
21963 @section Predicate Specifiers
21964 @cindex predicate specifiers
21965
21966 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
21967 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
21968 to type all that much.
21969
21970 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
21971
21972 Here's an example:
21973
21974 @lisp
21975 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
21976 gnus-article-unread-p)
21977 @end lisp
21978
21979 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
21980 functions all take one parameter.
21981
21982 @findex gnus-make-predicate
21983 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
21984 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
21985 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
21986 specifier.
21987
21988
21989 @node Moderation
21990 @section Moderation
21991 @cindex moderation
21992
21993 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
21994 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
21995 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
21996 get a copy.
21997
21998 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
21999 buffers. Put
22000
22001 @lisp
22002 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
22003 @end lisp
22004
22005 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
22006
22007 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
22008 supposed to work:
22009
22010 @enumerate
22011 @item
22012 You split your incoming mail by matching on
22013 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
22014 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
22015
22016 @item
22017 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
22018 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
22019
22020 @item
22021 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
22022 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
22023 @kbd{c} command.
22024 @end enumerate
22025
22026 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
22027
22028 @lisp
22029 (setq gnus-moderated-list
22030 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
22031 @end lisp
22032
22033
22034 @node Fetching a Group
22035 @section Fetching a Group
22036 @cindex fetching a group
22037
22038 @findex gnus-fetch-group
22039 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
22040 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
22041 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
22042 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
22043 It takes the group name as a parameter.
22044
22045
22046 @node Image Enhancements
22047 @section Image Enhancements
22048
22049 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
22050 support images yet.}, is able to display pictures and stuff, so Gnus has
22051 taken advantage of that.
22052
22053 @menu
22054 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
22055 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
22056 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
22057 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
22058 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
22059 @end menu
22060
22061
22062 @node X-Face
22063 @subsection X-Face
22064 @cindex x-face
22065
22066 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
22067 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
22068 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
22069 readers.
22070
22071 @cindex x-face
22072 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
22073 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
22074 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
22075 @iftex
22076 @iflatex
22077 \include{xface}
22078 @end iflatex
22079 @end iftex
22080 @c @anchor{X-Face}
22081
22082 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
22083 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions has), or that you
22084 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
22085 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
22086 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
22087 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
22088 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends. For XEmacs it's faster if
22089 XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The default action
22090 under Emacs without image support is to fork off the @code{display}
22091 program.
22092
22093 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is from the
22094 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
22095 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
22096
22097 The variable that controls this is the
22098 @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} variable. If this variable is a
22099 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
22100 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
22101 If the @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches
22102 the @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
22103
22104 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
22105 @code{xface}).
22106
22107 @noindent
22108 Face and variable:
22109
22110 @table @code
22111 @item gnus-x-face
22112 @vindex gnus-x-face
22113 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
22114 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
22115 default colors are black and white.
22116 @end table
22117
22118 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
22119 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
22120 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
22121 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
22122 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
22123 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
22124
22125 @findex gnus-random-x-face
22126 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
22127 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
22128 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
22129 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
22130 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
22131 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
22132 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
22133 header data as a string.
22134
22135 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
22136 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
22137 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
22138 randomly generated data.
22139
22140 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
22141 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
22142 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
22143 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
22144 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
22145
22146 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
22147 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22148
22149 @lisp
22150 (setq message-required-news-headers
22151 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22152 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
22153 @end lisp
22154
22155 Using the last function would be something like this:
22156
22157 @lisp
22158 (setq message-required-news-headers
22159 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22160 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
22161 (gnus-x-face-from-file
22162 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
22163 @end lisp
22164
22165
22166 @node Face
22167 @subsection Face
22168 @cindex face
22169
22170 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
22171
22172 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
22173 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
22174 represent the author of the message.
22175
22176 @cindex face
22177 @findex gnus-article-display-face
22178 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
22179 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
22180 specifications.
22181
22182 Viewing an @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
22183 PNG images.
22184 @c Maybe add this:
22185 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
22186 @c (featurep 'png)
22187 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
22188
22189 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
22190 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
22191
22192 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
22193 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
22194 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
22195
22196 @findex gnus-face-from-file
22197 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
22198 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
22199 converts the file to Face format by using the
22200 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
22201
22202 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
22203 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22204
22205 @lisp
22206 (setq message-required-news-headers
22207 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22208 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
22209 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
22210 @end lisp
22211
22212
22213 @node Smileys
22214 @subsection Smileys
22215 @cindex smileys
22216
22217 @iftex
22218 @iflatex
22219 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
22220 \input{smiley}
22221 @end iflatex
22222 @end iftex
22223
22224 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
22225 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
22226
22227 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
22228 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22229
22230 @lisp
22231 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
22232 @end lisp
22233
22234 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
22235 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
22236 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
22237 text and maps that to file names.
22238
22239 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
22240 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
22241 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
22242 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
22243 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
22244 displayed.
22245
22246 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
22247 files:
22248
22249 @table @code
22250
22251 @item smiley-data-directory
22252 @vindex smiley-data-directory
22253 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
22254
22255 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
22256 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
22257 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
22258
22259 @end table
22260
22261
22262 @node Picons
22263 @subsection Picons
22264
22265 @iftex
22266 @iflatex
22267 \include{picons}
22268 @end iflatex
22269 @end iftex
22270
22271 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
22272 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
22273 over your shoulder as you read news.
22274
22275 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
22276
22277 @iftex
22278 @iflatex
22279 \margindex{}
22280 @end iflatex
22281 @end iftex
22282
22283 @quotation
22284 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
22285 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
22286 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
22287 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
22288 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
22289 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
22290 @code{GIF} formats.
22291 @end quotation
22292
22293 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22294 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
22295 point your Web browser at
22296 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
22297
22298 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
22299 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
22300
22301 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
22302 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
22303 Picons databases.
22304
22305 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
22306
22307 @table @code
22308
22309 @item gnus-picon-databases
22310 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22311 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
22312 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
22313 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
22314 "/usr/local/faces")}.
22315
22316 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
22317 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
22318 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22319 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
22320
22321 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
22322 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
22323 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
22324 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
22325
22326 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
22327 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
22328 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22329 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
22330 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
22331
22332 @item gnus-picon-file-types
22333 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
22334 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
22335 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
22336
22337 @end table
22338
22339
22340 @node XVarious
22341 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
22342
22343 @table @code
22344 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22345 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22346 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
22347 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
22348 unusual directory structure.
22349
22350 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22351 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22352 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
22353 default.
22354
22355 @end table
22356
22357 @subsubsection Toolbar
22358
22359 @table @code
22360
22361 @item gnus-use-toolbar
22362 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
22363 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
22364 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
22365 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
22366 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
22367 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
22368 names show. The default is @code{default}.
22369
22370 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
22371 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
22372 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
22373 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
22374 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
22375 The default is that of the default toolbar.
22376
22377 @item gnus-group-toolbar
22378 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
22379 The toolbar in the group buffer.
22380
22381 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
22382 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
22383 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
22384
22385 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22386 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22387 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
22388
22389 @end table
22390
22391 @iftex
22392 @iflatex
22393 \margindex{}
22394 @end iflatex
22395 @end iftex
22396
22397
22398 @node Fuzzy Matching
22399 @section Fuzzy Matching
22400 @cindex fuzzy matching
22401
22402 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
22403 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
22404
22405 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
22406 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
22407 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
22408
22409 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
22410 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
22411 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
22412 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
22413 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
22414
22415
22416 @node Thwarting Email Spam
22417 @section Thwarting Email Spam
22418 @cindex email spam
22419 @cindex spam
22420 @cindex UCE
22421 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22422
22423 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
22424 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
22425 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
22426 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
22427 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
22428 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
22429 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
22430 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
22431 in the end.
22432
22433 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
22434 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
22435 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
22436 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
22437 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
22438 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
22439
22440 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
22441
22442 @menu
22443 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
22444 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
22445 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
22446 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
22447 * Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package::
22448 * Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat::
22449 @end menu
22450
22451 @node The problem of spam
22452 @subsection The problem of spam
22453 @cindex email spam
22454 @cindex spam filtering approaches
22455 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
22456 @cindex UCE
22457 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22458
22459 First, some background on spam.
22460
22461 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
22462 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
22463 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
22464 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
22465 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
22466 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
22467 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
22468 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
22469 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
22470
22471 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
22472 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
22473 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
22474 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
22475 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
22476 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
22477 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
22478 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
22479 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
22480 and processing.
22481
22482 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
22483 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
22484 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
22485 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
22486 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
22487 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
22488 from Bulgarian IPs.
22489
22490 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
22491 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
22492 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
22493 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
22494
22495 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
22496 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
22497 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
22498 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
22499
22500 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
22501 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
22502 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
22503 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
22504 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
22505 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
22506 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
22507 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
22508 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
22509
22510 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
22511 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
22512 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
22513 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
22514 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
22515 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
22516 down for some time because of the incident.
22517
22518 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
22519 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
22520 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
22521 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
22522 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
22523 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
22524 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
22525 to store the database of spam analyses. Statistical analysis on the
22526 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
22527 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
22528 the server that it has misclassified mail.
22529
22530 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
22531 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
22532 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
22533 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
22534 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
22535 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
22536 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
22537 spam plague.
22538
22539 @node Anti-Spam Basics
22540 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
22541 @cindex email spam
22542 @cindex spam
22543 @cindex UCE
22544 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22545
22546 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
22547 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
22548
22549 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
22550 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
22551 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
22552 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
22553 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
22554 part of the mail address.)
22555
22556 @lisp
22557 (setq message-default-news-headers
22558 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
22559 @end lisp
22560
22561 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
22562 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22563
22564 @lisp
22565 (...
22566 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
22567 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
22568 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
22569 "spam"))
22570 ...)
22571 @end lisp
22572
22573 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
22574 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
22575 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
22576 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
22577
22578 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
22579 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
22580 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
22581 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
22582 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
22583 your fancy split rule in this way:
22584
22585 @lisp
22586 (
22587 ...
22588 (to "larsi" "misc")
22589 "spam")
22590 @end lisp
22591
22592 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
22593 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
22594 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
22595 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
22596 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
22597
22598 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
22599 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
22600 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
22601 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
22602
22603 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
22604
22605
22606 @node SpamAssassin
22607 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
22608 @cindex SpamAssassin
22609 @cindex Vipul's Razor
22610 @cindex DCC
22611
22612 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
22613 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
22614 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
22615 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
22616 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
22617 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
22618 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
22619
22620 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
22621 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
22622 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
22623 recipes.
22624
22625 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
22626 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
22627 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
22628 Specifiers}) follow.
22629
22630 @lisp
22631 (setq mail-sources
22632 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
22633 (pop :user "jrl"
22634 :server "pophost"
22635 :postscript
22636 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
22637 @end lisp
22638
22639 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
22640 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
22641 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
22642
22643 @lisp
22644 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
22645 ...))
22646 @end lisp
22647
22648 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22649
22650 @lisp
22651 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
22652 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
22653 ...))
22654 @end lisp
22655
22656 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
22657 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
22658 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
22659 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
22660
22661 @lisp
22662 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
22663 ...))
22664 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
22665 (save-excursion
22666 (save-restriction
22667 (widen)
22668 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
22669 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
22670 "spam"))))
22671 @end lisp
22672
22673 Note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will not be
22674 downloaded by default. You need to set
22675 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
22676 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
22677
22678 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
22679 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
22680 spam. And here is the nifty function:
22681
22682 @lisp
22683 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
22684 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
22685 (interactive)
22686 (gnus-summary-show-raw-article)
22687 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d")
22688 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
22689 @end lisp
22690
22691 @node Hashcash
22692 @subsection Hashcash
22693 @cindex hashcash
22694
22695 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
22696 costly for each message they send. This has the obvious drawback that
22697 you cannot rely on everyone in the world using this technique,
22698 since it is not part of the Internet standards, but it may be useful
22699 in smaller communities.
22700
22701 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
22702 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
22703 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
22704 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
22705 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
22706 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
22707 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
22708 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
22709 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
22710 one of them separately.
22711
22712 @cindex X-Hashcash
22713 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
22714 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
22715 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:}
22716 header. For more details, and for the external application
22717 @code{hashcash} you need to install to use this feature, see
22718 @uref{http://www.cypherspace.org/~adam/hashcash/}. Even more
22719 information can be found at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
22720
22721 If you wish to call hashcash for each message you send, say something
22722 like:
22723
22724 @lisp
22725 (require 'hashcash)
22726 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'mail-add-payment)
22727 @end lisp
22728
22729 The @file{hashcash.el} library can be found in the Gnus development
22730 contrib directory or at
22731 @uref{http://users.actrix.gen.nz/mycroft/hashcash.el}.
22732
22733 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
22734
22735 @table @code
22736
22737 @item hashcash-default-payment
22738 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
22739 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
22740 should consist of. By default this is 0, meaning nothing will be
22741 done. Suggested useful values include 17 to 29.
22742
22743 @item hashcash-payment-alist
22744 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
22745 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
22746 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
22747 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
22748 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
22749 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
22750 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
22751 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
22752
22753 @item hashcash
22754 @vindex hashcash
22755 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed.
22756
22757 @end table
22758
22759 Currently there is no built in functionality in Gnus to verify
22760 hashcash cookies, it is expected that this is performed by your hand
22761 customized mail filtering scripts. Improvements in this area would be
22762 a useful contribution, however.
22763
22764 @node Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
22765 @subsection Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
22766 @cindex spam filtering
22767 @cindex spam
22768
22769 The idea behind @file{spam.el} is to have a control center for spam detection
22770 and filtering in Gnus. To that end, @file{spam.el} does two things: it
22771 filters new mail, and it analyzes mail known to be spam or ham.
22772 @dfn{Ham} is the name used throughout @file{spam.el} to indicate
22773 non-spam messages.
22774
22775 @cindex spam-initialize
22776 First of all, you @strong{must} run the function
22777 @code{spam-initialize} to autoload @code{spam.el} and to install the
22778 @code{spam.el} hooks. There is one exception: if you use the
22779 @code{spam-use-stat} (@pxref{spam-stat spam filtering}) setting, you
22780 should turn it on before @code{spam-initialize}:
22781
22782 @example
22783 (setq spam-use-stat t) ;; if needed
22784 (spam-initialize)
22785 @end example
22786
22787 So, what happens when you load @file{spam.el}?
22788
22789 First, some hooks will get installed by @code{spam-initialize}. There
22790 are some hooks for @code{spam-stat} so it can save its databases, and
22791 there are hooks so interesting things will happen when you enter and
22792 leave a group. More on the sequence of events later (@pxref{Spam
22793 ELisp Package Sequence of Events}).
22794
22795 You get the following keyboard commands:
22796
22797 @table @kbd
22798
22799 @item M-d
22800 @itemx M s x
22801 @itemx S x
22802 @kindex M-d
22803 @kindex S x
22804 @kindex M s x
22805 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
22806 @code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}.
22807
22808 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark.
22809 Whenever you see a spam article, make sure to mark its summary line
22810 with @kbd{M-d} before leaving the group. This is done automatically
22811 for unread articles in @emph{spam} groups.
22812
22813 @item M s t
22814 @itemx S t
22815 @kindex M s t
22816 @kindex S t
22817 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
22818 @code{spam-bogofilter-score}.
22819
22820 You must have Bogofilter installed for that command to work properly.
22821
22822 @xref{Bogofilter}.
22823
22824 @end table
22825
22826 Also, when you load @file{spam.el}, you will be able to customize its
22827 variables. Try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{spam} variable
22828 group.
22829
22830 @menu
22831 * Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events::
22832 * Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail::
22833 * Spam ELisp Package Global Variables::
22834 * Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples::
22835 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
22836 * BBDB Whitelists::
22837 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
22838 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
22839 * Blackholes::
22840 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
22841 * Bogofilter::
22842 * ifile spam filtering::
22843 * spam-stat spam filtering::
22844 * SpamOracle::
22845 * Extending the Spam ELisp package::
22846 @end menu
22847
22848 @node Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events
22849 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events
22850 @cindex spam filtering
22851 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
22852 @cindex spam
22853
22854 You must read this section to understand how @code{spam.el} works.
22855 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
22856
22857 There are two @emph{contact points}, if you will, between
22858 @code{spam.el} and the rest of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and
22859 leaving a group.
22860
22861 Getting new mail is done in one of two ways. You can either split
22862 your incoming mail or you can classify new articles as ham or spam
22863 when you enter the group.
22864
22865 Splitting incoming mail is better suited to mail backends such as
22866 @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap} where new mail appears in a single file
22867 called a @dfn{Spool File}. See @xref{Spam ELisp Package Filtering of
22868 Incoming Mail}.
22869
22870 For backends such as @code{nntp} there is no incoming mail spool, so
22871 an alternate mechanism must be used. This may also happen for
22872 backends where the server is in charge of splitting incoming mail, and
22873 Gnus does not do further splitting. The @code{spam-autodetect} and
22874 @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameters (accessible with
22875 @kbd{G c} and @kbd{G p} as usual), and the corresponding variables
22876 @code{gnus-spam-autodetect-methods} and
22877 @code{gnus-spam-autodetect-methods} (accessible with @kbd{M-x
22878 customize-variable} as usual).
22879
22880 When @code{spam-autodetect} is used, it hooks into the process of
22881 entering a group. Thus, entering a group with unseen or unread
22882 articles becomes the substitute for checking incoming mail. Whether
22883 only unseen articles or all unread articles will be processed is
22884 determined by the @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages}. When set
22885 to @code{t}, unread messages will be rechecked.
22886
22887 @code{spam-autodetect} grants the user at once more and less control
22888 of spam filtering. The user will have more control over each group's
22889 spam methods, so for instance the @samp{ding} group may have
22890 @code{spam-use-BBDB} as the autodetection method, while the
22891 @samp{suspect} group may have the @code{spam-use-blacklist} and
22892 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods enabled. Every article detected to
22893 be spam will be marked with the spam mark @samp{$} and processed on
22894 exit from the group as normal spam. The user has less control over
22895 the @emph{sequence} of checks, as he might with @code{spam-split}.
22896
22897 When the newly split mail goes into groups, or messages are
22898 autodetected to be ham or spam, those groups must be exited (after
22899 entering, if needed) for further spam processing to happen. It
22900 matters whether the group is considered a ham group, a spam group, or
22901 is unclassified, based on its @code{spam-content} parameter
22902 (@pxref{Spam ELisp Package Global Variables}). Spam groups have the
22903 additional characteristic that, when entered, any unseen or unread
22904 articles (depending on the @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam}
22905 variable) will be marked as spam. Thus, mail split into a spam group
22906 gets automatically marked as spam when you enter the group.
22907
22908 So, when you exit a group, the @code{spam-processors} are applied, if
22909 any are set, and the processed mail is moved to the
22910 @code{ham-process-destination} or the @code{spam-process-destination}
22911 depending on the article's classification. If the
22912 @code{ham-process-destination} or the @code{spam-process-destination},
22913 whichever is appropriate, are @code{nil}, the article is left in the
22914 current group.
22915
22916 If a spam is found in any group (this can be changed to only non-spam
22917 groups with @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only}), it is
22918 processed by the active @code{spam-processors} (@pxref{Spam ELisp
22919 Package Global Variables}) when the group is exited. Furthermore, the
22920 spam is moved to the @code{spam-process-destination} (@pxref{Spam
22921 ELisp Package Global Variables}) for further training or deletion.
22922 You have to load the @code{gnus-registry.el} package and enable the
22923 @code{spam-log-to-registry} variable if you want spam to be processed
22924 no more than once. Thus, spam is detected and processed everywhere,
22925 which is what most people want. If the
22926 @code{spam-process-destination} is @code{nil}, the spam is marked as
22927 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
22928
22929 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
22930 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
22931
22932 If a ham mail is found in a ham group, as determined by the
22933 @code{ham-marks} parameter, it is processed as ham by the active ham
22934 @code{spam-processor} when the group is exited. With the variables
22935 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
22936 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} the behavior can be further
22937 altered so ham found anywhere can be processed. You have to load the
22938 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and enable the
22939 @code{spam-log-to-registry} variable if you want ham to be processed
22940 no more than once. Thus, ham is detected and processed only when
22941 necessary, which is what most people want. More on this in
22942 @xref{Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples}.
22943
22944 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
22945 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
22946
22947 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
22948 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
22949 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
22950
22951 @node Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail
22952 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail
22953 @cindex spam filtering
22954 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
22955 @cindex spam
22956
22957 To use the @file{spam.el} facilities for incoming mail filtering, you
22958 must add the following to your fancy split list
22959 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}:
22960
22961 @example
22962 (: spam-split)
22963 @end example
22964
22965 Note that the fancy split may be called @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
22966 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on whether you use the nnmail or
22967 nnimap back ends to retrieve your mail.
22968
22969 Also, @code{spam-split} will not modify incoming mail in any way.
22970
22971 The @code{spam-split} function will process incoming mail and send the
22972 mail considered to be spam into the group name given by the variable
22973 @code{spam-split-group}. By default that group name is @samp{spam},
22974 but you can customize @code{spam-split-group}. Make sure the contents
22975 of @code{spam-split-group} are an @emph{unqualified} group name, for
22976 instance in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server} the value
22977 @samp{spam} will turn out to be @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The
22978 value @samp{nnimap+server:spam}, therefore, is wrong and will
22979 actually give you the group
22980 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam} which may or may not
22981 work depending on your server's tolerance for strange group names.
22982
22983 You can also give @code{spam-split} a parameter,
22984 e.g. @code{spam-use-regex-headers} or @code{"maybe-spam"}. Why is
22985 this useful?
22986
22987 Take these split rules (with @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and
22988 @code{spam-use-blackholes} set):
22989
22990 @example
22991 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
22992 (any "ding" "ding")
22993 (: spam-split)
22994 ;; @r{default mailbox}
22995 "mail")
22996 @end example
22997
22998 Now, the problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the
22999 ding folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam
23000 detected by SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through,
23001 when it's sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to
23002 the ding list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the
23003 invocation of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
23004
23005 You can let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, but all other
23006 @code{spam-split} rules (including a second invocation of the
23007 regex-headers check) will be after the ding rule:
23008
23009 @example
23010 nnimap-split-fancy
23011 '(|
23012 ;; @r{all spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
23013 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23014 (any "ding" "ding")
23015 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
23016 (: spam-split)
23017 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23018 "mail")
23019 @end example
23020
23021 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
23022 your particular needs, and to target the results of those checks to a
23023 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
23024 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
23025 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
23026 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
23027 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
23028
23029 You should still have specific checks such as
23030 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} set to @code{t}, even if you
23031 specifically invoke @code{spam-split} with the check. The reason is
23032 that when loading @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done
23033 depending on what @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. This
23034 is usually not critical, though.
23035
23036 @emph{Note for IMAP users}
23037
23038 The boolean variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} needs to be
23039 set, if you want to split based on the whole message instead of just
23040 the headers. By default, the nnimap back end will only retrieve the
23041 message headers. If you use @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
23042 @code{spam-check-ifile}, or @code{spam-check-stat} (the splitters that
23043 can benefit from the full message body), you should set this variable.
23044 It is not set by default because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and
23045 that is not an appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user.
23046
23047 @xref{Splitting in IMAP}.
23048
23049 @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
23050 statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
23051 don't.}
23052
23053 @node Spam ELisp Package Global Variables
23054 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Global Variables
23055 @cindex spam filtering
23056 @cindex spam filtering variables
23057 @cindex spam variables
23058 @cindex spam
23059
23060 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
23061 The concepts of ham processors and spam processors are very important.
23062 Ham processors and spam processors for a group can be set with the
23063 @code{spam-process} group parameter, or the
23064 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. Ham processors take
23065 mail known to be non-spam (@emph{ham}) and process it in some way so
23066 that later similar mail will also be considered non-spam. Spam
23067 processors take mail known to be spam and process it so similar spam
23068 will be detected later.
23069
23070 The format of the spam or ham processor entry used to be a symbol,
23071 but now it is a @sc{cons} cell. See the individual spam processor entries
23072 for more information.
23073
23074 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23075 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
23076 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
23077 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
23078 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
23079 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
23080 by customizing the corresponding variable
23081 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
23082 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
23083 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
23084 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
23085 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
23086 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
23087 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
23088 default.
23089
23090 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
23091 @cindex $
23092 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
23093 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
23094 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
23095 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
23096 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
23097 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
23098 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
23099 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
23100 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
23101 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
23102 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
23103 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
23104 processor which will study them as spam samples.
23105
23106 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
23107 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
23108 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
23109 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
23110 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
23111 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
23112 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
23113 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
23114
23115 @defvar ham-marks
23116 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23117 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
23118 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
23119 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
23120 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
23121 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
23122 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
23123 happy for you.
23124 @end defvar
23125
23126 @defvar spam-marks
23127 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23128 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
23129 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
23130 you really want to.
23131 @end defvar
23132
23133 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
23134 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
23135 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
23136 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
23137 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
23138 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
23139 and nothing else.
23140
23141 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
23142 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
23143 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
23144 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
23145 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
23146 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
23147 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
23148 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
23149 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
23150 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
23151 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
23152 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
23153 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
23154 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
23155 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
23156
23157 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23158 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23159
23160 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23161 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
23162 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
23163
23164 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
23165 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
23166
23167 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
23168 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
23169 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
23170 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
23171 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
23172
23173 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
23174 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
23175 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
23176 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
23177 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
23178 it there.
23179
23180 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23181 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
23182 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
23183 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
23184 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
23185 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
23186 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
23187 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
23188 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
23189 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
23190 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
23191 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
23192 group buffer then you need it here as well.
23193
23194 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23195 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23196
23197 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23198 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
23199 training} groups.
23200
23201 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
23202 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
23203 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
23204 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
23205 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
23206 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
23207 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
23208
23209 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
23210 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
23211 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
23212 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
23213
23214 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
23215 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
23216 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
23217 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
23218 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
23219 from the mail server.
23220
23221 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
23222 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
23223 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
23224 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
23225
23226 @node Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples
23227 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples
23228 @cindex spam filtering
23229 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
23230 @cindex spam configuration examples
23231 @cindex spam
23232
23233 @subsubheading Ted's setup
23234
23235 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
23236 @example
23237 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
23238 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
23239 (gnus-registry-initialize)
23240 (spam-initialize)
23241
23242 ;; @r{I like @kbd{C-s} for marking spam}
23243 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map "\C-s" 'gnus-summary-mark-as-spam)
23244
23245 (setq
23246 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
23247 spam-use-BBDB t
23248 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
23249 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
23250 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23251 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23252 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
23253 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
23254 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
23255 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
23256 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23257 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
23258 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23259 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
23260 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
23261 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
23262 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23263 (any "ding" "ding")
23264 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
23265 (: spam-split)
23266 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23267 "mail"))
23268
23269 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
23270
23271 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
23272 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
23273 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
23274 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
23275
23276 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23277
23278 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
23279 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
23280 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
23281 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
23282 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23283
23284 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
23285 ((spam-autodetect . t))
23286
23287 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
23288
23289 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
23290 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
23291
23292 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
23293 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
23294 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
23295
23296 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
23297
23298 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
23299 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
23300
23301 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
23302 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
23303 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
23304 (ham-marks
23305 (gnus-ticked-mark))
23306 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
23307 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
23308 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
23309
23310 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
23311 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
23312 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
23313
23314 @end example
23315
23316 @subsubheading Using @file{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
23317 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23318
23319 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
23320 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
23321 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
23322 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
23323 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
23324 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
23325 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
23326 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
23327 @samp{training.spam} folders.
23328
23329 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
23330 does most of the job for me:
23331
23332 @lisp
23333 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
23334 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
23335 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
23336 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23337 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
23338 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
23339 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
23340 @end lisp
23341
23342 @itemize
23343
23344 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
23345
23346 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
23347 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
23348 bogofilter or DCC).
23349
23350 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
23351 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
23352 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark (@code{ham-marks},
23353 @ref{Spam ELisp Package Global Variables}). On group exit, those
23354 messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want to have
23355 the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter) and
23356 deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
23357
23358 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
23359 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
23360 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
23361 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
23362 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
23363 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
23364
23365 @item @b{Ham folders:}
23366
23367 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
23368 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
23369 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
23370 @samp{training.ham}.
23371 @end itemize
23372
23373 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
23374
23375 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23376
23377 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
23378 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
23379 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
23380
23381 @lisp
23382 ("^gmane\\."
23383 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
23384 @end lisp
23385
23386 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
23387 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
23388 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
23389 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
23390 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
23391
23392 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
23393 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
23394 @cindex spam filtering
23395 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
23396 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
23397 @cindex spam
23398
23399 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
23400
23401 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
23402 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
23403 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
23404 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
23405 be spammers.
23406
23407 @end defvar
23408
23409 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
23410
23411 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
23412 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
23413 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23414 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
23415 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23416
23417 @end defvar
23418
23419 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
23420
23421 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
23422 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23423 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
23424
23425 @end defvar
23426
23427 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
23428
23429 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23430 customizing the group parameters or the
23431 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23432 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23433 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
23434
23435 @emph{WARNING}
23436
23437 Instead of the obsolete
23438 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
23439 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
23440 the same way, we promise.
23441
23442 @end defvar
23443
23444 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
23445
23446 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23447 customizing the group parameters or the
23448 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23449 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23450 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23451 whitelist. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23452 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23453
23454 @emph{WARNING}
23455
23456 Instead of the obsolete
23457 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
23458 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
23459 the same way, we promise.
23460
23461 @end defvar
23462
23463 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
23464 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
23465 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
23466 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
23467 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
23468
23469 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
23470 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
23471 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
23472 Emacs regular expression syntax.
23473
23474 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
23475 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
23476 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
23477 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
23478 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
23479 @file{blacklist} respectively.
23480
23481 @node BBDB Whitelists
23482 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
23483 @cindex spam filtering
23484 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
23485 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
23486 @cindex spam
23487
23488 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
23489
23490 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23491 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
23492 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
23493 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
23494 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23495 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
23496 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23497
23498 @end defvar
23499
23500 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
23501
23502 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
23503 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23504 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
23505 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
23506 classified as spammers.
23507
23508 @end defvar
23509
23510 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
23511
23512 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23513 customizing the group parameters or the
23514 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23515 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23516 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23517 BBDB. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23518 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23519
23520 @emph{WARNING}
23521
23522 Instead of the obsolete
23523 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
23524 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
23525 the same way, we promise.
23526
23527 @end defvar
23528
23529 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
23530 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
23531 @cindex spam reporting
23532 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23533 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23534 @cindex spam
23535
23536 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
23537
23538 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23539 customizing the group parameters or the
23540 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23541 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23542 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
23543 HTTP request.
23544
23545 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
23546
23547 @emph{WARNING}
23548
23549 Instead of the obsolete
23550 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
23551 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
23552 same way, we promise.
23553
23554 @end defvar
23555
23556 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
23557
23558 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
23559 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
23560 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
23561 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
23562 @code{spam-report.el} will use the @code{X-Report-Spam} header that
23563 Gmane provides.
23564
23565 @end defvar
23566
23567 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23568 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23569 @cindex spam filtering
23570 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
23571 @cindex spam
23572
23573 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
23574
23575 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23576 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
23577 instead of the sender address. You must have the @code{hashcash.el}
23578 package loaded for @code{spam-use-hashcash} to work properly.
23579 Messages without a hashcash payment token will be sent to the next
23580 spam-split rule. This is an explicit filter, meaning that unless a
23581 hashcash token is found, the messages are not assumed to be spam or
23582 ham.
23583
23584 @end defvar
23585
23586 @node Blackholes
23587 @subsubsection Blackholes
23588 @cindex spam filtering
23589 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
23590 @cindex spam
23591
23592 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
23593
23594 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
23595 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
23596 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
23597 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
23598 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
23599 contains outdated servers.
23600
23601 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
23602 @file{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
23603 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
23604 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
23605 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
23606 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
23607
23608 @end defvar
23609
23610 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
23611
23612 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
23613
23614 @end defvar
23615
23616 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
23617
23618 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
23619 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
23620
23621 @end defvar
23622
23623 @defvar spam-use-dig
23624
23625 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
23626 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
23627
23628 @end defvar
23629
23630 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
23631 ham processor for blackholes.
23632
23633 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
23634 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
23635 @cindex spam filtering
23636 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
23637 @cindex spam
23638
23639 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
23640
23641 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
23642 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
23643 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
23644 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
23645 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
23646 message is spam or ham, respectively.
23647
23648 @end defvar
23649
23650 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
23651
23652 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23653 the message, positively identify it as spam.
23654
23655 @end defvar
23656
23657 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
23658
23659 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23660 the message, positively identify it as ham.
23661
23662 @end defvar
23663
23664 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
23665 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
23666
23667 @node Bogofilter
23668 @subsubsection Bogofilter
23669 @cindex spam filtering
23670 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
23671 @cindex spam
23672
23673 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
23674
23675 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23676 speedy Bogofilter.
23677
23678 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
23679 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
23680 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
23681 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
23682 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
23683 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
23684
23685 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
23686 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
23687 documentation.
23688
23689 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
23690 processing will be turned off.
23691
23692 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
23693
23694 @end defvar
23695
23696 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
23697
23698 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23699 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
23700 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
23701 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
23702 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
23703 installation documents for details.
23704
23705 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
23706
23707 @end defvar
23708
23709 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
23710 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23711 customizing the group parameters or the
23712 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23713 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
23714 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
23715
23716 @emph{WARNING}
23717
23718 Instead of the obsolete
23719 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23720 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23721 the same way, we promise.
23722 @end defvar
23723
23724 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
23725 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23726 customizing the group parameters or the
23727 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23728 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23729 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
23730 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23731 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23732
23733 @emph{WARNING}
23734
23735 Instead of the obsolete
23736 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23737 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23738 the same way, we promise.
23739 @end defvar
23740
23741 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
23742
23743 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
23744 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
23745 database directory.
23746
23747 @end defvar
23748
23749 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
23750 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23751 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
23752 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
23753 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
23754 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
23755
23756 @node ifile spam filtering
23757 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
23758 @cindex spam filtering
23759 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
23760 @cindex spam
23761
23762 @defvar spam-use-ifile
23763
23764 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
23765 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
23766
23767 @end defvar
23768
23769 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
23770
23771 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
23772 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
23773 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
23774
23775 @end defvar
23776
23777 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
23778
23779 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
23780 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
23781 the default value of @samp{spam}.
23782 @end defvar
23783
23784 @defvar spam-ifile-database-path
23785
23786 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
23787 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
23788
23789 @end defvar
23790
23791 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
23792 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23793 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
23794 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
23795 functionality.
23796
23797 @node spam-stat spam filtering
23798 @subsubsection spam-stat spam filtering
23799 @cindex spam filtering
23800 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
23801 @cindex spam-stat
23802 @cindex spam
23803
23804 @xref{Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat}.
23805
23806 @defvar spam-use-stat
23807
23808 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use
23809 spam-stat.el, an Emacs Lisp statistical analyzer.
23810
23811 @end defvar
23812
23813 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
23814 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23815 customizing the group parameters or the
23816 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23817 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23818 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
23819
23820 @emph{WARNING}
23821
23822 Instead of the obsolete
23823 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23824 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23825 the same way, we promise.
23826 @end defvar
23827
23828 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
23829 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23830 customizing the group parameters or the
23831 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23832 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23833 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
23834 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23835 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23836
23837 @emph{WARNING}
23838
23839 Instead of the obsolete
23840 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23841 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23842 the same way, we promise.
23843 @end defvar
23844
23845 This enables @file{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
23846 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
23847 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
23848 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
23849 @code{spam-split} are provided.
23850
23851 @node SpamOracle
23852 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
23853 @cindex spam filtering
23854 @cindex SpamOracle
23855 @cindex spam
23856
23857 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
23858 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
23859 installed separately.
23860
23861 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
23862 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
23863 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
23864 mail as a spam mail or not.
23865
23866 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
23867 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
23868 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
23869
23870 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Filtering Spam
23871 Using The Spam ELisp Package}) call SpamOracle.
23872
23873 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
23874 To enable SpamOracle usage by @file{spam.el}, set the variable
23875 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
23876 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy} as described in
23877 the section @xref{Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package}. In
23878 this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is filtered using
23879 SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be moved to
23880 @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham messages stay
23881 in @samp{INBOX}:
23882
23883 @example
23884 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
23885 spam-split-group "Junk"
23886 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
23887 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23888 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
23889 @end example
23890
23891 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
23892 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
23893 SpamOracle.
23894 @end defvar
23895
23896 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
23897 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
23898 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
23899 can be customized.
23900 @end defvar
23901
23902 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
23903 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
23904 store its analyses. This is controlled by the variable
23905 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
23906 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
23907 database to live somewhere special, set
23908 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
23909 @end defvar
23910
23911 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
23912 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
23913 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns the
23914 characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
23915 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
23916 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary buffer
23917 and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using @file{spam.el}'s
23918 spam- and ham-processors, which is much more convenient. For a
23919 detailed description of spam- and ham-processors, @xref{Filtering Spam
23920 Using The Spam ELisp Package}.
23921
23922 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
23923 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23924 customizing the group parameter or the
23925 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
23926 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
23927 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
23928
23929 @emph{WARNING}
23930
23931 Instead of the obsolete
23932 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
23933 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
23934 the same way, we promise.
23935 @end defvar
23936
23937 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
23938 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23939 customizing the group parameter or the
23940 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
23941 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
23942 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
23943 messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam} or
23944 @emph{unclassified} groups.
23945
23946 @emph{WARNING}
23947
23948 Instead of the obsolete
23949 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
23950 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
23951 the same way, we promise.
23952 @end defvar
23953
23954 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
23955 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
23956 messages.
23957 @example
23958 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
23959 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
23960 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
23961 @end example
23962 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
23963 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
23964 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
23965 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
23966 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
23967 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
23968
23969 @node Extending the Spam ELisp package
23970 @subsubsection Extending the Spam ELisp package
23971 @cindex spam filtering
23972 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
23973 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
23974
23975 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
23976 incoming mail, provide the following:
23977
23978 @enumerate
23979
23980 @item
23981 Code
23982
23983 @lisp
23984 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
23985 "True if blackbox should be used.")
23986 @end lisp
23987
23988 Add
23989 @lisp
23990 (spam-use-blackbox . spam-check-blackbox)
23991 @end lisp
23992 to @code{spam-list-of-checks}.
23993
23994 Add
23995 @lisp
23996 (gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox ham spam-use-blackbox)
23997 (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox spam spam-use-blackbox)
23998 @end lisp
23999
24000 to @code{spam-list-of-processors}.
24001
24002 Add
24003 @lisp
24004 (spam-use-blackbox spam-blackbox-register-routine
24005 nil
24006 spam-blackbox-unregister-routine
24007 nil)
24008 @end lisp
24009
24010 to @code{spam-registration-functions}. Write the register/unregister
24011 routines using the bogofilter register/unregister routines as a
24012 start, or other restister/unregister routines more appropriate to
24013 Blackbox.
24014
24015 @item
24016 Functionality
24017
24018 Write the @code{spam-check-blackbox} function. It should return
24019 @samp{nil} or @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other
24020 conventions. See the existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for
24021 examples of what you can do, and stick to the template unless you
24022 fully understand the reasons why you aren't.
24023
24024 Make sure to add @code{spam-use-blackbox} to
24025 @code{spam-list-of-statistical-checks} if Blackbox is a statistical
24026 mail analyzer that needs the full message body to operate.
24027
24028 @end enumerate
24029
24030 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
24031
24032 @enumerate
24033
24034 @item
24035 Code
24036
24037 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
24038 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
24039
24040 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
24041 variables. Instead the form @code{'(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
24042 @code{'(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
24043 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
24044
24045 @lisp
24046 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
24047 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
24048 Only applicable to spam groups.")
24049
24050 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
24051 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
24052 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
24053
24054 @end lisp
24055
24056 @item
24057 Gnus parameters
24058
24059 Add
24060 @lisp
24061 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
24062 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
24063 @end lisp
24064 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
24065 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
24066 variable customization.
24067
24068 Add
24069 @lisp
24070 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
24071 @end lisp
24072 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
24073 @code{gnus.el}.
24074
24075 @end enumerate
24076
24077
24078 @node Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
24079 @subsection Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
24080 @cindex Paul Graham
24081 @cindex Graham, Paul
24082 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
24083 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
24084 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
24085
24086 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
24087 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
24088 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
24089 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
24090 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
24091 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
24092 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
24093 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
24094 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
24095 or not.
24096
24097 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
24098 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
24099 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
24100 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
24101 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
24102 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
24103 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
24104 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
24105
24106 Gnus supports this kind of filtering. But it needs some setting up.
24107 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
24108 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
24109 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
24110 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
24111
24112 @menu
24113 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
24114 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
24115 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
24116 @end menu
24117
24118 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24119 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24120
24121 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
24122 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
24123 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
24124 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
24125 need several hundred emails in both collections.
24126
24127 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
24128 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
24129 per mail. Use the following:
24130
24131 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
24132 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
24133 is treated as one spam mail.
24134 @end defun
24135
24136 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
24137 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
24138 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
24139 @end defun
24140
24141 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
24142 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds
24143 the the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
24144 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
24145 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds the the group
24146 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
24147
24148 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
24149 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
24150 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
24151 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
24152 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
24153
24154 @defvar spam-stat
24155 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
24156 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
24157 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
24158 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
24159 @end defvar
24160
24161 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
24162 reset the dictionary.
24163
24164 @defun spam-stat-reset
24165 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
24166 @end defun
24167
24168 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
24169 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
24170 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
24171 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
24172 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
24173 only non-spam mails.
24174
24175 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
24176 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
24177 to update the dictionary incrementally.
24178 @end defun
24179
24180 @defun spam-stat-save
24181 Save the dictionary.
24182 @end defun
24183
24184 @defvar spam-stat-file
24185 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
24186 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
24187 @end defvar
24188
24189 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
24190 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
24191
24192 In order to use @code{spam-stat} to split your mail, you need to add the
24193 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24194
24195 @lisp
24196 (require 'spam-stat)
24197 (spam-stat-load)
24198 @end lisp
24199
24200 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
24201 created.
24202
24203 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
24204 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
24205 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
24206 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
24207
24208 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
24209 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
24210 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
24211 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
24212
24213 @lisp
24214 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24215 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24216 "mail.misc"))
24217 @end lisp
24218
24219 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
24220 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
24221 @end defvar
24222
24223 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
24224 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
24225 expression are considered potential spam.
24226
24227 @lisp
24228 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24229 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24230 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24231 "mail.misc"))
24232 @end lisp
24233
24234 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
24235 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
24236 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
24237 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
24238 mails, when creating the dictionary!
24239
24240 @lisp
24241 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24242 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24243 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24244 "mail.misc"))
24245 @end lisp
24246
24247 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
24248 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
24249 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
24250 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
24251 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
24252 dictionary!
24253
24254 @lisp
24255 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24256 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
24257 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24258 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24259 "mail.misc"))
24260 @end lisp
24261
24262
24263 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24264 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24265
24266 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
24267
24268 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
24269 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
24270 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24271 @end defun
24272
24273 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
24274 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
24275 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24276 @end defun
24277
24278 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
24279 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
24280 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
24281 already been processed as non-spam.
24282 @end defun
24283
24284 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
24285 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
24286 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
24287 been processed as spam.
24288 @end defun
24289
24290 @defun spam-stat-save
24291 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
24292 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24293 @end defun
24294
24295 @defun spam-stat-load
24296 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
24297 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24298 @end defun
24299
24300 @defun spam-stat-score-word
24301 Return the spam score for a word.
24302 @end defun
24303
24304 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
24305 Return the spam score for a buffer.
24306 @end defun
24307
24308 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
24309 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
24310 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
24311 @end defun
24312
24313 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
24314 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24315
24316 @lisp
24317 (require 'spam-stat)
24318 (spam-stat-load)
24319 @end lisp
24320
24321 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
24322
24323 @smallexample
24324 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24325 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24326 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24327 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24328 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24329 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24330 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24331 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24332 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24333 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24334 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24335 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24336 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24337 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24338 @end smallexample
24339
24340 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
24341
24342 @smallexample
24343 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24344 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24345 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24346 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
24347 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24348 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24349 @end smallexample
24350
24351 @node Other modes
24352 @section Interaction with other modes
24353
24354 @subsection Dired
24355 @cindex dired
24356
24357 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provided some useful functions for dired
24358 buffers. It is enabled with
24359 @lisp
24360 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
24361 @end lisp
24362
24363 @table @kbd
24364 @item C-c C-m C-a
24365 @findex gnus-dired-attach
24366 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
24367 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
24368
24369 @item C-c C-m C-l
24370 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
24371 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
24372 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
24373 buffer.
24374
24375 @item C-c C-m C-p
24376 @findex gnus-dired-print
24377 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
24378 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
24379 @end table
24380
24381 @node Various Various
24382 @section Various Various
24383 @cindex mode lines
24384 @cindex highlights
24385
24386 @table @code
24387
24388 @item gnus-home-directory
24389 @vindex gnus-home-directory
24390 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
24391 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
24392
24393 @item gnus-directory
24394 @vindex gnus-directory
24395 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
24396 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
24397 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
24398
24399 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
24400 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
24401 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
24402 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
24403
24404 @item gnus-default-directory
24405 @vindex gnus-default-directory
24406 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
24407 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
24408 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
24409 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
24410 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
24411 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
24412
24413 @item gnus-verbose
24414 @vindex gnus-verbose
24415 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
24416 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
24417 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
24418 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
24419 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
24420
24421 @item gnus-verbose-backends
24422 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
24423 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
24424 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
24425
24426 @item nnheader-max-head-length
24427 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
24428 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
24429 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
24430 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
24431 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
24432 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
24433 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
24434 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
24435 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
24436
24437 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
24438 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
24439 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
24440 read when doing the operation described above.
24441
24442 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24443 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24444 @cindex file names
24445 @cindex invalid characters in file names
24446 @cindex characters in file names
24447 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
24448 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
24449 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
24450
24451 @lisp
24452 @group
24453 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24454 '((?: . ?_)))
24455 @end group
24456 @end lisp
24457
24458 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
24459 Windows (phooey) systems.
24460
24461 @item gnus-hidden-properties
24462 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
24463 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
24464 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
24465 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
24466
24467 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
24468 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
24469 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
24470 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
24471 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
24472
24473 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
24474 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
24475 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
24476
24477 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24478 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24479
24480 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
24481 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
24482 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
24483 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
24484 group).
24485
24486 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
24487
24488
24489 @end table
24490
24491 @node The End
24492 @chapter The End
24493
24494 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
24495 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
24496
24497 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
24498
24499 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
24500
24501 @quotation
24502 @strong{Te Deum}
24503
24504 @sp 1
24505 Not because of victories @*
24506 I sing,@*
24507 having none,@*
24508 but for the common sunshine,@*
24509 the breeze,@*
24510 the largess of the spring.
24511
24512 @sp 1
24513 Not for victory@*
24514 but for the day's work done@*
24515 as well as I was able;@*
24516 not for a seat upon the dais@*
24517 but at the common table.@*
24518 @end quotation
24519
24520
24521 @node Appendices
24522 @chapter Appendices
24523
24524 @menu
24525 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
24526 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
24527 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
24528 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
24529 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
24530 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
24531 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
24532 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
24533 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
24534 @end menu
24535
24536
24537 @node XEmacs
24538 @section XEmacs
24539 @cindex XEmacs
24540 @cindex installing under XEmacs
24541
24542 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
24543 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
24544 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
24545 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
24546 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
24547 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
24548
24549
24550 @node History
24551 @section History
24552
24553 @cindex history
24554 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
24555 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
24556
24557 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
24558 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
24559 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
24560 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
24561 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
24562
24563 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
24564 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
24565 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
24566 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
24567 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
24568 appropriate name, don't you think?)
24569
24570 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
24571 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
24572 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
24573 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
24574
24575 @menu
24576 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
24577 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
24578 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
24579 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
24580 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
24581 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
24582 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
24583 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
24584 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
24585 @end menu
24586
24587
24588 @node Gnus Versions
24589 @subsection Gnus Versions
24590 @cindex ding Gnus
24591 @cindex September Gnus
24592 @cindex Red Gnus
24593 @cindex Quassia Gnus
24594 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
24595 @cindex Oort Gnus
24596 @cindex No Gnus
24597 @cindex Gnus versions
24598
24599 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
24600 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
24601 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
24602
24603 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
24604 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
24605
24606 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
24607 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
24608
24609 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
24610 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
24611
24612 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
24613 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
24614 1999.
24615
24616 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
24617 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
24618
24619 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
24620
24621 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
24622 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
24623 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'' -- don't panic.
24624 Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever
24625 you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach.
24626 Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
24627
24628
24629 @node Other Gnus Versions
24630 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
24631 @cindex Semi-gnus
24632
24633 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
24634 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
24635 Japan. It's based on a library called @acronym{SEMI}, which provides
24636 @acronym{MIME} capabilities.
24637
24638 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
24639 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
24640 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
24641 @acronym{MIME} and multilingualization things, especially important for
24642 Japanese users.
24643
24644
24645 @node Why?
24646 @subsection Why?
24647
24648 What's the point of Gnus?
24649
24650 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
24651 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
24652 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
24653 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
24654 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
24655 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
24656 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
24657 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
24658 keep track of millions of people who post?
24659
24660 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
24661 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
24662 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
24663 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
24664 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
24665 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
24666 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
24667 every one of you to explore and invent.
24668
24669 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
24670 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
24671
24672
24673 @node Compatibility
24674 @subsection Compatibility
24675
24676 @cindex compatibility
24677 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
24678 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
24679 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
24680
24681 Our motto is:
24682 @quotation
24683 @cartouche
24684 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
24685 @end cartouche
24686 @end quotation
24687
24688 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
24689 their names.
24690
24691 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
24692 Articles}.
24693
24694 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
24695 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
24696 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
24697 important variables have their values copied into their global
24698 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
24699 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
24700
24701 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
24702 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
24703 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
24704 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
24705 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
24706 peculiar results.
24707
24708 @cindex hilit19
24709 @cindex highlighting
24710 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
24711 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
24712 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
24713 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
24714 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
24715 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
24716 Away!
24717
24718 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
24719 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
24720 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
24721 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
24722
24723 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
24724 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
24725 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
24726 to stop doing it the old way.
24727
24728 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
24729
24730 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
24731 @findex gnus-bug
24732 @cindex reporting bugs
24733 @cindex bugs
24734 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
24735 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
24736 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
24737
24738 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
24739 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
24740 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
24741 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
24742 up at you.
24743
24744
24745 @node Conformity
24746 @subsection Conformity
24747
24748 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
24749 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
24750 with, of course.
24751
24752 @table @strong
24753
24754 @item RFC (2)822
24755 @cindex RFC 822
24756 @cindex RFC 2822
24757 There are no known breaches of this standard.
24758
24759 @item RFC 1036
24760 @cindex RFC 1036
24761 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
24762
24763 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
24764 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
24765 We do have some breaches to this one.
24766
24767 @table @emph
24768
24769 @item X-Newsreader
24770 @itemx User-Agent
24771 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
24772 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
24773 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
24774 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
24775 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
24776 @end table
24777
24778 @item USEFOR
24779 @cindex USEFOR
24780 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
24781 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
24782 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
24783 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
24784
24785 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
24786 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
24787 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
24788
24789 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
24790 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
24791
24792 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
24793 @cindex RFC 1991
24794 @cindex RFC 2440
24795 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
24796 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
24797 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
24798 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
24799 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
24800 decryption).
24801
24802 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
24803 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
24804 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RF 1991/2440 format.
24805 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
24806
24807 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
24808 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
24809
24810 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
24811 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
24812 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
24813 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
24814 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
24815 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
24816 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
24817 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
24818
24819 @end table
24820
24821 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
24822 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
24823 know.
24824
24825
24826 @node Emacsen
24827 @subsection Emacsen
24828 @cindex Emacsen
24829 @cindex XEmacs
24830 @cindex Mule
24831 @cindex Emacs
24832
24833 Gnus should work on:
24834
24835 @itemize @bullet
24836
24837 @item
24838 Emacs 20.7 and up.
24839
24840 @item
24841 XEmacs 21.1 and up.
24842
24843 @end itemize
24844
24845 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
24846 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
24847 Emacs versions.
24848
24849 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
24850 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
24851 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
24852 Emacsen.
24853
24854
24855 @node Gnus Development
24856 @subsection Gnus Development
24857
24858 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
24859 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
24860 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
24861 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
24862 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
24863 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
24864 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
24865 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
24866
24867 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
24868 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
24869 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
24870 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
24871 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
24872
24873 @cindex Incoming*
24874 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
24875 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
24876 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
24877 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
24878 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
24879
24880 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
24881 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
24882 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
24883 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
24884 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
24885 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
24886 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
24887 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
24888 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
24889 can't be assumed to do so.
24890
24891
24892
24893 @node Contributors
24894 @subsection Contributors
24895 @cindex contributors
24896
24897 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
24898 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
24899 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
24900 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
24901 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
24902 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
24903 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
24904 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
24905 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
24906 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
24907
24908 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
24909 wrong show.
24910
24911 @itemize @bullet
24912
24913 @item
24914 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
24915
24916 @item
24917 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
24918 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
24919 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
24920 functionality and stuff.
24921
24922 @item
24923 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
24924 well as numerous other things).
24925
24926 @item
24927 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
24928
24929 @item
24930 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
24931
24932 @item
24933 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
24934
24935 @item
24936 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
24937
24938 @item
24939 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
24940 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
24941
24942 @item
24943 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
24944
24945 @item
24946 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
24947 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
24948
24949 @item
24950 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
24951
24952 @item
24953 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
24954
24955 @item
24956 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
24957
24958 @item
24959 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
24960
24961 @item
24962 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
24963 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
24964
24965 @item
24966 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
24967
24968 @item
24969 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
24970
24971 @item
24972 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
24973
24974 @item
24975 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
24976 .newsrc files.
24977
24978 @item
24979 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
24980
24981 @item
24982 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
24983
24984 @item
24985 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
24986
24987 @item
24988 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
24989 well as autoconf support.
24990
24991 @end itemize
24992
24993 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
24994 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
24995
24996 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
24997
24998 Christopher Davis,
24999 Andrew Eskilsson,
25000 Kai Grossjohann,
25001 Kevin Greiner,
25002 Jesper Harder,
25003 Paul Jarc,
25004 Simon Josefsson,
25005 David KÃ¥gedal,
25006 Richard Pieri,
25007 Fabrice Popineau,
25008 Daniel Quinlan,
25009 Michael Shields,
25010 Reiner Steib,
25011 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
25012 Jack Vinson,
25013 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
25014 and
25015 Teodor Zlatanov.
25016
25017 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
25018
25019 Jari Aalto,
25020 Adrian Aichner,
25021 Vladimir Alexiev,
25022 Russ Allbery,
25023 Peter Arius,
25024 Matt Armstrong,
25025 Marc Auslander,
25026 Miles Bader,
25027 Alexei V. Barantsev,
25028 Frank Bennett,
25029 Robert Bihlmeyer,
25030 Chris Bone,
25031 Mark Borges,
25032 Mark Boyns,
25033 Lance A. Brown,
25034 Rob Browning,
25035 Kees de Bruin,
25036 Martin Buchholz,
25037 Joe Buehler,
25038 Kevin Buhr,
25039 Alastair Burt,
25040 Joao Cachopo,
25041 Zlatko Calusic,
25042 Massimo Campostrini,
25043 Castor,
25044 David Charlap,
25045 Dan Christensen,
25046 Kevin Christian,
25047 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
25048 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
25049 Laura Conrad,
25050 Michael R. Cook,
25051 Glenn Coombs,
25052 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
25053 Neil Crellin,
25054 Frank D. Cringle,
25055 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
25056 Andre Deparade,
25057 Ulrik Dickow,
25058 Dave Disser,
25059 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
25060 Joev Dubach,
25061 Michael Welsh Duggan,
25062 Dave Edmondson,
25063 Paul Eggert,
25064 Mark W. Eichin,
25065 Karl Eichwalder,
25066 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
25067 Michael Ernst,
25068 Luc Van Eycken,
25069 Sam Falkner,
25070 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
25071 Sigbjorn Finne,
25072 Sven Fischer,
25073 Paul Fisher,
25074 Decklin Foster,
25075 Gary D. Foster,
25076 Paul Franklin,
25077 Guy Geens,
25078 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
25079 David S. Goldberg,
25080 Michelangelo Grigni,
25081 Dale Hagglund,
25082 D. Hall,
25083 Magnus Hammerin,
25084 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
25085 Raja R. Harinath,
25086 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
25087 P. E. Jareth Hein,
25088 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
25089 Scott Hofmann,
25090 Marc Horowitz,
25091 Gunnar Horrigmo,
25092 Richard Hoskins,
25093 Brad Howes,
25094 Miguel de Icaza,
25095 François Felix Ingrand,
25096 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
25097 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
25098 Lee Iverson,
25099 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
25100 Rajappa Iyer,
25101 Andreas Jaeger,
25102 Adam P. Jenkins,
25103 Randell Jesup,
25104 Fred Johansen,
25105 Gareth Jones,
25106 Greg Klanderman,
25107 Karl Kleinpaste,
25108 Michael Klingbeil,
25109 Peter Skov Knudsen,
25110 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
25111 Petr Konecny,
25112 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
25113 Thor Kristoffersen,
25114 Jens Lautenbacher,
25115 Martin Larose,
25116 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
25117 Joerg Lenneis,
25118 Carsten Leonhardt,
25119 James LewisMoss,
25120 Christian Limpach,
25121 Markus Linnala,
25122 Dave Love,
25123 Mike McEwan,
25124 Tonny Madsen,
25125 Shlomo Mahlab,
25126 Nat Makarevitch,
25127 Istvan Marko,
25128 David Martin,
25129 Jason R. Mastaler,
25130 Gordon Matzigkeit,
25131 Timo Metzemakers,
25132 Richard Mlynarik,
25133 Lantz Moore,
25134 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
25135 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
25136 Hrvoje Niksic,
25137 Andy Norman,
25138 Fred Oberhauser,
25139 C. R. Oldham,
25140 Alexandre Oliva,
25141 Ken Olstad,
25142 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
25143 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
25144 Ettore Perazzoli,
25145 William Perry,
25146 Stephen Peters,
25147 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
25148 Ulrich Pfeifer,
25149 Matt Pharr,
25150 Andy Piper,
25151 John McClary Prevost,
25152 Bill Pringlemeir,
25153 Mike Pullen,
25154 Jim Radford,
25155 Colin Rafferty,
25156 Lasse Rasinen,
25157 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
25158 Joe Reiss,
25159 Renaud Rioboo,
25160 Roland B. Roberts,
25161 Bart Robinson,
25162 Christian von Roques,
25163 Markus Rost,
25164 Jason Rumney,
25165 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
25166 Jay Sachs,
25167 Dewey M. Sasser,
25168 Conrad Sauerwald,
25169 Loren Schall,
25170 Dan Schmidt,
25171 Ralph Schleicher,
25172 Philippe Schnoebelen,
25173 Andreas Schwab,
25174 Randal L. Schwartz,
25175 Danny Siu,
25176 Matt Simmons,
25177 Paul D. Smith,
25178 Jeff Sparkes,
25179 Toby Speight,
25180 Michael Sperber,
25181 Darren Stalder,
25182 Richard Stallman,
25183 Greg Stark,
25184 Sam Steingold,
25185 Paul Stevenson,
25186 Jonas Steverud,
25187 Paul Stodghill,
25188 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
25189 Kurt Swanson,
25190 Samuel Tardieu,
25191 Teddy,
25192 Chuck Thompson,
25193 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
25194 Philippe Troin,
25195 James Troup,
25196 Trung Tran-Duc,
25197 Jack Twilley,
25198 Aaron M. Ucko,
25199 Aki Vehtari,
25200 Didier Verna,
25201 Vladimir Volovich,
25202 Jan Vroonhof,
25203 Stefan Waldherr,
25204 Pete Ware,
25205 Barry A. Warsaw,
25206 Christoph Wedler,
25207 Joe Wells,
25208 Lee Willis,
25209 and
25210 Lloyd Zusman.
25211
25212
25213 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
25214 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
25215 (550kB and counting).
25216
25217 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
25218 sure.
25219
25220 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
25221 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
25222
25223
25224 @node New Features
25225 @subsection New Features
25226 @cindex new features
25227
25228 @menu
25229 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
25230 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
25231 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
25232 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
25233 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
25234 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
25235 @end menu
25236
25237 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
25238 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
25239 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
25240
25241 @node ding Gnus
25242 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
25243
25244 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
25245
25246 @itemize @bullet
25247
25248 @item
25249 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
25250 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
25251
25252 @item
25253 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
25254 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
25255
25256 @item
25257 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
25258
25259 @item
25260 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
25261 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
25262 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
25263
25264 @item
25265 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
25266 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
25267 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
25268 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25269
25270 @item
25271 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
25272 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25273
25274 @item
25275 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
25276 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
25277 (@pxref{The Active File}).
25278
25279 @item
25280 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
25281 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
25282
25283 @item
25284 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
25285 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
25286 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25287
25288 @item
25289 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
25290 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
25291 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
25292
25293 @item
25294 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
25295 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
25296
25297 @item
25298 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
25299 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
25300
25301 @item
25302 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
25303 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
25304
25305 @item
25306 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
25307 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25308
25309 @item
25310 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
25311 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
25312
25313 @item
25314 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
25315 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25316
25317 @item
25318 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
25319
25320 @item
25321 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
25322 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
25323
25324 @item
25325 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
25326 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
25327
25328 @item
25329 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
25330 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25331
25332 @item
25333 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
25334
25335 @item
25336 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
25337 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25338
25339 @item
25340 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
25341 Articles}).
25342
25343 @item
25344 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
25345 Buttons}).
25346
25347 @item
25348 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
25349 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
25350
25351 @item
25352 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
25353 (@pxref{Buttons}).
25354
25355 @end itemize
25356
25357
25358 @node September Gnus
25359 @subsubsection September Gnus
25360
25361 @iftex
25362 @iflatex
25363 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
25364 @end iflatex
25365 @end iftex
25366
25367 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
25368
25369 @itemize @bullet
25370
25371 @item
25372 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
25373 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
25374 now obsolete.
25375
25376 @item
25377 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
25378 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
25379 Threading}).
25380
25381 @lisp
25382 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
25383 @end lisp
25384
25385 @item
25386 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
25387 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
25388
25389 @item
25390 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
25391 referred.
25392
25393 @item
25394 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25395
25396 @item
25397 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
25398
25399 @item
25400 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
25401
25402 @lisp
25403 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
25404 @end lisp
25405
25406 @item
25407 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
25408 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
25409
25410 @lisp
25411 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
25412 @end lisp
25413
25414 @item
25415 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
25416 Groups}).
25417
25418 @item
25419 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
25420 Topics}).
25421
25422 @lisp
25423 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
25424 @end lisp
25425
25426 @item
25427 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
25428
25429 @item
25430 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
25431 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
25432
25433 @lisp
25434 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
25435 @end lisp
25436
25437 @item
25438 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
25439 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
25440
25441 @item
25442 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
25443
25444 @item
25445 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
25446 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
25447 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25448
25449 @item
25450 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
25451 (@pxref{SOUP}).
25452
25453 @item
25454 The Gnus cache is much faster.
25455
25456 @item
25457 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
25458 Groups}).
25459
25460 @item
25461 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
25462 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
25463
25464 @item
25465 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
25466 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
25467
25468 @item
25469 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
25470 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
25471
25472 @item
25473 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
25474 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
25475 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
25476
25477 @item
25478 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
25479 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
25480
25481 @item
25482 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
25483
25484 @item
25485 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25486
25487 @item
25488 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
25489
25490 @item
25491 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
25492
25493 @item
25494 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
25495 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
25496
25497 @item
25498 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
25499 Layout}).
25500
25501 @item
25502 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
25503 @iftex
25504 @iflatex
25505 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
25506 @end iflatex
25507 @end iftex
25508
25509 @item
25510 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
25511
25512 @lisp
25513 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
25514 @end lisp
25515
25516 @item
25517 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25518
25519 @lisp
25520 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
25521 @end lisp
25522
25523 @item
25524 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
25525
25526 @item
25527 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
25528
25529 @item
25530 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
25531 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25532
25533 @lisp
25534 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
25535 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
25536 @end lisp
25537
25538 @item
25539 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
25540 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
25541
25542 @lisp
25543 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
25544 @end lisp
25545
25546 @item
25547 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
25548 buffer to allow easier treatment.
25549
25550 @item
25551 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
25552
25553 @item
25554 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
25555 Articles}).
25556
25557 @lisp
25558 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
25559 @end lisp
25560
25561 @item
25562 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
25563 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
25564
25565 @lisp
25566 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
25567 @end lisp
25568
25569 @item
25570 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
25571 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25572
25573 @item
25574 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
25575 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25576
25577 @lisp
25578 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
25579 @end lisp
25580
25581 @item
25582 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25583
25584 @item
25585 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
25586
25587 @item
25588 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
25589
25590 @end itemize
25591
25592
25593 @node Red Gnus
25594 @subsubsection Red Gnus
25595
25596 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
25597
25598 @iftex
25599 @iflatex
25600 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
25601 @end iflatex
25602 @end iftex
25603
25604 @itemize @bullet
25605
25606 @item
25607 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
25608
25609 @item
25610 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
25611 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25612
25613 @item
25614 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
25615 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
25616 Scoring}).
25617
25618 @item
25619 Article washing status can be displayed in the
25620 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
25621
25622 @item
25623 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
25624
25625 @item
25626 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
25627 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
25628
25629 @lisp
25630 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
25631 @end lisp
25632
25633 @item
25634 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
25635 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
25636 been added.
25637
25638 @item
25639 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
25640 Server Internals}).
25641
25642 @item
25643 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
25644 Parameters}).
25645
25646 @item
25647 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
25648
25649 @item
25650 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
25651 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
25652
25653 @item
25654 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
25655 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
25656 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
25657
25658 @item
25659 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
25660 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25661
25662 @item
25663 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
25664 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
25665
25666 @item
25667 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
25668 (@pxref{Undo}).
25669
25670 @item
25671 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
25672 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25673
25674 @item
25675 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
25676 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25677
25678 @lisp
25679 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
25680 @end lisp
25681
25682 @item
25683 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
25684
25685 @lisp
25686 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
25687 @end lisp
25688
25689 @item
25690 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
25691 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25692
25693 @item
25694 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
25695 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25696
25697 @item
25698 A new command for reading collections of documents
25699 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
25700 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
25701
25702 @item
25703 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
25704 Marks}).
25705
25706 @item
25707 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
25708 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
25709
25710 @item
25711 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
25712 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
25713 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
25714
25715 @item
25716 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
25717 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
25718 Sorting}).
25719
25720 @item
25721 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
25722 Groups}).
25723
25724 @item
25725 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
25726 Commands}).
25727 @iftex
25728 @iflatex
25729 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
25730 @end iflatex
25731 @end iftex
25732
25733 @item
25734 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
25735 Variables}).
25736
25737 @item
25738 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
25739 Mail}).
25740
25741 @item
25742 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
25743 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
25744
25745 @item
25746 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
25747
25748 @end itemize
25749
25750
25751 @node Quassia Gnus
25752 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
25753
25754 New features in Gnus 5.6:
25755
25756 @itemize @bullet
25757
25758 @item
25759 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
25760 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
25761 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
25762
25763 @item
25764 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
25765 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
25766 group, which is created automatically.
25767
25768 @item
25769 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
25770 values.
25771
25772 @item
25773 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
25774
25775 @item
25776 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
25777 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
25778
25779 @item
25780 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
25781 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
25782
25783 @item
25784 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
25785
25786 @item
25787 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
25788 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
25789
25790 @item
25791 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
25792
25793 @item
25794 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
25795 details.
25796
25797 @item
25798 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
25799 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
25800
25801 @item
25802 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
25803 control over simplification.
25804
25805 @item
25806 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
25807
25808 @item
25809 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
25810 limit.
25811
25812 @item
25813 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
25814
25815 @item
25816 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
25817
25818 @item
25819 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
25820 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
25821 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
25822
25823 @item
25824 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
25825 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
25826
25827 @item
25828 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
25829 text---@kbd{W d}.
25830
25831 @item
25832 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
25833 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
25834
25835 @item
25836 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
25837 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
25838
25839 @item
25840 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
25841 has been added.
25842
25843 @item
25844 A history of where mails have been split is available.
25845
25846 @item
25847 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
25848
25849 @item
25850 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
25851 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
25852
25853 @item
25854 A new function for citing in Message has been
25855 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
25856
25857 @item
25858 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
25859
25860 @item
25861 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
25862 been added.
25863
25864 @item
25865 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
25866 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
25867
25868 @item
25869 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
25870 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
25871
25872 @item
25873 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
25874
25875 @item
25876 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
25877
25878 @end itemize
25879
25880 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
25881 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
25882
25883 New features in Gnus 5.8:
25884
25885 @itemize @bullet
25886
25887 @item
25888 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
25889 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
25890
25891 If you used procmail like in
25892
25893 @lisp
25894 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
25895 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
25896 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
25897 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
25898 @end lisp
25899
25900 this now has changed to
25901
25902 @lisp
25903 (setq mail-sources
25904 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
25905 :suffix ".in")))
25906 @end lisp
25907
25908 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
25909
25910 @item
25911 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
25912 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
25913
25914 @item
25915 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
25916 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
25917
25918 @item
25919 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
25920 called to position point.
25921
25922 @item
25923 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
25924 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
25925
25926 @item
25927 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
25928 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
25929
25930 @item
25931 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
25932 subtly different manner.
25933
25934 @item
25935 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
25936 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
25937 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
25938
25939 @item
25940 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
25941
25942 @end itemize
25943
25944 @node Oort Gnus
25945 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
25946 @cindex Oort Gnus
25947
25948 New features in Gnus 5.10:
25949
25950 @itemize @bullet
25951
25952 @item
25953 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
25954 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
25955 region if the region is active.
25956
25957 @item
25958 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
25959 using @kbd{G M}.
25960
25961 @item
25962 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
25963 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
25964
25965 @item
25966 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
25967 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
25968
25969 @item
25970 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
25971
25972 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
25973 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
25974 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
25975 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
25976 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
25977 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
25978 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
25979 isn't save in general.
25980
25981 @item
25982 Article Buttons
25983
25984 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
25985 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
25986 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
25987 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
25988
25989 @item
25990 Dired integration
25991
25992 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
25993 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
25994 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
25995 entry.
25996
25997 @item
25998 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
25999
26000 @item
26001 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
26002
26003 @item
26004 Picons
26005
26006 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
26007 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
26008
26009 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
26010 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
26011 @xref{Picons}.
26012
26013 @item
26014 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
26015 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
26016
26017 @item
26018 Retrieval of charters and control messages
26019
26020 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
26021 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
26022
26023 @item
26024 Delayed articles
26025
26026 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
26027 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
26028 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
26029
26030 @item
26031 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
26032 decompressed when activated.
26033
26034 @item
26035 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
26036 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
26037
26038 @item
26039 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
26040
26041 @item
26042 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
26043 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
26044
26045 @item
26046 Warn about email replies to news
26047
26048 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
26049 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
26050 you.
26051
26052 @item
26053 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
26054 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
26055 built.
26056
26057 @item
26058 The new @code{recent} mark @samp{.} indicates newly arrived messages (as
26059 opposed to old but unread messages).
26060
26061 @item
26062 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
26063 Gcc articles as read.
26064
26065 @item
26066 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
26067
26068 @item
26069 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
26070 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
26071
26072 @item
26073 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
26074 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
26075
26076 @item
26077 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
26078 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
26079
26080 @item
26081 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
26082 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
26083
26084 @item
26085 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
26086
26087 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
26088 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GNUTLS. The old
26089 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} support via (external third party)
26090 @file{ssl.el} and OpenSSL still works.
26091
26092 @item
26093 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
26094
26095 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
26096 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
26097 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, iff you want
26098 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
26099 the second parameter.
26100
26101 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
26102 automatic recognition of XEmacs and GNU Emacs, generates
26103 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
26104 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
26105 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
26106 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
26107 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
26108 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
26109 cycle used under Unix systems.
26110
26111 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} superfluous, so it has
26112 been removed.
26113
26114 @item
26115 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
26116
26117 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
26118 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
26119 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
26120 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
26121 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
26122 controls this.
26123
26124 @item
26125 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
26126
26127 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
26128 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
26129 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
26130 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
26131 citations.
26132
26133 @item
26134 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
26135
26136 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
26137 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
26138 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
26139 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
26140
26141 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
26142 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
26143 message cited below.
26144
26145 @item
26146 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
26147
26148 @item
26149 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
26150
26151 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
26152 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
26153 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
26154 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
26155 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
26156 parameters, a'la:
26157 @lisp
26158 (setq gnus-parameters
26159 '(("mail\\..*"
26160 (gnus-show-threads nil)
26161 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
26162 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
26163 (to-group . "\\1"))))
26164 @end lisp
26165
26166 @item
26167 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now iconized for Emacs too.
26168
26169 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
26170 disable it.
26171
26172 @item
26173 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
26174
26175 Earlier it was generated iff the user configurable email address was
26176 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
26177 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
26178 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
26179 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
26180 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
26181 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
26182 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
26183 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
26184
26185 @item
26186 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
26187
26188 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
26189 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
26190 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
26191 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
26192 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
26193 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
26194
26195 @item
26196 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
26197 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
26198 @code{nil}.
26199
26200 @item
26201 Improved anti-spam features.
26202
26203 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
26204 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
26205 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
26206 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
26207 are also new. @xref{Thwarting Email Spam}.
26208
26209 @item
26210 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers.
26211
26212 @item
26213 Face headers handling.
26214
26215 @item
26216 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
26217 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
26218
26219 @item
26220 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
26221
26222 @item
26223 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
26224
26225 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
26226 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
26227 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
26228 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
26229 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
26230 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
26231 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
26232 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
26233 when getting new mail, remove the function.
26234
26235 @item
26236 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
26237
26238 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
26239 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
26240 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
26241 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
26242 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
26243 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
26244 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
26245 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
26246 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
26247 was inserted directly.
26248
26249 @item
26250 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
26251
26252 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
26253 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
26254 hierarchy.
26255
26256 @item
26257 @code{gnus-agent}
26258
26259 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
26260 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
26261 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
26262 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
26263 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
26264 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
26265 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
26266 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
26267 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
26268 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
26269 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
26270 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
26271 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
26272 is not needed any more.
26273
26274 @item
26275 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
26276
26277 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
26278 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
26279 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
26280 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
26281 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
26282 groups.
26283
26284 @item
26285 @file{deuglify.el} (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article})
26286
26287 A new file from Raymond Scholz @email{rscholz@@zonix.de} for deuglifying
26288 broken Outlook (Express) articles.
26289
26290 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
26291 @c CVS. We should find a better place for this item.
26292 @item
26293 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
26294
26295 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
26296 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
26297 lisp directory into load-path.
26298
26299 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
26300 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
26301
26302 @item
26303 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
26304
26305 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
26306
26307 @item
26308 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
26309
26310 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
26311 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
26312 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
26313 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
26314
26315 @item
26316 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
26317
26318 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
26319 @lisp
26320 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
26321 'bbdb-complete-name)
26322 @end lisp
26323
26324 @item
26325 Externalizing and deleting of attachments.
26326
26327 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
26328 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
26329 local files as external parts.
26330
26331 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
26332 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
26333 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
26334 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
26335 that support editing.
26336
26337 @item
26338 @code{gnus-default-charset}
26339
26340 The default value is determined from the
26341 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
26342 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
26343 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
26344
26345 @item
26346 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
26347
26348 Add a new format of match like
26349 @lisp
26350 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
26351 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26352 @end lisp
26353 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
26354 @lisp
26355 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
26356 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26357 @end lisp
26358
26359 @item
26360 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
26361
26362 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
26363 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
26364 need add those two headers too.
26365
26366 @item
26367 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
26368
26369 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
26370 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
26371 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
26372
26373 @item
26374 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
26375 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
26376 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
26377 versions.
26378
26379 @item
26380 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
26381 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
26382 inline PGP signed messages. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
26383
26384 @item
26385 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
26386
26387 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
26388
26389 @item
26390 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
26391
26392 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
26393
26394 @item
26395 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
26396
26397 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
26398 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
26399 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
26400
26401 @item
26402 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
26403
26404 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
26405 the valid values.
26406
26407 @item
26408 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
26409
26410 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
26411 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
26412 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
26413 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
26414 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
26415 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
26416 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
26417 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
26418
26419 @item
26420 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
26421
26422 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
26423 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
26424 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
26425 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
26426 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
26427
26428 @item
26429 Extended format specs.
26430
26431 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
26432 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
26433 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
26434 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
26435 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
26436 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
26437
26438 @item
26439 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
26440
26441 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
26442 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
26443 out other articles.
26444
26445 @item
26446 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
26447
26448 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
26449 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
26450 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
26451 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
26452
26453 @item
26454 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
26455
26456 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
26457 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
26458 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
26459
26460 @item
26461 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
26462
26463 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
26464 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
26465 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
26466 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
26467 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
26468 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
26469 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
26470 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
26471 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
26472 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
26473 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
26474
26475 @item
26476 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
26477 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
26478
26479 @item
26480 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
26481 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
26482 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
26483 message, Message Manual}).
26484
26485 @item
26486 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
26487 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
26488
26489 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
26490 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
26491 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
26492 @lisp
26493 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
26494 @end lisp
26495
26496 @item
26497 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
26498 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
26499
26500 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
26501 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
26502 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
26503 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
26504
26505 @item
26506 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
26507
26508 @item
26509 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
26510 C-m}.
26511
26512 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
26513 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
26514
26515 @item
26516 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to symbol @code{best}.
26517
26518 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
26519 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
26520 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
26521 invalidate the digital signature.
26522 @end itemize
26523
26524 @iftex
26525
26526 @page
26527 @node The Manual
26528 @section The Manual
26529 @cindex colophon
26530 @cindex manual
26531
26532 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
26533 either @code{texi2dvi}
26534 @iflatex
26535 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
26536 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
26537 @end iflatex
26538 to get what you hold in your hands now.
26539
26540 The following conventions have been used:
26541
26542 @enumerate
26543
26544 @item
26545 This is a @samp{string}
26546
26547 @item
26548 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
26549
26550 @item
26551 This is a @file{file}
26552
26553 @item
26554 This is a @code{symbol}
26555
26556 @end enumerate
26557
26558 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
26559 mean:
26560
26561 @lisp
26562 (setq flargnoze "yes")
26563 @end lisp
26564
26565 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
26566
26567 @lisp
26568 (setq flumphel 'yes)
26569 @end lisp
26570
26571 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
26572 ever get them confused.
26573
26574 @iflatex
26575 @c @head
26576 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
26577 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
26578 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
26579 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
26580 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
26581 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
26582 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
26583 @end iflatex
26584
26585 @end iftex
26586
26587
26588 @node On Writing Manuals
26589 @section On Writing Manuals
26590
26591 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
26592 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
26593 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
26594 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
26595 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
26596 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code goes
26597 hand in hand.
26598
26599 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
26600 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
26601 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
26602 started with Gnus.
26603
26604 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
26605 reference manual as source material. It would look quite differently.
26606
26607
26608 @page
26609 @node Terminology
26610 @section Terminology
26611
26612 @cindex terminology
26613 @table @dfn
26614
26615 @item news
26616 @cindex news
26617 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
26618 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
26619 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
26620 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
26621 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
26622
26623 @item mail
26624 @cindex mail
26625 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
26626 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
26627 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
26628 not posting, and replying is not following up.
26629
26630 @item reply
26631 @cindex reply
26632 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
26633
26634 @item follow up
26635 @cindex follow up
26636 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
26637 are reading.
26638
26639 @item back end
26640 @cindex back end
26641 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
26642 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
26643 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
26644 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
26645 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
26646 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
26647 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
26648 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
26649 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
26650 number 4711''.
26651
26652 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
26653 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
26654 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
26655 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
26656 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
26657 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
26658
26659 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
26660 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
26661 access the articles.
26662
26663 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
26664 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
26665 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
26666 confusing.
26667
26668 @item native
26669 @cindex native
26670 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
26671 default, way of getting news.
26672
26673 @item foreign
26674 @cindex foreign
26675 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
26676 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
26677 news.
26678
26679 @item secondary
26680 @cindex secondary
26681 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
26682 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
26683
26684 @item article
26685 @cindex article
26686 A message that has been posted as news.
26687
26688 @item mail message
26689 @cindex mail message
26690 A message that has been mailed.
26691
26692 @item message
26693 @cindex message
26694 A mail message or news article
26695
26696 @item head
26697 @cindex head
26698 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
26699 put.
26700
26701 @item body
26702 @cindex body
26703 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
26704 body.
26705
26706 @item header
26707 @cindex header
26708 A line from the head of an article.
26709
26710 @item headers
26711 @cindex headers
26712 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
26713 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
26714
26715 @item @acronym{NOV}
26716 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
26717 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
26718 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
26719 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
26720 normal @sc{head} format.
26721
26722 @item level
26723 @cindex levels
26724 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
26725 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
26726 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
26727 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
26728 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
26729 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
26730
26731 @item killed groups
26732 @cindex killed groups
26733 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
26734 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
26735
26736 @item zombie groups
26737 @cindex zombie groups
26738 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
26739
26740 @item active file
26741 @cindex active file
26742 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
26743 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
26744 is rather large, as you might surmise.
26745
26746 @item bogus groups
26747 @cindex bogus groups
26748 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
26749 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
26750 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
26751
26752 @item activating
26753 @cindex activating groups
26754 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
26755 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
26756 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
26757
26758 @item spool
26759 @cindex spool
26760 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
26761 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
26762 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
26763
26764 @item server
26765 @cindex server
26766 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
26767
26768 @item select method
26769 @cindex select method
26770 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
26771 server settings.
26772
26773 @item virtual server
26774 @cindex virtual server
26775 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
26776 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
26777 whole is a virtual server.
26778
26779 @item washing
26780 @cindex washing
26781 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
26782 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
26783 original.
26784
26785 @item ephemeral groups
26786 @cindex ephemeral groups
26787 @cindex temporary groups
26788 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
26789 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
26790 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
26791
26792 @item solid groups
26793 @cindex solid groups
26794 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
26795 group buffer are solid groups.
26796
26797 @item sparse articles
26798 @cindex sparse articles
26799 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
26800 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
26801
26802 @item threading
26803 @cindex threading
26804 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
26805 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
26806
26807 @item root
26808 @cindex root
26809 @cindex thread root
26810 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
26811 articles in the thread.
26812
26813 @item parent
26814 @cindex parent
26815 An article that has responses.
26816
26817 @item child
26818 @cindex child
26819 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
26820
26821 @item digest
26822 @cindex digest
26823 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
26824 specified by RFC 1153.
26825
26826 @item splitting
26827 @cindex splitting, terminolgy
26828 @cindex mail sorting
26829 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
26830 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
26831 incorrectly called mail filtering.
26832
26833 @end table
26834
26835
26836 @page
26837 @node Customization
26838 @section Customization
26839 @cindex general customization
26840
26841 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
26842 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
26843 for some quite common situations.
26844
26845 @menu
26846 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
26847 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
26848 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
26849 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
26850 @end menu
26851
26852
26853 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
26854 @subsection Slow/Expensive NNTP Connection
26855
26856 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
26857 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
26858 Gnus has to get from the @acronym{NNTP} server.
26859
26860 @table @code
26861
26862 @item gnus-read-active-file
26863 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
26864 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
26865 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
26866 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
26867 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
26868
26869 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
26870 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
26871 the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast. Not all @acronym{NNTP} servers
26872 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
26873 @end table
26874
26875
26876 @node Slow Terminal Connection
26877 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
26878
26879 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
26880 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
26881 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
26882
26883 @table @code
26884
26885 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
26886 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
26887 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
26888 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
26889 horizontal and vertical recentering.
26890
26891 @item gnus-visible-headers
26892 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
26893 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
26894 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
26895 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
26896
26897 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
26898 @lisp
26899 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
26900 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
26901 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
26902 @end lisp
26903
26904 @item gnus-use-full-window
26905 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
26906 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
26907 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
26908 want to read them anyway.
26909
26910 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
26911 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
26912 hidden initially.
26913
26914
26915 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
26916 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
26917 lines, which might save some time.
26918 @end table
26919
26920
26921 @node Little Disk Space
26922 @subsection Little Disk Space
26923 @cindex disk space
26924
26925 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
26926 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
26927
26928 @table @code
26929
26930 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
26931 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
26932 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
26933 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
26934 default.
26935
26936 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
26937 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
26938 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
26939 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
26940 default.
26941
26942 @item gnus-save-killed-list
26943 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
26944 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
26945 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
26946 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
26947
26948 @end table
26949
26950
26951 @node Slow Machine
26952 @subsection Slow Machine
26953 @cindex slow machine
26954
26955 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
26956 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
26957
26958 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
26959 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
26960
26961 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
26962 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
26963 summary buffer faster.
26964
26965
26966 @page
26967 @node Troubleshooting
26968 @section Troubleshooting
26969 @cindex troubleshooting
26970
26971 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
26972 problems, really.
26973
26974 Ahem.
26975
26976 @enumerate
26977
26978 @item
26979 Make sure your computer is switched on.
26980
26981 @item
26982 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
26983 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
26984 Gnus will work.
26985
26986 @item
26987 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
26988 like @samp{Gnus v5.10.6} you have the right files loaded. Otherwise
26989 you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
26990
26991 @item
26992 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
26993 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
26994
26995 @item
26996 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
26997 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
26998 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
26999 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
27000 something like that.
27001 @end enumerate
27002
27003 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
27004
27005 @cindex bugs
27006 @cindex reporting bugs
27007
27008 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
27009 @findex gnus-bug
27010 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
27011 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
27012 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
27013 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
27014
27015 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
27016 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
27017 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
27018 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
27019 time.
27020
27021 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
27022 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
27023 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
27024 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
27025 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
27026 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
27027
27028 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
27029 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
27030 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
27031 the bug report.
27032
27033 @cindex patches
27034 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
27035 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
27036
27037 @cindex edebug
27038 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
27039 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
27040 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
27041 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
27042 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
27043 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
27044 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
27045 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
27046 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
27047 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
27048 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
27049 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
27050 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
27051 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
27052
27053 @cindex elp
27054 @cindex profile
27055 @cindex slow
27056 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
27057 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
27058 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
27059 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
27060 helps isolating the real problem areas).
27061
27062 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
27063 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
27064 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
27065 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
27066 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
27067 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
27068 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
27069 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
27070 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
27071 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
27072 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
27073 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
27074 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
27075 work perfectly.
27076
27077 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
27078 @cindex ding mailing list
27079 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
27080 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
27081 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
27082 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
27083
27084
27085 @page
27086 @node Gnus Reference Guide
27087 @section Gnus Reference Guide
27088
27089 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
27090 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
27091 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
27092 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
27093 it.
27094
27095 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
27096 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
27097 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
27098 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
27099 and general methods of operation.
27100
27101 @menu
27102 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
27103 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
27104 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
27105 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
27106 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
27107 * Group Info:: The group info format.
27108 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
27109 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
27110 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
27111 @end menu
27112
27113
27114 @node Gnus Utility Functions
27115 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
27116 @cindex Gnus utility functions
27117 @cindex utility functions
27118 @cindex functions
27119 @cindex internal variables
27120
27121 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
27122 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
27123 Below is a list of the most common ones.
27124
27125 @table @code
27126
27127 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
27128 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
27129 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
27130
27131 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
27132 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
27133 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
27134
27135 @item gnus-group-real-name
27136 @findex gnus-group-real-name
27137 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
27138 name.
27139
27140 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
27141 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
27142 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
27143 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
27144
27145 @item gnus-get-info
27146 @findex gnus-get-info
27147 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
27148
27149 @item gnus-group-unread
27150 @findex gnus-group-unread
27151 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
27152 unknown.
27153
27154 @item gnus-active
27155 @findex gnus-active
27156 The active entry for @var{group}.
27157
27158 @item gnus-set-active
27159 @findex gnus-set-active
27160 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
27161
27162 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27163 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27164 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
27165 exit.
27166
27167 @item gnus-continuum-version
27168 @findex gnus-continuum-version
27169 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
27170 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
27171 versions.
27172
27173 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
27174 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
27175 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
27176
27177 @item gnus-news-group-p
27178 @findex gnus-news-group-p
27179 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
27180
27181 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27182 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27183 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
27184
27185 @item gnus-server-to-method
27186 @findex gnus-server-to-method
27187 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
27188
27189 @item gnus-server-equal
27190 @findex gnus-server-equal
27191 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
27192
27193 @item gnus-group-native-p
27194 @findex gnus-group-native-p
27195 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
27196
27197 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
27198 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
27199 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
27200
27201 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
27202 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
27203 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
27204
27205 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
27206 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
27207 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
27208 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
27209
27210 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
27211 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
27212 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
27213
27214 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
27215 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
27216 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
27217
27218 @item gnus-check-backend-function
27219 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
27220 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
27221 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
27222
27223 @lisp
27224 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
27225 @result{} t
27226 @end lisp
27227
27228 @item gnus-read-method
27229 @findex gnus-read-method
27230 Prompts the user for a select method.
27231
27232 @end table
27233
27234
27235 @node Back End Interface
27236 @subsection Back End Interface
27237
27238 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
27239 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
27240 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
27241 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
27242 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
27243 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
27244
27245 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
27246 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
27247 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
27248 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
27249 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
27250 been opened, the function should fail.
27251
27252 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
27253 name. Take this example:
27254
27255 @lisp
27256 (nntp "odd-one"
27257 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
27258 (nntp-port-number 4324))
27259 @end lisp
27260
27261 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
27262 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
27263
27264 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
27265 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
27266 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
27267
27268 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
27269 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
27270 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
27271
27272 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
27273 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
27274 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
27275 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
27276 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
27277 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
27278 return value.
27279
27280 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
27281 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
27282 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
27283 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
27284 more.
27285
27286 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
27287 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
27288 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
27289 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
27290 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
27291 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
27292 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
27293 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
27294 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
27295 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
27296
27297 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
27298 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
27299 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
27300 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
27301 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
27302 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
27303 of numbers as long as possible.
27304
27305 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
27306 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
27307 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
27308
27309 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
27310 @code{nnchoke}.
27311
27312 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
27313
27314 @menu
27315 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
27316 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
27317 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
27318 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
27319 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
27320 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
27321 @end menu
27322
27323
27324 @node Required Back End Functions
27325 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
27326
27327 @table @code
27328
27329 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
27330
27331 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
27332 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
27333 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
27334 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
27335
27336 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
27337 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
27338 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
27339 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
27340
27341 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
27342 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
27343 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
27344 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
27345 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
27346 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
27347 number, do maximum fetches.
27348
27349 Here's an example HEAD:
27350
27351 @example
27352 221 1056 Article retrieved.
27353 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
27354 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
27355 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
27356 Subject: Re: Something very droll
27357 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
27358 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
27359 Lines: 26
27360 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
27361 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
27362 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
27363 .
27364 @end example
27365
27366 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
27367 these in the data buffer.
27368
27369 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
27370
27371 @example
27372 headers = *head
27373 head = error / valid-head
27374 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
27375 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
27376 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
27377 header = <text> eol
27378 @end example
27379
27380 @cindex BNF
27381 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
27382
27383 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
27384 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
27385 separated by tabs.
27386
27387 @example
27388 nov-buffer = *nov-line
27389 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
27390 field = <text except TAB>
27391 @end example
27392
27393 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
27394 @pxref{Headers}.
27395
27396
27397 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
27398
27399 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
27400 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
27401
27402 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
27403 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
27404 server. In fact, it should do so.
27405
27406 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
27407 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
27408
27409
27410 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
27411
27412 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
27413 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
27414 reason.
27415
27416 There should be no data returned.
27417
27418
27419 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
27420
27421 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
27422 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
27423 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
27424 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
27425
27426 There should be no data returned.
27427
27428
27429 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
27430
27431 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
27432 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
27433 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
27434 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
27435
27436 There should be no data returned.
27437
27438
27439 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
27440
27441 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
27442
27443 There should be no data returned.
27444
27445
27446 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
27447
27448 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
27449 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
27450 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
27451 it would be nice if that were possible.
27452
27453 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
27454 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
27455 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
27456 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
27457 into its article buffer.
27458
27459 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
27460 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
27461 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
27462 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
27463 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
27464 on successful article retrieval.
27465
27466
27467 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
27468
27469 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
27470 making @var{group} the current group.
27471
27472 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
27473 the current group.
27474
27475 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
27476
27477 @example
27478 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
27479 @end example
27480
27481 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
27482 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
27483 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
27484 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
27485 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
27486 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
27487 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
27488 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
27489 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
27490 highest as 0.
27491
27492 @example
27493 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
27494 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
27495 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
27496 @end example
27497
27498
27499 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27500
27501 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
27502 a no-op on most back ends.
27503
27504 There should be no data returned.
27505
27506
27507 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
27508
27509 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
27510 @emph{all}.
27511
27512 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
27513
27514 @example
27515 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
27516 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
27517 @end example
27518
27519 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
27520 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
27521 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
27522 and the highest as 0.
27523
27524 @example
27525 active-file = *active-line
27526 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
27527 name = <string>
27528 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
27529 @end example
27530
27531 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
27532 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
27533 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
27534
27535
27536 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
27537
27538 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
27539 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
27540 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
27541 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
27542 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
27543 clear if the posting could not be completed.
27544
27545 There should be no result data from this function.
27546
27547 @end table
27548
27549
27550 @node Optional Back End Functions
27551 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
27552
27553 @table @code
27554
27555 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
27556
27557 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
27558 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
27559 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
27560
27561 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
27562 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
27563 former is in the same format as the data from
27564 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
27565 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
27566
27567 @example
27568 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
27569 @end example
27570
27571
27572 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
27573
27574 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
27575 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
27576 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
27577 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
27578 should return a non-@code{nil} value.
27579
27580 There should be no result data from this function.
27581
27582
27583 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
27584
27585 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
27586 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
27587 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
27588 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
27589 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
27590 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
27591 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
27592 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
27593
27594 There should be no result data from this function.
27595
27596
27597 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
27598
27599 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
27600 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
27601 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
27602 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
27603 propagate the mark information to the server.
27604
27605 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
27606
27607 @example
27608 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
27609 @end example
27610
27611 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
27612 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
27613 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
27614 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
27615 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
27616 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend},
27617 @code{forward} and @code{recent}, but your back end should, if
27618 possible, not limit itself to these.
27619
27620 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
27621 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
27622 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
27623 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
27624
27625 An example action list:
27626
27627 @example
27628 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
27629 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
27630 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
27631 @end example
27632
27633 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
27634 mark on (currently not used for anything).
27635
27636 There should be no result data from this function.
27637
27638 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
27639
27640 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
27641 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
27642 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
27643 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
27644 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
27645
27646 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
27647 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
27648 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
27649 expirable.
27650
27651 There should be no result data from this function.
27652
27653
27654 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
27655
27656 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
27657 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
27658 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
27659 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
27660 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
27661 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
27662 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
27663 local if that's practical.
27664
27665 There should be no result data from this function.
27666
27667
27668 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
27669
27670 The result data from this function should be a description of
27671 @var{group}.
27672
27673 @example
27674 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
27675 name = <string>
27676 description = <text>
27677 @end example
27678
27679 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
27680
27681 The result data from this function should be the description of all
27682 groups available on the server.
27683
27684 @example
27685 description-buffer = *description-line
27686 @end example
27687
27688
27689 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
27690
27691 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
27692 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
27693 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
27694 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
27695 in the active buffer format.
27696
27697 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
27698 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
27699 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
27700 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
27701 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
27702 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
27703 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
27704
27705
27706 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27707
27708 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
27709
27710 There should be no return data.
27711
27712
27713 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
27714
27715 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
27716 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
27717 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
27718 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
27719 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
27720 they are.
27721
27722 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
27723 able to delete.
27724
27725 There should be no result data returned.
27726
27727
27728 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
27729
27730 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
27731 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
27732
27733 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
27734 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
27735 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
27736 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
27737 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
27738 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
27739
27740 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
27741 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
27742 optimizations.
27743
27744 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27745 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27746
27747 There should be no data returned.
27748
27749
27750 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
27751
27752 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
27753 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
27754 this function in short order.
27755
27756 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27757 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27758
27759 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
27760 article for that group.
27761
27762 There should be no data returned.
27763
27764
27765 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
27766
27767 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
27768 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
27769
27770 There should be no data returned.
27771
27772
27773 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
27774
27775 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
27776 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
27777 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
27778
27779 There should be no data returned.
27780
27781
27782 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
27783
27784 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
27785 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
27786
27787 There should be no data returned.
27788
27789 @end table
27790
27791
27792 @node Error Messaging
27793 @subsubsection Error Messaging
27794
27795 @findex nnheader-report
27796 @findex nnheader-get-report
27797 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
27798 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
27799 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
27800 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
27801 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
27802 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
27803
27804 @lisp
27805 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
27806
27807 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
27808 @end lisp
27809
27810 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
27811 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
27812 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
27813 takes one argument---the server symbol.
27814
27815 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
27816 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
27817 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
27818
27819
27820 @node Writing New Back Ends
27821 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
27822
27823 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
27824 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
27825 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
27826 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
27827 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
27828 editing articles.
27829
27830 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
27831 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
27832 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
27833
27834 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
27835 package called @code{nnoo}.
27836
27837 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
27838 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
27839 following macros:
27840
27841 @table @code
27842
27843 @item nnoo-declare
27844 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
27845 parameters. For instance:
27846
27847 @lisp
27848 (nnoo-declare nndir
27849 nnml nnmh)
27850 @end lisp
27851
27852 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
27853 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
27854
27855 @item defvoo
27856 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
27857 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
27858 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
27859
27860 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
27861 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
27862 a function in those back ends.
27863
27864 @lisp
27865 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
27866 "Where nndir will look for groups."
27867 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
27868 @end lisp
27869
27870 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
27871 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
27872 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
27873
27874 @item nnoo-define-basics
27875 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
27876 have.
27877
27878 @lisp
27879 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
27880 @end lisp
27881
27882 @item deffoo
27883 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
27884 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
27885 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
27886
27887 @item nnoo-map-functions
27888 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
27889 functions from the parent back ends.
27890
27891 @lisp
27892 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
27893 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27894 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
27895 @end lisp
27896
27897 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
27898 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
27899 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
27900 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
27901
27902 @item nnoo-import
27903 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
27904 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
27905 haven't already been defined.
27906
27907 @lisp
27908 (nnoo-import nndir
27909 (nnmh
27910 nnmh-request-list
27911 nnmh-request-newgroups)
27912 (nnml))
27913 @end lisp
27914
27915 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
27916 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
27917 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
27918 defined now.
27919
27920 @end table
27921
27922 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
27923
27924 @lisp
27925 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
27926 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
27927
27928 ;;; @r{Code:}
27929
27930 (require 'nnheader)
27931 (require 'nnmh)
27932 (require 'nnml)
27933 (require 'nnoo)
27934 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
27935
27936 (nnoo-declare nndir
27937 nnml nnmh)
27938
27939 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
27940 "Where nndir will look for groups."
27941 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
27942
27943 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
27944 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
27945 nnml-nov-is-evil)
27946
27947 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
27948 nil
27949 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
27950 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
27951 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
27952
27953 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
27954 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
27955
27956 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
27957
27958 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
27959
27960 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
27961 (setq nndir-directory
27962 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
27963 server))
27964 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
27965 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
27966 (push `(nndir-current-group
27967 ,(file-name-nondirectory
27968 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
27969 defs)
27970 (push `(nndir-top-directory
27971 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
27972 defs)
27973 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
27974
27975 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
27976 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27977 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27978 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
27979 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
27980
27981 (nnoo-import nndir
27982 (nnmh
27983 nnmh-status-message
27984 nnmh-request-list
27985 nnmh-request-newgroups))
27986
27987 (provide 'nndir)
27988 @end lisp
27989
27990
27991 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
27992 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
27993
27994 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
27995 @findex gnus-declare-backend
27996 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
27997 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
27998 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
27999
28000 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
28001 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
28002
28003 Here's an example:
28004
28005 @lisp
28006 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
28007 @end lisp
28008
28009 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
28010
28011 The abilities can be:
28012
28013 @table @code
28014 @item mail
28015 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
28016 @item post
28017 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
28018 @item post-mail
28019 This back end supports both mail and news.
28020 @item none
28021 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
28022 different.
28023 @item respool
28024 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
28025 articles and groups.
28026 @item address
28027 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
28028 true for almost all back ends.
28029 @item prompt-address
28030 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
28031 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
28032 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
28033 @end table
28034
28035
28036 @node Mail-like Back Ends
28037 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
28038
28039 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
28040 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
28041 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
28042 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
28043
28044 @lisp
28045 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
28046 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
28047 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
28048 @end lisp
28049
28050 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
28051 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
28052 mail.
28053
28054 This function takes four parameters.
28055
28056 @table @var
28057 @item method
28058 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
28059 the call.
28060
28061 @item exit-function
28062 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
28063
28064 @item temp-directory
28065 Where the temporary files should be stored.
28066
28067 @item group
28068 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
28069 performed for one group only.
28070 @end table
28071
28072 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
28073 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
28074 find the article number assigned to this article.
28075
28076 The function also uses the following variables:
28077 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
28078 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
28079 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
28080 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
28081 this:
28082
28083 @example
28084 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
28085 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
28086 @end example
28087
28088
28089 @node Score File Syntax
28090 @subsection Score File Syntax
28091
28092 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
28093 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
28094 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
28095
28096 Here's a typical score file:
28097
28098 @lisp
28099 (("summary"
28100 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
28101 ("Gnus"))
28102 ("from"
28103 ("Lars" -1000))
28104 (mark -100))
28105 @end lisp
28106
28107 BNF definition of a score file:
28108
28109 @example
28110 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
28111 element = rule / atom
28112 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
28113 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
28114 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
28115 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
28116 quote = <ascii 34>
28117 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
28118 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
28119 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
28120 date-header = "date"
28121 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28122 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28123 score = "nil" / <integer>
28124 date = "nil" / <natural number>
28125 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
28126 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
28127 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
28128 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
28129 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28130 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28131 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
28132 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28133 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
28134 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
28135 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
28136 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
28137 exclude-files / read-only / touched
28138 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
28139 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
28140 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
28141 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
28142 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
28143 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
28144 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
28145 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
28146 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
28147 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
28148 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
28149 eval = "eval" space <form>
28150 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
28151 @end example
28152
28153 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
28154 discarded.
28155
28156 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
28157 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
28158 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
28159 one looong line, then that's ok.
28160
28161 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
28162 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
28163
28164
28165 @node Headers
28166 @subsection Headers
28167
28168 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
28169 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
28170 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
28171 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
28172
28173 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
28174 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
28175 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
28176 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
28177 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
28178 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
28179 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
28180
28181 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
28182 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
28183 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
28184 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
28185 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
28186
28187 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
28188 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
28189
28190
28191 @node Ranges
28192 @subsection Ranges
28193
28194 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
28195 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
28196
28197 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
28198 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
28199 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
28200 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
28201
28202 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
28203 sequence.
28204
28205 @example
28206 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
28207 @end example
28208
28209 is transformed into
28210
28211 @example
28212 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
28213 @end example
28214
28215 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
28216 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
28217
28218 @example
28219 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
28220 @end example
28221
28222 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
28223 is slightly tricky:
28224
28225 @example
28226 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
28227 @end example
28228
28229 and
28230
28231 @example
28232 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
28233 @end example
28234
28235 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
28236
28237 @example
28238 (1 2 3 4 5)
28239 @end example
28240
28241 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
28242 also valid:
28243
28244 @example
28245 (1 . 5)
28246 @end example
28247
28248 and is equal to the previous range.
28249
28250 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
28251 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
28252 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
28253 range handling.)
28254
28255 @example
28256 range = simple-range / normal-range
28257 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
28258 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
28259 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
28260 number *[ " " contents ]
28261 @end example
28262
28263 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
28264 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
28265 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
28266 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
28267 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
28268 sequences.)
28269
28270
28271 @node Group Info
28272 @subsection Group Info
28273
28274 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
28275 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
28276 describes the group.
28277
28278 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
28279 second is a more complex one:
28280
28281 @example
28282 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
28283
28284 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
28285 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
28286 (nnml "")
28287 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
28288 @end example
28289
28290 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
28291 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
28292 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
28293 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
28294 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
28295 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
28296 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
28297 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
28298 this section is about.
28299
28300 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
28301 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
28302 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
28303
28304 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
28305
28306 @example
28307 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
28308 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
28309 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28310 group = quote <string> quote
28311 ralevel = rank / level
28312 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28313 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
28314 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28315 read = range
28316 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
28317 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
28318 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
28319 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
28320 @end example
28321
28322 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
28323 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
28324 in pseudo-BNF.
28325
28326 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
28327 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
28328
28329 @table @code
28330 @item gnus-info-group
28331 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
28332 @findex gnus-info-group
28333 @findex gnus-info-set-group
28334 Get/set the group name.
28335
28336 @item gnus-info-rank
28337 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
28338 @findex gnus-info-rank
28339 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
28340 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
28341
28342 @item gnus-info-level
28343 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
28344 @findex gnus-info-level
28345 @findex gnus-info-set-level
28346 Get/set the group level.
28347
28348 @item gnus-info-score
28349 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
28350 @findex gnus-info-score
28351 @findex gnus-info-set-score
28352 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
28353
28354 @item gnus-info-read
28355 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
28356 @findex gnus-info-read
28357 @findex gnus-info-set-read
28358 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
28359
28360 @item gnus-info-marks
28361 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
28362 @findex gnus-info-marks
28363 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
28364 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
28365
28366 @item gnus-info-method
28367 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
28368 @findex gnus-info-method
28369 @findex gnus-info-set-method
28370 Get/set the group select method.
28371
28372 @item gnus-info-params
28373 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
28374 @findex gnus-info-params
28375 @findex gnus-info-set-params
28376 Get/set the group parameters.
28377 @end table
28378
28379 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
28380 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
28381
28382 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
28383 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
28384 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
28385 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
28386
28387
28388 @node Extended Interactive
28389 @subsection Extended Interactive
28390 @cindex interactive
28391 @findex gnus-interactive
28392
28393 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
28394 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
28395 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
28396
28397 @lisp
28398 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
28399 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
28400 ...
28401 )
28402 @end lisp
28403
28404 The best thing to do would have been to implement
28405 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
28406 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
28407 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
28408 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
28409 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
28410 @code{interactive}.
28411
28412 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
28413 adds a few more.
28414
28415 @table @samp
28416 @item y
28417 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
28418 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
28419 variable.
28420
28421 @item Y
28422 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
28423 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
28424 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
28425
28426 @item A
28427 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
28428 function.
28429
28430 @item H
28431 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
28432 function.
28433
28434 @item g
28435 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
28436 function.
28437
28438 @end table
28439
28440
28441 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
28442 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
28443 @cindex XEmacs
28444 @cindex Emacsen
28445
28446 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
28447 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
28448 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
28449
28450 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
28451 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
28452 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
28453 Gnus, that's very useful.
28454
28455 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
28456 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
28457 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
28458 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
28459 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
28460 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
28461 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
28462 following function:
28463
28464 @lisp
28465 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
28466 (start-itimer
28467 "gnus-run-at-time"
28468 `(lambda ()
28469 (,function ,@@args))
28470 time repeat))
28471 @end lisp
28472
28473 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
28474 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
28475 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
28476 all over.
28477
28478 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
28479 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
28480 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
28481
28482 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
28483 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
28484 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
28485
28486
28487 @node Various File Formats
28488 @subsection Various File Formats
28489
28490 @menu
28491 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
28492 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
28493 @end menu
28494
28495
28496 @node Active File Format
28497 @subsubsection Active File Format
28498
28499 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
28500 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
28501 in each group.
28502
28503 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
28504
28505 @example
28506 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
28507 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
28508 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
28509 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
28510 no.general 1000 900 y
28511 @end example
28512
28513 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
28514
28515 @example
28516 active = *group-line
28517 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
28518 group = <non-white-space string>
28519 spc = " "
28520 high-number = <non-negative integer>
28521 low-number = <positive integer>
28522 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
28523 @end example
28524
28525 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
28526 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
28527
28528
28529 @node Newsgroups File Format
28530 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
28531
28532 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
28533 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
28534 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
28535 the user.
28536
28537 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
28538 Here's the definition:
28539
28540 @example
28541 newsgroups = *line
28542 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
28543 group = <non-white-space string>
28544 tab = <TAB>
28545 description = <string>
28546 @end example
28547
28548
28549 @page
28550 @node Emacs for Heathens
28551 @section Emacs for Heathens
28552
28553 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
28554 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
28555 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
28556 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
28557 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
28558 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
28559 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
28560 cat instead.
28561
28562 @menu
28563 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
28564 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
28565 @end menu
28566
28567
28568 @node Keystrokes
28569 @subsection Keystrokes
28570
28571 @itemize @bullet
28572 @item
28573 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
28574
28575 @item
28576 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
28577 @end itemize
28578
28579 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
28580 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
28581 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
28582 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
28583 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
28584 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
28585
28586 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
28587 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
28588 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
28589 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
28590 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
28591 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
28592 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
28593
28594 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
28595 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
28596 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
28597 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
28598 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
28599 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
28600 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
28601
28602 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
28603 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
28604 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
28605 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
28606 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
28607 it.
28608
28609
28610
28611 @node Emacs Lisp
28612 @subsection Emacs Lisp
28613
28614 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
28615 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
28616 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
28617 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
28618
28619 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
28620 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
28621 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
28622 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
28623 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
28624 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
28625 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
28626 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
28627 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
28628 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
28629
28630 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
28631 write the following:
28632
28633 @lisp
28634 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
28635 @end lisp
28636
28637 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
28638 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
28639 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
28640 change how Gnus works.
28641
28642 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
28643 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
28644 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
28645 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
28646 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
28647
28648 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
28649 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
28650 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
28651
28652 Some pitfalls:
28653
28654 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
28655 that means:
28656
28657 @lisp
28658 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
28659 @end lisp
28660
28661 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
28662 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
28663
28664 @lisp
28665 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
28666 @end lisp
28667
28668 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
28669 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
28670
28671 @page
28672 @include gnus-faq.texi
28673
28674 @node Index
28675 @chapter Index
28676 @printindex cp
28677
28678 @node Key Index
28679 @chapter Key Index
28680 @printindex ky
28681
28682 @summarycontents
28683 @contents
28684 @bye
28685
28686 @iftex
28687 @iflatex
28688 \end{document}
28689 @end iflatex
28690 @end iftex
28691
28692 @c Local Variables:
28693 @c mode: texinfo
28694 @c coding: iso-8859-1
28695 @c End:
28696
28697 @ignore
28698 arch-tag: c9fa47e7-78ca-4681-bda9-9fef45d1c819
28699 @end ignore